ANALYSIS OF FACTORS AFFECTING PAKISTAN’S
NATIONAL COMPETITIVE ADVANTAGE IN TRADE WITH
INDIA: EVIDENCE FROM
2005 TO 2015
SAMRA KIRAN
REGISTRATION NO. AWKUM-16002807
DOCTOR OF PHILOSOPHY IN MANAGEMENT SCIENCES
INSTITUTE OF BUSINESS STUDIES & LEADERSHIP
FACULTY OF BUSINESS & ECONOMICS
ABDUL WALI KHAN UNIVERSITY MARDAN
YEAR (2018)
i
Dedication
To my parents
Ms. Samra Kiran
ii
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
With the name of Allah
The most Gracious and the Most Merciful, all praise to Allah for giving me strength
and confidence for the completion of this thesis.
First and foremost, I offer my profound and sincere gratitude to the Almighty Allah for
bestowing me with strength, wisdom, courage, and intellect to complete this assignment
successfully.
I am very thankful to my Supervisor Prof. Dr. Qadar Bakhsh Baloch, for his advice and
supervision during my research work. His consistent support and guidance gave me the
confidence to achieve my goal.
I am also grateful to Mr. Sohrab Arshad, Mr. Zeeshan Khan, Mr. Mohammad Kamran
and Madam SaimaBano for their cooperation and support in the completion of this
thesis.
I ineffably acknowledge my parents, siblings and especially my husband for their
unconditional love and support in every regard. Without their kindness and guidance,
this thesis would not be possible.
Once again,I convey my gratitude to all those who had a direct or indirect influence on
my work.
Ms. Samra Kiran
iii
Author’s Declaration
I Ms. Samra Kiran hereby state that my PhD thesis titled “ANALYSIS OF FACTORS
AFFECTING PAKISTAN’S NATIONAL COMPETITIVE ADVANTAGE IN
TRADE WITH INDIA: EVIDENCE FROM 2005 TO 2015” is my own work and
has not been submitted previously by me for taking any degree from Abdul Wali Khan
University, Mardan or anywhere else in the country/world.
At any time if my statement is found to be incorrect even after my Graduate the
university has the right to withdraw my Ph.D. degree.
Ms. Samra Kiran
iv
Plagiarism Undertaking
I solemnly declare that research work presented in the thesis titled “ANALYSIS OF
FACTORS AFFECTING PAKISTAN’S NATIONAL COMPETITIVE
ADVANTAGE IN TRADE WITH INDIA: EVIDENCE FROM 2005 TO 2015” is
solely my research work with no significant contribution from any other person. Small
contribution/help whenever taken has been duly acknowledged and that complete thesis
has been written by me.
I understand the zero-tolerance policy of the HEC and Abdul Wali Khan University,
Mardan towards plagiarism. Therefore, I as an Author of the above-titled thesis declare
that no portion of my thesis has been plagiarized and any material used as a reference
is properly referred/cited.
I undertake that if I am found guilty of any formal plagiarism in the above-titled thesis
even after award of Ph.D. degree, the university reserves the rights to withdraw/revoke
my Ph.D. degree and that HEC and the university has the right to publish my name on
the HEC/University Website on which names of students are placed who submitted
plagiarized thesis.
Student Signature: ______________
Name: Samra Kiran
v
Certificate Of Approval
This is to certify that the research work presented in this thesis, entitled “ANALYSIS
OF FACTORS AFFECTING PAKISTAN’S NATIONAL COMPETITIVE
ADVANTAGE IN TRADE WITH INDIA: EVIDENCE FROM 2005 TO 2015”
was conducted by Ms. Samra Kiran under the supervision of Prof. Dr. Qadar Bakhsh
Baloch.
No part of this thesis has been submitted anywhere else for any other degree. This thesis
is submitted to the Institute of Business Studies & Leadership, Abdul Wali Khan
University, Mardan in partial fulfillment of the requirements for the degree of Doctor
of Philosophy in the field of Marketing Institute of Business Studies & Leadership,
Abdul Wali Khan University, Mardan.
Student Name: Ms. Samra Kiran Signature: __________________
Supervision committee:
1.Major Supervisor:
Prof. Dr. Qadar Bakhsh Baloch Signature: __________________
Director
Institute of Business Studies & Leadership
Abdul Wali Khan University, Mardan
2. External Examiner
Dr. Aamir Nadeem Signature:___________________
Assistant Professor
Department of Management Sciences
City University, Peshawar
3. Co-Supervisor:
Dr. KauserTakreem Signature:___________________
Associate Professor
Institute of Management Studies
University of Peshawar
Director,IBLSignature: __________________
Institute of Business Studies & Leadership
Abdul Wali Khan University, Mardan
Dean, Signature:___________________
Faculty of Business & Economics
Abdul Wali Khan University, Mardan
Director Acad. & ResearchSignature: __________________
Abdul Wali Khan University, Mardan
vi
Abstract
This work had tried to identify sources of competitive advantage for Pakistan in trade
with India. Focusing five industries from both countries for the period 2005 to 2015.
Industries include textile, Sugar and Sugar Confectionaries, Inorganic Chemicals,
edible fruits,and nuts and Agriculture. A detailed literature review, Ratio analysis, and
regression analysis were applied, to identify impediments to trade with India, future
trade prospects, sources of competitive advantage for Pakistan, and assess the effects
of granting of MFN status to India. The analysis identified many impediments to trade
by India, like tariffs, quota, strict quality, non-tariff barriers, Visa policy, hindering
trade between both countries. The intraregional trade share suggests a very costly
future trade between both countries, intra-regional trade share suggested that the
aggregate trade of Pakistan and India is not very significant in the world. The
intraregional trade introversion index suggested that trade between both countries had
an extra-regional bias suggesting trade diversion. The ratio of revealed comparative
advantage suggested that Pakistani textile was not consistently competitive, but
Inorganic chemical, Agriculture, Sugarand sugar confectionaries and Edible fruits and
nuts industries were not competitive during the period under study. Whereas, textile
and sugar and sugar confectionery were sustainable competitive but all the other Indian
industries were not consistently competitive. The regression analysis suggests that
government policy had significantly affected the national competitive advantage of
Pakistan. Whereas for India, government policy and firm strategy and rivalry were
significant. The research concludes that both Pakistan and India are facing the same
problems regarding their factor conditions, demand condition, supporting and related
industries. As compared to Pakistan, India is providing a better business environment
and its relatively easy to conduct business in India. The governments of both countries
are trying to liberalize trade and playing a positive role but the main hindrance is
political and military interference in many issues. Both countries have the potential for
future trade, but for that, they have to abolish their NTBs, tariffs and devise fairly liberal
trade policies against each other.
keywords: International trade, Rational Trade Agreement, SAFTA,
vii
List of Tables
Table3.1 Pakistan India Trade Share Analysis………………………...….…….…83
viii
Table 4.1 Variable Proxies Data Source and References………………….….….…93 Table 5.1 Indicators of Regional Trade interdependence.........................................118 Table 5.2 Pakistan Revealed Comparative Advantage inDifferent Industries …...119 Table5.3 Indian Revealed Comparative Advantage in differentIndustries………120 Table 5.4Regional Orientation of Pakistan trade with India…………….….….…121 Table 5.5 Trade Complementarity Index………………………….........................123 Table 5.6 Summary Statistics Pakistan ………………….………………...….......123 Table5.7 Correlation Matrix Pakistan………………….……………………..…..124 Table 5.8 ADF panel unit root test result Pakistan……..……………………….…124 Table 5.9 Hausman Test Result Pakistan overall………………………………....125 Table5.10 Regression Results Pakistan…..……...………….……..………...….….125
Table 5.11 Summary Statistics India.………………………….……………….…...126
Table 5.12 Correlation Matrix India…………………………………………. …….126
Table 5.13 Panel Unit Root test result sugar industry India…………………...……127
Table 5.14 Hausman Test Result India Overal……………………………………...127
Table 5.15 Overall India Regression Results……...…………………….………….127
Table 5.16 Summary Statistics Pakistan - Agriculture …….………...……………..128
Table 5.17 Correlation Matrix Agriculture Industry Pakistan……………………….129
Table5.18 ADF Unit Root Test Result Agriculture Industry Pakistan……………..129
Table 5.19 Regression Results Pakistan Agriculture Industry...................................129
Table 5.20 Summarystatistics Pakistan edible fruits and nuts……………….….…130
Table 5.21 Correlation Matrix Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry Pakistan…..……....131
Table 5.22 ADF Unit Root Test Result- Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry Pakistan...131
Table5.23Regression Results-Edible Fruits and Nuts IndustryPakistan……….…131
Table5.24 Summary Statistics -Pakistan Sugar Industry…..……………….……...132
Table 5.25 Correlation Matrix Sugar Industry Pakistan.……...……………….…....133
Table5.26 ADF Unit Root Test Result Sugar Industry Pakistan..…………….…....133
Table5.27 Regression Results- Sugar Industry Pakistan….……….……....…… ...133
Table5.28 Summary Statistics Pakistan Inorganic Chemicals……………………...134
Table 5.29 Correlation Matrix Edible Inorganic Chemical Industry Pakistan….…..135
Table 5.30 ADF unit root test result inorganic chemical industry-Pakistan….…….135
Table5.31Regression Results Inorganic Chemical Industry-Pakistan……….........135
Table 5. 32 Summary Statistics Pakistan Textile ………………………………......136
Table 5.33 Correlation Matrix Textile Industry Pakistan…………...……………....136
Table 5.34 ADF Unit Root Test Result Textile Industry Pakistan…….....................136
Table 5.35 Regression Results- Textile Industry Pakistan……….……………...….137
Table 5.36 Summary Statistics – Sugar Industry India…………………………......138
Table 5.37 Correlation Matrix Sugar Industry India……………………………,,....139
Table 5.39 Regression Results- Sugar Industry India……………….…………,,...139
Table 5.40 Summary Statistics India Edible Fruits and Nuts………………….…...140
Table 5.41 Correlation matrix edible fruits and nuts industry India………………..141
Table5.42 Unit Root Test Result Edible Fruits And Nuts Industry India……...…..141
Table 5.43 Regression Results- Edible Fruits And Nuts Industry India…..…..........141
Table 5.44 Summary Statistics India Inorganic Chemicals.………………………..142
Table 5.45 Correlation Matrix Inorganic Chemical Industry India……….……..….143
Table 5.46 Unit Root Test Result Inorganic Chemical Industry India………..….....143
Table 5.47 Regression Results -Inorganic Chemical Industry India…….….…...….143
Table 5.48 Summary Statistics India Textile….……………………..………..........144
Table 5.49 Correlation Matrix Textile Industry India……………………………....144
ix
Table 5.50 Panel Unit Root Test Result Textile Industry India…………...………..145
Table 5.51 Regression Results- Textile Industry India…………..….………..….....145
Table 5.52 Correlation Matrix Agriculture Industry India ........................................146
Table5.53 Unit Root Test Result Agriculture Industry India…………....................146
Table5.54 Regression Results -Agriculture Industry India………….…….....…….147
List of Figures
x
Figure 2 1 Porter Diamond Model ………………………………………………….29
Figure 3.1 Conceptual Framework…………………………………………………..90
LIST OF ANNEXURES
xi
Annexture 1 ................................................................................................................ 202
List of Abbreviations
xii
MFNMost Favorite Nation
SAARC South Asian Association of Regional Cooperation
SAPTA South Asian Preferential Trade Agreement
SAFTA South Asian Free Trade Area
ITO International Trade Organization
WTO World Trade Organization
OECDOrganization for Economic Cooperation and
Development.
RTA Regional Trade Agreement
ERP Enterprise Resource Planning
CRM Customer Relations Management
SCM Supply Chain Management
EU European Union
GSP Generalized System of Preference
FDI Foreign Direct Investment
PTA Pakistan Telecommunication Authority
ARDLAutoregressive Distributed Lag Model
VECMVector Error Correction Model
FC Factor Conditions
DC Demand Conditions
SRI Supporting and Related Industries
FSSR Firm Strategy and Rivalry
GP Government Policy
CA Competitive Advantage
RCA Revealed Comparative Advantage
13
CHAPTER # I
INTRODUCTION
1.1.Background
International trade is a practice in which countries expand their markets by selling and purchasing
beyond their borders competitively. International trade developsa global economy in which
demand, supply,and prices are generally affected by global political crises and other global events.
International trade absorbs the country surplus production – the absorption of surplus increases
demand and corresponding production level. Increase in production leads to economies of scale
and hence the reductionin the cost of production, which increases competition in the market. The
resulting efficiency derived from economies of scalemay attract Foreign Direct Investment (FDI),
that guarantees maximum revenue, employment and profitability of the business.As the volume of
trade increases, the integral benefits are divided on more numbers of people, hence prosperity and
wealth creation for society.In order to protect the home industry or control the market, some
countries regulate international business by imposing tariffs andnon-tariffmeasures. Protectionist
policies(old time Mercantilism) arecontradictory to free trade and restrict the volume of foreign
trade.The main purpose of practicing international trade is to decrease cost and maximize revenues.
A country can be positively affected by international trade. The benefits are not only limited to the
producers, but it also contributes in the socialwellbeing, increasing economic development,proper
allocation of funds and more specifically encouraging the businesses to improve the quality,
infrastructure,and technology.
The first organized theory regarding trade was mercantilism suggesting wealth to be
dependent on gold reserves, precious metals and surplus trade.The literature regarding
mercantilism appeared from Great Britain inthe 16th century the major contributor was Thomas
Mun (1571–1641) by his book Treasure by Foreign Trade (1664). The last contributor of this
system was Stuard (1767), who mentioned it in his book an inquiry into Principles of Political
Economy. This system was also extended towardsItaly and France and produced very noteworthy
writers, including Jean Bodin (1530-1596), Colbert (1619-1683) in France and Giovanni
Botero (1544–1617) and Antonio Serra (1580) in Italy. Smith (1776) in his wealth of nations
14
organized the idea of mercantilism and its contributions and criticize this system on the basis that
mercantilism view trade as azero-sum game. He proposed the Absolute Advantage Theory,
whichstates that countries should trade with each other by only producing products in which they
are effectivelycreating an absolute balance among different countries.
Ricardo (1817) improved the absolute advantage theory by restating the Comparative
Advantage Theory. The theory suggests that efficiency in resource utilization will help countries
to increase its productivity. The trade should be done by comparing the opportunity cost of a
country, and if it has as a lower opportunity cost in producing certain good it should trade that
product. Heckscher (1919) and Olin (1933) contradicted the Ricardian theory of comparative
advantage and suggested that the countries should export those goods for which it has abundant
resources, rather than efficiency of production. They added government policy to be positively
impacted on factor endowment. They focus on the relative advantage instead of an absolute
advantage. The Heckscher-Ohlin theory was introduced to update the Ricardian model having an
ideological mission of elimination of labor theory of value and to incorporate the neoclassical price
mechanism in international trade theory. The H-O theory suggests that the empirical work for
proving its validity by focusing on its power to forecast the trend of trade patterns is irrelevant.
Secondly, the model is also theoretically weak in its treatment its treatment of capital and labor.
Finally, its view of challenging the Ricardian model by emphasizing its ability to identify trade
patterns of developing and underdeveloped countries, just like the Ricardian model.
The H-O theory suggests that in the case of free trade and factor-price equalization, the capital-
labor ratio of import-competing goods of the United States should be equal to its imports. Leontief
(1951) estimated the consequences of utilization of factors of production of the United States, He
took only two factors labor and capital explicitly into account. When exports were decreased, both
capital and labor were released. When production of import-competing goods is increased, both
labor and capital were more needed.
Linder (1960) introduced the Country Similarity theory, which suggests that trade between
countries take place due to the similarity in customer needs, their preferences, economic
development,and production conditions. Porter (1991) suggested a diamond model in which he
suggested that in order to be globally competitive countries should be competitive domestically.
His model was based on four factors, including factor endowment, demand conditioning, relating
15
and supporting industries and two additional factors including government policy and change
events. The New trade theory contributed that with the increase in production specialization is
achieved, which decreases per unit cost and also decreases the learningcurve.Therefore, world
demand can entertain by an increase in large scale. Due to first mover advantage competition
emerged and develop economies of scale, which hiders new entrants. These competitors are further
strengthened by government policies.
The realization of the inherent advantages of free trade led the international community to plan to
create an international trade organization at Bretton woods in 1944. The internal resistance in the
USA against the ratification of International Trade Organization (ITO) succeeded to delay the
establishment of World Trade Organization (WTO) till 1995(Schott, 1996).The underlying
purpose of WTO was to make an ambitious effort to make globalization more inclusive and
help the world's poor, particularly by slashing barriers and subsidies in farming. The initial
agenda comprised both further trade liberalization and new rule-making, underpinned by
commitments to strengthen substantial assistance to developing countries. The sociopolitical
and economic liberalization pushed the phenomenon of globalization and integration to
unprecedented scale and speed.The economic integration involves a hierarchy of levels, starting
from a free trade area, passing through customs union, common market, economic union to
political union. All of these levels gradually increased different dimensions of free trade.
From the foregoing discussion in view, free trade creates jobs, customer focus competitions
and determine the course of flow of goods, services from the lower cost production to demand
destinations. However, if this flow is restricted through agreement (integration) changing from low
to high-cost origins, the volume of trade may decrease thereby creating trade diversion. Therefore,
this conclusion guides that countries before arranging any level of integration must assess the cost-
effectiveness of the intended state in their cost of production and delivery, failing which the
integration may trap the party into trade diversion.Pakistan has facedthe economic problems ever
since its independence. Much work had already done to find the solution for the economic problem
of the country(Baloch, 2009). Trade is an important factor which contributes much to the
development of the country. This will try to find factors affecting national competitive advantage
both Pakistan and India and developa scenario for future trade prospects for both countries.
16
1.2 Statement Of Problem
The surplustrade balance is a key indicator of any country’s economic growth and
development. The trend of Pakistan’s balance of payment suggests that the majority of times it
remained in deficit (State bank of Pakistan, 2016),and could not reverse the situationso far.
Economic Integration (depending upon its integration level)is considered to be a positive outcome
of globalization, where trade between the contracting parties is deregularized. However, the
benefits integrated with economic integrationvary from member to member.Due to their varying
nature of themacroeconomic environment,increased trade between Pakistan and Indiais considered
to be offering lots of trade benefits to both countriesby lowering tariff and non-tariff barriers. There
exists mix opinion about the benefits of increased Pak India trade in Pakistan viz a viz India. There
is an increasing argument that Pakistan should reciprocate India by granting MFN Status. as it
granted MFN to Pakistan in 1996. Some of the Schoolsargue that Pakistan is not in a position to
liberalize trade with India as its competitive advantage doesn’t match with India. Therefore, there
is a dire need to know the present level of competitive advantage before taking the decision of
such national significance.
This research aims to determine the National Competitive advantage of Pakistan in a trade with
India with a view to ascertain the ensuing trade prospects for Pakistan in South Asia with special
reference to India. The research intends to investigate the factors that affect Pakistan’s National
Competitive Advantage using Porter’s National competitive Advantage Model. The ultimate
outcomeintended for this research is to determine whether there exists, trade diversion or trade
creation for Pakistan in post SAFTAenvironments.
1.3 Research Questions
The research would seek answers of the following questions:
a. What are the factors which contribute to the competitive advantage of Pakistan trade with
India?
b. What is the impact of SAFTA on Pakistani trade, with regard to its imports and exports
toIndiaand beyond?
c. Does Pakistan hold the National competitive advantage to withstand the effects of granting
MFN status to India or otherwise?
17
d. What arethe challenges in Pakistan in extended trade liberalization between Pakistan and
India?
1.4Research Objectives
The main objective persuaded by this work were:
1. To Determine and describe the Pak-India bilateral trade regime and conditions of MFN as in
vogue through a comprehensive review of the current situation.
2. To identify the effectsof SAFTA on trade liberalization between India andPakistanthrough
ratio analysis and their applied status with likely pros and cons integrated intothe bilateral
trade.
3. To identify factors affecting Pakistan National Competitive Advantage intrade with India
during post SAFTA period (2005 to 2015).
4.To identify challenges and opportunities for Pakistan in trade with India and suggest a response
to trade creation.
1.5Significance Of Research
The research study could provide information on Pak-India bilateral trade. For academia, it will
contribute to the limited literature already available and open insights into new areas of research.
As the economic reforms, initiation of the policy of openness to integrate into the global economy
is very important for the sustained economic growth of the country. This work will try to provide
policy guidelines to the policymakers. Countries like companies compete in the international
market. At the firmlevel, the competitiveness can be attained by the combination of strong political
and legal system, with stable institutions and social frameworks, this work will identify factors
which can play important role in the development of competitive advantage. Additionally, the
macro, as well as micro-conditions of the nation, will help to attain and sustain competitiveness in
the global market.As, International competitiveness is critical for the attraction of investment,
tourism and Other services. The current work will analyze variables through which international
competitiveness can be attained for Pakistan and India
The major contribution of this work is that both Pakistan and India are exporting more in
labor-intensive industries which suggest that trade between the two countries will not significantly
18
provide benefit. they will be benefited by trading more with developed countries who are more
competitive in capital-intensive industries and are facing problems of labor shortages. As very few
studies were directed towards this issue, so it will help to clarify many important aspects of
international trade, trade liberalization and RTA’s. The research study will also provide
information on Pak-India bilateral trade in SAFTA (free trade agreement between SAARC
countries) environment. As the economic reforms and initiation of the policy of openness,to
integrate into the global economy is very important for the sustained economic growth of the
country. This work will also help investors and businessmen in finding new markets and prospects.
There are a substantial number of theoretical studies that have addressed the issue of regional
Integration and also on the relation and trade potential between Pakistan and India, but this work
has identified potential factors which are contributing or hindering the competitive advantage
selected industries in both countries
1.6The Organization of The Study
The structure of the remaining thesis will be as follows:
Chapter 2 briefly reviews the previous studies, theories related to international trade. The detailed
analysis of Porter national diamond model.The theoretical framework and the specification of the
Porter diamond model applied for the analysis.
Chapter 3 presents an introduction to the economy of India and Pakistan and their trade patterns,
which estimated the effects of RTAs and other trade liberalization efforts in South East
Asia,especially between Pakistan and India.
Chapter 4 willdiscuss the research methodology. This chapter will provide details about the data,
sampling techniques used. Dependent and independent variable development and proxies used to
measure these variables and analytical techniques applied.
Chapter 5 provides results of ratio analysis applied, descriptive statistics, and regression models.
Chapter 6 provides analysis, findings,and discussion based on the results.
Chapter 7 will present the conclusion, recommendations and suggests for future research.
19
CHAPTER# 2
LITERATURE REVIEW
To answer the research question about the national competitive advantage, this chapter will discuss
different theories and models regarding the competitiveness of nations and their firms. The next
discussion will be on historical overview of Pak- India bilateral trade and future prospects.
2.1.What is Trade?
Trade means the exchange of goods and service for money or for other goods and services.
According to OEDC (2017) report trade is regarded as a source of growth, development and
employment opportunities. In order to be successful in trade countries need an integrated approach
to make it beneficial for the whole system which thenbenefits its people. This requires the creation
of an environment, with which benefits from trade can be materialized and supportsthe domestic
policies. This encourages innovation, creativity, opportunities,and competition, as a result,
unnecessary trade cost can be invested in its people, digital and physical infrastructure. Secondly,
it tries to help regions which are lagging behind and thirdly, it tries to makethe international system
free and fair, in order to avail the benefits of international economic integration and cooperation
(OECD,2017). Actually, Trade is a very powerful driver in itself, which encourage structural
change, which helps to reallocate resources to the areas and industry, where they can be used most
efficiently. Working Countries and people practice trade for their own interest as open economy’s
progress more than closed economies, additionally working conditions and salaries are better in
firms that trade, rather those that do not (OECD, 2012). The GDP and global trade pace of
economic integration were reversed or slow (OECD, 2016). The increased trade ratio is also
20
positively correlated with productivity over the long run (Newfarmer and Sztajerowska, 2012).
Within regions and countries, that showed progress in productivity are those which are indulged
in trade-related activities (OECD,2017).
2.1.1.Historical Background of Trade
Trade can be found in recorded human history. In the stone ages, evidence was found for obsidian
and flint to be used as a medium of exchange. Much of this trade took place in Guinea 17000 BCE
(Lower, 1970). Trade in the stone ages was believed to be started in South West Asia (Smith,
2009). The archaeological history of the use of obsidian provides evidence on the use of this
material preferred over chert and was increasingly used from the late Mesolithic to Neolithic,
despite its scare reserves in Mediterranean region (Robb,2007), It was traded within 900 kilometers
of the Mediterranean (Thore,1995). The prime source of trade with Antalia was Iran, Levant,and
Egypt (Bohn, 1857). The Melos and Lipari were also the major sources for trade in the
Mediterranean region (Blake & Knapp, 2005). In Afghanistan, the mine of Sari-i-Sang was the
major source of trade of Lapis Lazuli (Colllon, 1990). The material was also widely used the period
of Kassite and Babylonia in 1595 BCE (Bertman,2005).
In the third millennium,Eba was a prominent trading center, having networks with Northern
Mesopotamia and Anatolia (Etheredg, 2011). Since 3000 BCE the material used for jewelry
making was traded with Egypt. The long routes emerged in the 3rd millennium BCE when
Sumerians started trading with Harappan civilization. The Phoenicians were prominent sea traders,
who travel across the Mediterranean Sea and travel as far as Britain in search of sources for tin.
They also established trade colonies called emporia for this purpose (Dikov, 2015). From the early
Greek civilization till the decline of Roman empire, a very valuable and lucrative trade brought
spices to Europe from China and India. Later on, development of saving and secure transportation
system by Roman empire enable trade on these routes without the fear of piracy. As a result, Rome
acquires sole power in the Mediterranean. With the fall of the Roman Empire and the start of dark
ages the trade routes and networks were destroyed but trade continued to flourish in the African
region, India, China,andthe middle east. A minimal trade also happens in the west which includes
Radhanites, who wasa group of Jews, who trade with Muslim at the east and with Christian of
Europe.
21
Trade developed in the middle ages with the trade of luxury items. With the development
of the banking system, the transfer of capital and money across national borders and the regulation
of the town market by authorities, a complex and regulated system of trade network was developed
in Europe. Trade networks were also developed by many ports (Sean, 2001). Central Asia was
considered to the economic hub of the world in the middles ages (Beckwit, 2009). From 4th to 8th-
centuryOgdians dominated the silk routes. The Varangians and Viking, during 8th to 11th
century,traveled to and from Scandinavia. Between 13th to 17th century a trade monopoly on
Baltic and northern Europe was maintained by an alliance of different called Hanseatic League.
When Vasco Da Gama Reached Calicut after pioneering the spice trade of Europe in 1498,
sailing around Cape of Good, which was previously dominated by Islamic powers. That was the
start of economic development of Europe. as spice trade brought many impart commodities along
with spices especially gold. In 16th century west indies, in the 17th-century Dutch Republic and
in 18th century Britain dominated the trade activities in the world. The economic recession of
great depression from 1929 to 1930, showed a huge decrease in the trade-related activities. the
lack of free trade was considered to be the main cause of inflation and recession at that time. After
world war ii, the Bretton Wood Agreement was signed which marked the era of trade liberalization
and cooperation among European countries. an international political economy was initiated with
the help of international monetary fund and a bank of reconstruction and development and
promoted international trade later on.
2.1.2.International Trade
The main purpose of practicing international trade is to decrease cost and maximize revenues. A
country can be positively affected by international trade. As a producer can find lower cost factor
of production in achieving economies of scale, which in turn provide benefits to the customer by
providing them lower costs products and services (Appleyardet.al, 2006). The benefits are not
only limited to the producers, but it also contributes to the socialwellbeing, increasing economic
development, proper allocation of funds and more specifically encouraging the businesses to
improve the quality, infrastructure, and technology (Jhingan, 1994 in Mulyanto, 1999). In the
modern era, countries should interact with the world and avoid isolation. This objective will be
achieved through international trade. Goharian (2000) called international trade as an important
growth and development driver. United Nations Conference on Trade and Development (2004)
22
suggested the country should avail existing opportunitiesand possibilities in the international
market, to be competitive in the world.
The important entry into the international market will enhance progress and development.
International trade can rightly be called the engine of economic development and growth
(Goharian,2000). According to the report of theUnited Nations Conference on Trade and
Development (2004) for the reduction of poverty, a nation should maintain its exports annual real
growth rate above 5%. The success of every country is highly dependent on its understanding of
its international competitive environment for exploring international market opportunities.
Hussain (2003) suggested that in last half century world trade volume had increased in twenty
folds and manufactures exports had increased forty-fold. The world output had increased up to
seventy folds. By 2001 the total world trade was almost 24% of world gross domestic product. In
the last three decades,the merchandise and manufactured exports of developing countries a had
grown by an average of 12 % and 70% per annum respectively. The world exports had increased
up to 30% since 1990. This provides an excellent opportunity for developing countries to avail and
participates in the benefits of a buoyant trading environment.If Pakistan had maintained its exports
growth rate equal to the average of developing countries, the country would not face with the
problems of unemployment, poverty and other economic problems. Hussain (2003) identified that
reason for these problems is more reliance on the domestic market.
Entering the global arena will help countries to enhance its economic growth which cannot be
achieved relying only on the domestic market. Increased international trade will help the nation to
achieve economies of scales, benefiting domestic customers in a form of decreased prices. Exports
will generate revenues for the imports of equipment, raw material, components, machinery, etc.
for the industry and for the purchase of petroleum for transports, electricity, railways and other
important economic activities and also repayment to our external creditors. Therefore, relying only
onthe domestic market for poverty reduction and growth is sadly mistaken.
Hussain (2013) suggested that integration into the global market and increase trade liberalization
will lead a nation to accelerate international trade and increase economic activity. This is because
the volume of the traded goods sector increase as compared to rest of the economy and shifting
the resources from protected import sector to the export-oriented sectors. This reallocation of
resources will help gain competitive advantage and welfare gains to the society. This exposure to
23
the world competition will provide country more access to technology and information for the
development of new capabilities and skills as export-oriented economies enjoy better capabilities
as compared to closed economies.
2.1.3. HistoricalEvaluation of InternationalTradeTheories.
In 1492 Columbus discovered America, The World; in Amerigo Vespucci, an Italian explorer
Amerigo Vespucci discovered the east coast of South America between 1499 and 1504. Magellan
in 1519 with the permission of his Spanish king discovered a new route to India. All these
discoveries were the outcome of scientific advancement in astronomy and transportation industry.
Businessmen and other trade were interested to expand their business in western and eastern
countries to earn a profit(Dong-Sung &Cho, 2000). The International business phenomenon
hadbecome popular in the age of exploration and discovery during the 15th century.
2.1.3.1. Mercantilism
The first organized economic system is Mercantilism dated back in the 16th century and was
dominant in major European countries till 18th-centuryeconomic theory and a political struggle.
There is generally no accurate definition of this system, as it was a collection of policies and
principle of economic regulation upon which a country can achieve welfare and be prosperous
(Rempel 1998). According to Ekelund and Hébert (1996) in 1684 Philipp von Hörnigk (1640-
1712) suggested a very clear mercantile policy by suggesting nine important rules. According to
these rules the country should make every effort to achieve maximum efficiency from its
agricultural fields, all the raw materials and minerals, which cannot be used in their first-hand state
should be refined and should be developed within the country, the population should be large
enough to be easily supported by the country resources. Gold and silver reserves of the countries
should be hoarded and should not be taken out of the country under any circumstances.
The inhabitants of the country should use preferably their home manufactured products, imports
should not be done in exchange for gold and silver but in an exchange with their domestic products.
It should be tried that imports should be done in unfinished form. Imports should be done only in
case there is not sufficient quantity of products not available within the country. Britain France
and Germany developed a very strong economy based on this system. Asthe first principle of this
system was to increase exports and store precious metals in order to achieve power and increase
24
wealth. It advocates that countries should be strong and they can use military power for the
protection of their local markets and their supply sources. Therefore,Mercantilism holds that a
nation can be prosperous if it had an abundance of capital and a positive balance of
trade.Mercantilism practiced by different countries in the world are discussed below:
2.1.3.1.1British Mercantilism
In the 1650’s, Britain pursued a policy of mercantilism for international trade., which states that
in order to gain economic strength, a country must import less than it exports. In order to achieve
this goal, they passed different laws to benefit from this system. From 1651 and 1673, the British
Parliament passed NavigationActs in order to ensure proper implementation of mercantilist trade
balance.
The acts include clauses, like that, Only English colonial or English ships had permission to carry
cargo between imperial ports, Trade of Goods such as tobacco, rice, and furs can only be done
between foreign nations except through England.The British Parliament has to pay “bounties” for
raw material produced by Americans while charging tariffs from other nations producing the same
goods. There would be no competition for British large-scale manufacturers from American.
Between 15th and 18th-century huge amount of revenues were required in order to bare expenses
of the army and city governments. At that time this concept flourished as governments identified
that precious metals were in universal demand and they can be exchanged with other commodities
as well. So, they identify wealth with money, giving birth to the theory of bullionism which can
only be achieved under certain conditions. Firstly, Agricultural base should be developed and
strengthened, so imports can be minimized and farmers should prosper as they help to provide a
solid base for taxation, sea routes should be specialized and secure, in order to facilitate imports
as well as exports and all kindsof internal taxes should be imposed (Rempel 1998).
The policy of mercantilism encourages increased production, in order to increase exports for
maintaining a positive balance of trade. Thomas Mun (157 1 - 164 I), who was the director of East
India company, explained thatmercantilist policy in detail, he advised trade to be the only source
of increasing. He suggested different tactics such as increased imports of precious metals to
England through its colonies, also increase imports of cheap raw material and increased exports of
finished goods and protectionist policies for other country’s imports, take measures for population
and maintain competitive and low wages.
25
Mercantilist policies were intended to national prosperity through maximization of exports. This
idea was closely linked to the bullionism, which advocates a nation’s success due to the amount
of gold and other precious metals. This idea had a very great impact on economic policy. Which
ensures fewer imports and a huge amount of exports to maintain a large amount of foreign
exchange to maintain and increase the reservoirs of gold. These ideas were adopted by different
countries e.g. The Navigation Acts, by Britain strictly restrict the ability of other countries to trade
with Britain and its colonies.
2.1.3.1.2. French Mercantilism
After the Napoleonic wars, the French government tried to restrict the import of foods and other
exports by their opponents to restrict their supply of gold. The mercantilist theorist identified tax
policy to be an important tool for achieving mercantilist goals. This policy was misused by
government and they imposed taxes on even births, burials, marriages bachelor and even windows.
This policy also encouraged smuggling, damage many important industries. Another problem
created by granting a monopoly to critical industries. Therefore,the policy created a negative
impact on the industrial structure and became less helpful. Laffemas (1598) a French thinker,
criticize the view of not using expensive silk, as he was of the view that purchase of precious silk
earned a livelihood for poor and hoarding of money results in starving them to death. In 1952
William Grampp published his paper in which he suggested that mercantilist policies should not
be mingled with mercantilist thought as according to his views, true mercantilists are an advocate
of foreign trade. Nicholas Barbon (1690) a pioneer of fire insurance policy was of the view that
money should not be hoarded but invested.
Actually, mercantilism replaced the feudal imperialism of Western Europe, but it was not
popular till Smith (1776) in his book, wealth of nations organized the idea of mercantilism and its
contributions. That was the beginning of modern capitalism. As there was a decline of feudalism.,
Smith (1776) presented Absolute Advantagetheory which is explained below.
2.1.3.2 Absolute Advantage Theory
Smith (1776) in his wealth of nations organized the idea of mercantilism and its contributions and
criticize this system on the basis that mercantilism view trade as azero-sum game. He proposed
the Absolute Advantage Theory, whichstates that countries should trade with each other by only
26
producing products in which they are effectivelycreating an absolute balance among different
countries. He suggested an economic system which is deeply rooted in the human nature and social
system and suggested that the wealth of a nation can never be judged by reservoirs of metal itposses
but, its capacity and the abilityto create and extend world markets through trade. According to him,
the actual strength of the nation is the speed and efficiency of its production of goods and services.
He developed the idea of free trade and individualism, presented the concept ofinvisible hands.The
concept of invisible hand suggests that the mechanism of the market is automatic and it regulates
itself, but this ability is threatened by lobbying groups, tax preferences, and monopolies. Further,
he mentioned that every individual is well aware of the needs of the other, if he is allowed to
achieve the welfare, in the long run, he will contribute to the welfare of the nation. The government
can only facilitate and protect his freedom.
Smith (1776) extracted the idea of individualism and naturallaw from the division of labor, which
was then extended to the international division of labor accompanied by specialization. He
suggested due to the division of labor the countries will specialize in producing particular types of
goods which will then be exchanged and will further promote the world's progress.But, he
identified that in the real-world governments try to create barriers to trade, which should
discourage and free trade should be promoted.
Smith's ideas of reduced protectionist policy by the government were reduced in England. Smith
proposed that competition is very important for the society, as it promotes efficiency, better reward
system, which further promotesthe welfare of the nation. Therefore, interference of the
governments should be minimum. However, Smith’s does not restrict governments from
undertaking necessary projects which are critical for private enterprise. He also favored the
NavigationActs, which were at that time necessity for marine services and national defense.
Smith’s ideas and thoughts have a significant place in the history of trade. He not only promoted
international trade but also gave the idea of social responsibility and economic freedom.
2.1.3.3.Comparative Advantage Theory
After the publication of Adam Smith book, many economists enriched this theory by their valuable
contributions. The most notable among them was David Ricardo. David Ricardo (1817) improved
the absolute advantage theory by restating the Comparative Advantage Theory. The theory
suggests that efficiency in resource utilization will help countries to increase its productivity. The
27
trade should be done by comparing the opportunity cost if a country has a lower opportunity cost
in producing certain goods it should export those goods. Smith (1776) suggeststhat if a nation
had an absolute advantage in both goods than they might have no benefits from international trade.
But Ricardo suggests superior country produce those goods in which it had a more absolute
advantage and import those goods in which it had a greater absolute disadvantage. The theory of
comparative advantage has some serious implication because it suggests that if the country does
not have an absolute advantage in any good it still can participate in international trade and
contribute to national and international welfare. Ricardo contended a country can export good and
gain profit even though it cannot produce a single productata lower cost. In the real world, it cannot
be true as according to Adam Smith a country should specialize in the production of those goods
which it can produce atthe lowest cost.
The principle of comparative advantage specifies the advantages of specialization and division of
labor between countries and individuals. It is also a very important model of international trade,
which explains the reason for the existence of trade and the mechanism through which it can
increase the welfare of the country. The Ricardian model is very useful, butstill, it has some
deficiencies. There are two major shortcomings in this model. Firstly, it predictsa high level of
specialization, but in the realworld, it is not possible that a country only produces one product, but
they produce many goods in which import-competing goods are also included.
The reason behind this that when the factor of production moves from one industry to another, the
opportunity cost of the individualunit other industry increases, this concept is called diminishing
returns to scale. The reason forthe increased cost is due to variation in the quality and quantity of
the suitability of each factor in that particular industry. Under these situations in the country can
only specialize up to a certain point, appoint at which gains from specialization equals its cost.
Therefore, a country cannot specialize in every industry it had. The second problem is that this
theory does not explain the reason for the differencein production of different countries. This
problem is solved with the introduction of the factor endowment theory.
The core determinant of trade in the Ricardian model is labor cost, lower labor cost in the
production of a specific commodity will be a commodity. The theory was tested in 1952 by
MacDougall by using data from the US and Great Britain from 1937 of 25 productivity industries.
In order to compare exports with labor productivity. The results were not consistent with the
28
simple Ricardian modelbut were supporting the Ricardian general argument, which suggests that
the difference in labor productivity is the major determinant of comparative advantage.
2.1.3.4.The Factor EndowmentsTheory
The Ricardian model suggests adifference in labor productivity in different countries, but they did
not give areason for this difference. In the twenty century, the Heckscher-Ohlin(HO)theory of
comparative advantage was developed by Swedish economists – Heckscher (1919) and Ohlin
(1933) as an alternative to the Ricardian model and provide justification and explained that the
labor productivity difference between countriesis dueto the differences in factor endowmentof
these countries.According to this model goods require different factors for their production, the
country had a comparativeadvantage in the production and latterly exports of those goods in which
they are well endowed, as the factor abundance will able them to produce goods in a cost-
effectivemanner. The HO model identified two major factors of production, capital, and labor,
whereas, in the Ricardianmodel, labor was the only factor of production. The HO model also
assumes that countries have the same type of technology, but they apply different production
methods in which different combination labor and capital are utilized. This is because of price
differences of a different factor of production. The production and trade pattern is therefore
dependent on the factor endowment. This model is expanded by three theorems which are the
factor price equalization, Stolper-Samuelson, and the Rybczynski theorem.
2.1.3.4.1.The Factor Price Equalization Theorem
This theorem states that due to free trade between countries, the difference in the factor endowment
will be equalized. In the case of free trade,the production of comparative advantage goods
increases, which increase the demand for the abundance factor increase, this increase the price of
that factor. Moreover, the prices of comparative disadvantage factor decrease due to its decrease
demand and less utilization in the production. This will increase rents, and decrease labor wages
in countries where labor is abundant, the opposite happens in capital-intensive countries. Before
free trade wage rates were high and rental rates were lowest in the capital-intensive country, but
after the freetrade, the prices of both factors move to the equalization. However, in order to get
factor prices to equalization certain conditions must be fulfilled. These include the elimination of
trade barriers and transportation cost and uniform technology. The major implication of this
theorem is that it is valid in case the prices of different factors are in different countries. Investment
29
abroad is not needed in case of factor price equalization. But in reality, many hurdles are there
which hinder complete price equalization of factors. (Hymer,1960/1976). Despite
certainlimitations, this theorem is very useful in explaining the effects of free trade on overcoming
income gaps of different countries. The useful conclusion of the theorem is that after the formation
of trade bloc the low-income country will benefit more as compared to a high-income country.
The developing and underdeveloped countries can increase their income level by relaxing
international trade barriers.
2.1.3.4.2. The Stolper-Samuelson Theorem
The theorem predicts linkage of international trade to the distribution of income in the country.
This theorem states that free trade increase income or the price of an abundant factor and decrease
the income of scarce factor, so the abundant factor will gain and scarce factor will lose in the
international trade. Scarce factor, because internationaltrade has to compete with its foreign rival.
Despitethe immovability of labor, its value is added to the prices of the product. So, in the case of
international trade one –factor model everyone is in a win-win situation. But in the case of the two-
factormodel, one factor will gain and others will lose. It is important to understand that in the case
of free trade the scarce resource loses, but the country will overall gain. In order to attain the true
benefit of free trade, the government should apply an effective tax policy. To avoid the
accumulation of money in a few hands.
2.1.3.4.3. The Rybczynski Theorem
This theorem states that keeping the prices constant increase in a factor will increase the output of
goods in the greater proportion which uses that factor and decreases the production of goods that
uses the other factor. If a country’s stock of capital increases and labor remains unchanged. This
result in an increase in capital-intensive goods and a decrease in labor-intensive goods. The major
implication of this theorem is that a country can influence and change its factor endowment with
the help of changing its investment patterns
According to absolute advantage theory and comparative advantage theory factor of
production are fixed, which is said to be the theories of classical the economics. The HO theory,
which is said to be a neo-classical theory, as is based upon the Ricardian theory of comparative
30
advantage. The model is very simple and appealing and makes sense and self-evident. However,
this model was challenged by empirical test by Leontief in the caseof the US market.
2.1.3.5. Leontief Paradox
Leontief (1953)empirically tested the HO model, and in 1973 gained a NobelPrize for his
work.The expected results for the Leontief work was that as the US is a capital-intensivecountry,
therefore, it should export more capital-intensive goods and import labor-intensive goods. But,
results were opposite of his expectation. The US was exporting more labor-intensive goods than
capital-intensiveIn order to reconcile the results of Leontief with HO Model, many economistshave
tried their best. The first attempt was made by Leontief himself and explained that as labor
productivity of US labor is three times better than the rest of the world, therefore the produce goods
three times more than the other countries of the world.But actually, he overstated the labor
productivity of US labor.
As according to Kreinen(1965),US labor is superior to the rest of the world but it is not 300%
better. He suggested that this superiority may be around 20-25%, which is not significant enough
to change the paradox. His finding was opposite of HO theory and was named as the Leontief
Paradox. Vanek (1968) tries to challenge the paradox and added that as the US is scarce in natural
resources and abounded in capital and labor. So, importing natural resources from abroad means
importing capital in a form of natural resources. Many studies have tried to recalculate US content
of factor by excluding the natural resource, but the results were not significant enough to challenge
the paradox.
Another issue with Leontief paradox was that, due to non-availability of foreign data he used factor
content of imports competing for goods of US, Instead of actual import data. As in the case of
textile sector, Leontief calculated factor content of textile products which are competing with
imports, instead of taking factor content of the textile industry abroad. In reality, it is possible that
the textile industry would be capital intensive in the US market but labor intensive in Mexico. In
reality, many economists believe that factor reversal is not significant. Many other explanations
were tried to reverse the paradox and prove the validity of the HOmodel. many other theories were
developed afterward,These theories include ProductLife CycleTheory, country similarity theory,
andNew trade theory.
31
2.1.3.6. Country Similar Theory
Linder (1961) introduced the Country Similarity theory,which was different from other theories as
it explained the demand side of thetrade. This theory suggests that increased trade between
countries occurs when they have similar characteristics and demand patterns. This theory is based
on two assumptions. According to the first assumption, the country only produces and export
those goods which have a significant domestic market. Firstly, they produce goods to serve home
market, but in order to be cost-effective, they increase their production for achieving economies
of scale. Therefore, they produce more than domestic market demand.
The second assumption is that countries exports to those foreign countries which have a
similar level of income and tastes. They try to produce products for their domestic market and
export part of that production to countries with similar demand pattern. The first assumption is
similar to the first stage of the product lifecycle theory of international trade. This view is obsolete
as in the modern world countries try to satisfy the global demand rather than a domestic one. For
example, the major exporter of artificial Christmas tree is China, which is a non-Christian country.
Moreover, thesecond assumption was also not valid as two countries which have similar incomes
and demand patterns, then why one country produces a specific product. Actually, the origin of
the product is not clearly explained in the Linder model. In order to understand the difference, we
have to know the factor endowments and technological facilities of different countries which are
clearly explained in the HO model. These are some limitations of the Linder theory, but still, it is
providing a valuable explanation of different trade patterns in different countries. According to the
model, much of the trade happens betweenhigh-income countries and most of this trade
composition of similar products.
There are basically two dissimilarities between Linder theory and HO theory. HO theory suggests
that countries trade due to dissimilarities between factor endowment these differences create
greater differences in factor prices. Whereas, Linder suggests that countries trade because of
similarities in tastes and income level. Secondly, the HO theory regards exports and imports to be
different products. Whereas, in Linder theory exports and imports of countries are similar products.
These differences are the due difference in the perspective difference between these theories.
32
As Linder model explains the demand side and HO model explains the production side.
The Lindertheory provides two important variables – economy of scale and domestic demand. For
the explanation of international trade patterns. The variable economies of scale are explained in
intra-industry trade theory and domestic demand are detailed explained in the Porter (1990)
diamond model.
2.1.3.7. Product Cycle Theory
Vernon (1960) presented this theory and suggested that goods which are produced in a country go
through a life cycle which is comprised of introduction, growth, maturity, and decline. The
comparative advantage of producing goods is shifted from one country to another from time to
time. The assumption of this model is that a country innovates due to some stimulus, which is
coming in a form of a threat or opportunity in the market. The home market will be placed which
provides that stimulus and also serves as a preferable place for the production of that product
In the introduction phase, a country tries to innovate and produce products depending upon the
availability of capital and labor which will be used in the production. The production will be
domestically produced. So that team of skilled workers to be brought at the same location. In the
introduction phase, the demand for the product is based on factors other than price. The innovative
firm can chargehigh prices for a new product. As the market grows for the product, the producers
will try to find low-cost production location worldwide. As the market matures for the product the
price would become the only weapon for competition, and the entire production would transfer to
other countries.
Vernon (1979) in his later work suggested that with a passage of time the power the PLC model is
changing and this change is due to two reasons. Firstly, due to the improvement in transportation
and geographical reach, many producers are subsidiary business units, which are producing
products for that particular country. Secondly, changes in the domestic markets of the developed
industrialized countries, reducing many differences that previously existed between them.
Companies are not limiting their production in the domestic market now a day, companies which
have their international network and introduce new products in developmentas well as developing
countries. They grab their profit through time lapse between the introduction of a new product and
its first production in the foreign country location, which is rapidly decreasing. As the income of
developed countries is increasing which has decreased the income gap between different countries
33
have minimized, weakening the assumptions of this model. Entrepreneurs of large businesses face
different conditions in their domestic markets. As Japanese and European incomes reach the US,
these differences were minimized.
The hypotheses of product lifecycle had a predictive power in the first twenty to thirty years after
the Second World War, in the case of US it had provided a valid explanation for trade patterns and
its compositions. It also helped in anticipating the US firm’s likely patterns of foreign direct
investment. However, Vernon explained that many conditions of that period do not present now.
The reason might be the development of worldwide networks of subsidiaries of leading
multinational companies. Additional, the U.S. market is no longer a unique market among other
international markets. The model is useful in explaining for multinational companies, which are
willing to move from domestic production site to any foreign location but not yet acquired the
capacity. The model is also helpful in providing l guidelines for many less-developing countries,
for the absorption of innovation of developed countries in their economy.
2.1.3.8.Economies of Scale
The basic assumption of the HO model was a constant return to scales, which suggests the
incorporation of double inputs will double the output. In reality, in many industries doubling of
input results in an output which are more than double. The phenomenon is known as economies
of scale. This concept encourages firms to specialize in the manufacturing of a limited range of
products to get the full benefit of economies of scale.
Lancaster (1979) and Krugman (1979) developeda trade model for differentiated product
independently. If we take the example of the US and Japan, producing two kinds of cars. (The US
produceslarge and Japan produces small cars), and there is a demandfor these cars in both
countries, in the caseof economies of scale it would beneficial for each country to specialize in
manufacturing of only one type of car instead of both types. In the case of are practicing freetrade,
International trade and economies of scale had made possible for both countries produce products
more efficiently without compromising the variety of products. Two types of trade occur between
countries- intra-industry and inter-industry trade. Comparative advantage is reflected in Inter-
industry, as a customer can buy both types of cars.
34
Countries similar in many aspects have very few comparative differences are not engagedin
inter-industry trade. In this case,the HO model suggests no trade between them. But in the case of
economies of scale, both countries will benefit from specialization in a specific product. This
concludes that countries possessing dissimilar factor endowment are intensively involved in the
inter-industry trade. But countries having similar factor endowments are largely engaged in
interindustry.
The economy of scale theory explains the patterns of trade of manufactured goods of
developed countries, as in the case of the US, the products of US are exported to other countries
and same types of product areimported from foreign country. This prediction is similar to country
similarity theory. However, the production or supply side is focused by Intra industry trade model,
while the country similarity model explains the demand side
The two implication of this model is that due to broad aggregation measures are overstated intra-
industry and most of this trade disappear if products are further disaggregated. Another implication
of this model is that it does not specify the particular product to be produced by the specific
country, due to which Intra industry trade patterns remain unpredictable. In reality, trade patterns
are not so unpredictable as we can see in country similarity it is based on similar demands of the
customers of different countries or patterns can be based on the amount of factor endowment
among different countries.
The theories above are categorized as traditional theories,but, they are still very useful in
explaining many phenomena of this modern age. They are very helpful in understanding different
trade and industrial policies pursued by different nations. The theory of comparative advantage
will help and guide countries to properly develop their trade and industrial policies. Even the policy
of mercantilism is helpful for countries to strengthen their exchange rate. However, no traditional
theory can give a comprehensive explanation which can explain the phenomenon of international
trade in the modern era. No traditional theory is satisfactory in explaining traditional trade because
the modern world is much more complex than before. The main aim of building a theoretical model
is to identify variables to understand the particular phenomenon and understand the world. The
theory of comparative advantage only identifies one variable i.e. factor endowment and ignores
many another important variable like demand factors. The traditional theories were valid when
they were introduced, but are now not compatible with the modern world. In order to identify
35
important variables, several factors have to be considered simultaneously to calculate
competitiveness formula trade patterns. There is a general acceptance that these theories fail to
explain intra-industry trade, they only explain sufficiently only inter-industry trade. (Grubel &
Lloyd 1975). For the explanation of intra-industry trade, economists had put forth many new
theories which relax the certain assumption of constant economies of scale and perfect
competition. These new set theories had opened the new debate in which government policy can
play a very critical role inthe increasing international competitiveness of the country. Porter
(1990a, 1998b), hadalso questioned the traditionaltrade abilityenhance location advantages of a
nation and proposed a ‘new theory’ which clearly identified location advantages and thus the
competitive advantage of nations. The introduction of a national competitive advantage model
introduced by Porter (1990) can be helpful in explaining many important variables of competitive
advantage.
2.1.3.9.The Competitive Advantage of Nations
Porter (1990) presented his theory of competitive advantage of nations. This theory contributed
tothe understanding of competitive advantage in production and international trade. The theory
focuses on single industries which build up to the whole economy. The important implication of
this theory is that at international level firms, not nations compete, therefore we can understand
the key role the nations can playin helping theirfirms to achieve and sustain its competitive
advantage.
Therefore, home country can help its industries to be internationally competitive in a particular
industry. Interdependence of this nature will help to understand the factors involved in gaining
competitive advantage in a particular industry. According to Porter (1990), the prosperity of a
nation is not inherited but created. It is created by a pool of natural resources, skillful labor, interest
rates, and stable currency. A competitiveness of a nation is dependent upon its industrial capacity
to upgrade and innovate. The success of a country is dependent upon the competition and pressure
it faces in the domestic market, which is composed of aggressive domestic suppliers, strong rivals
and demanding local customers. The modern world had changed the concept of competition, as in
this era competition is not on the basis of physical factors. Competition is now based on the speed
of creativity, generation of knowledge and innovation. This has increased the importance of a
nation. This model states that competitive advantage can be created through the localized process.
36
In this case,the national language, culture, values, traditions, customs, institutions, histories may
contribute to the success of a nation. The difference in the pattern of competitiveness is extremely
different in each country. No country will be competitive in each and every industry. Countries
can gain a competitive advantage in a specific industry, which is supported by the favorable,
challenging and dynamic environment in that country
The traditional model suggests that important determinants of competitiveness are labor cost,
exchange rates, economies of scale and interest rates. Firms nowadays are opting for the
strategicalliance at national and international level. Managers are seeking support from the
government for particular industries. Additionally, various policies at the government level are
used to manage and manipulate exchange rates, in the intention to increase national
competitiveness. Both these techniques are categorized as flawed by Michael Porter. These
techniques have a short-term benefit but in reality, missed the true source of competitive
advantage. Therefore, a perspective was needed to ascertain the true source of competitive
advantage or particular industries. A new tool or measure was needed at that time to identify an
approach to competitiveness by making a detailed analysis of firms and industries which are
internationally successful, disregarding the old traditional theories of international trade.
2.1.3.9.1.How Companies Succeed in International Markets
The internationally successful companies around the world are devising strategies which are
extremely different from each other in all aspects. But all these successful companies, while
employing their strategy with the same underlying logic and emphasis. They had perceived a
newbasis for competition or different means of competing in old ways. They incorporate
innovation in designing the product, production facilities or new ways of marketing or employee
training, and developing new technologies for the achievement of a competitive edge.
Innovation is a continuous process in which small and continuous small advances and insights
rather a huge breakthrough are achieved. The ideas are not totally new but were not previously
pursued before. It includes continuous investment in many physical assets, development of
goodwill, knowledge, and skills. Innovation might include finding a new market or segment for
an old product which was not targeted before. This innovation can gain a competitive advantage
to the firm if the competitor is not much responsive. Japanese companies of home appliance and
car manufacturing are the ideal example of this kind of innovation. They are involved in low-cost,
37
compact, small and lower capacity models. Which was previously ignored by others. The
international competitive advantage which is gained by innovation can help forecast potential
foreign and domestic demand. Swedish companies have recognized consumer concerns for
product safety and developed different products recognizing these market opportunities.
The innovation, which is the outcome of circumstances which peculiarly to the domestic market
retards the competitive advantage which can further gain international success. Information plays
a vital role in the process of development of improvement and innovation the information that is
limited to the company or not clear to them can be helpful for success and later on gaining
competitive advantage. Innovation can be achieved through investment in research and
development, looking to an unexpected place, the policy of openness to new ideas and adopting
new ways of doing things.
2.1.3.9.2. The Diamond of National Advantage
There are certain countries in which companies are consistently engaged in innovation and
improvement and able to gain and sustain competitive advantage in different industries. They are
also able to overcome barriers to reach different markets. The reason for their success lies in four
important attributes of that country. These attributes individually and as a constitute diamond of
national competitive advantage. This actually a playing field which is developed by that country
for its industries. These attributes are:
Factor Conditions include the condition of a factor of production, including human, physical,
informational, infrastructure and capital necessary for the competition in a particular industry.
Demand Conditions include the composition of home demand and number and sophisticated
customer in the home country. For particular goods and services.
Related and Supporting Industries are the existence or absence of supplier’s industries and other
internationally competitive supporting and relates industries for a particular product or service.
Firm Strategy, Structure, and Rivalry are the business environment of the nation in which
companies develop their strategies and also the nature of domestic rivalry in the countries.
The role of governmentthe policies and procedures perused by the government to boost the
competitiveness of the country.
38
The role of chanceis the sudden incidents or events which might have affected the competitiveness
of the country.
Figure 2 1 Porter Diamond Model
Source: Porter (1980)
Figure 2.1 shows the relationship of all the determinant of the Porter national diamond
model which helpsto generate a national environment in which firms are created and learn to
compete. Each factor of the diamond individually and as system affects important aspects of
achieving success in the international market. The necessary skills, resources availablefor the
particular industry for achieving competitive advantage, the needed information which helps to
avail opportunities by deploying their skills and resources, the intentions and goals of the corporate
managers, owners, and employees in the companies and the pressure for creativity and innovation.
When a domestic environment permits and supports companies for rapid accumulation of
specialized resources and skilled workers for greater efforts and commitment they gain
competitive advantage.Additionally, when a national environment provides and facilitates to
39
provide ongoing information and helps to develop new insight into the productionprocess and
customer needs, they gain a competitive advantage. Finally, when the companies are pressurized
by the national environment to invest and innovate, they win competitive edge and able to sustain
that position for the longer period of time.
2.1.3.9.2.1.Factor Conditions
The standard theory of economics states that the flow of trade is determined by the factor of
production possessed by a country. The country uses its well-endowed resources to produce and
exportgoods. This doctrine was presented by Adam Smith and David Ricardo, which were the
prominent classical economists. Porter explains the different types of factors present in the
economy, which are explained in detail below.
2.1.3.9.2.1.1. Specialized Verses Inherited Factors
According to Porter (1990), the important and critical industries which form the backbone of the
economy of any country does not inherit but creates resources needed such as sophisticated
technology or skilled labor. The amount factors endowment a nation possesses at a particular point
in time is less important than the speed and quality of factors they create, upgrade and deploy them
into its industries. The factors which are very important and required heavy and continuous
investment are specialized one. The basic factor, including labor and natural resources, do not help
a country to achieve a competitive edge in knowledge-based industries. Companies can achieve
them through their global strategy or a breakthrough technology. In contrast to the traditional view
of merely having an educated and skilled workforce does not guarantee a competitive advantage
in the modern era. To achieve and sustain competitive advantage, an industry needs factors which
are highly upgraded by specialized research through its educational institute, availability of capital
to be invested in new ventures and moreover a highly integrated and decentralized corporate
culture. These are the factors which are not easily imitated by foreign rivals, as this requires
continuous investment to create and sustain.
Nations can succeed in those industries in which they create factors. A nationcan create a
Competitive advantage in presence institutions which are world class that creates and works
continuously upgrade their specialized factors. The major example is Denmark’sleadership
insulin and diabetes treatment which is the outcome of its two hospitals who continuously
40
concentrated on studying and treating diabetes. Holland’s leadership in flower export is also the
outcome of its research and development in the cultivation, packaging,andshipping.
2.1.3.9.2.1.2. Selective Disadvantage
Another factor which is identified by Porter is the selective disadvantage.When a country is
naturally not well endowed with some basic factors. They will try to overcome that deficiency by
finding and upgrading its existing factors, to convert them into a competitive advantage. It is
obvious that when a country has natural resources in abundance they will not use them carelessly,
but if they have a deficient resource they will try to use them more efficiently.
Japan is the ideal example of converting their resource disadvantage into a competitive advantage
by innovation, technological up gradation and creativity. The strategy of just in time inventory is
an ideal example of overcoming space and warehousing capacity deficiency. The concept of
vertical vegetation and garden is another example. Another example is of Italian steel
manufacturer situating in Brescia faced with high energy and capital cost with non-availability of
raw material. They also face problem non-efficient transportation facilities and non-proximity of
the port. This resulted in the creation of technology comprising of mini-mills which require not
much capital investment and energy efficient, utilizing scrap metal and encouraging producers to
be in close vicinity with sources of raw material and its customers.
Disadvantages which can be converted to competitive advantage under certain conditions. Firstly,
the government must properlytime signals to the companies to innovate and equip themselves
before their foreign rivals. Secondly, their condition that helps to convert a disadvantage into an
advantage is having a favorable environment for innovation, having proper access to skilled
people, favorable domestic demand conditions which send the appropriate signals. Additionally,
they must have challenging competitors, which create pressure. Another precondition required in
this scenario is a commitment of the company goals for the industry. As without this commitment
and industry rivalry, the companies will not employ their efforts to overcome a disadvantage.
US consumer electronics manufacturers faced high labor cost due to which they chose to
shift production processes from the US to Taiwan or any other country where they can find cheap
labor, instead of upgrading their factor disadvantage to competitive advantage. On the other hand,
Japan facing the same problem eliminated labor with automation of its manufacturing facilities
41
which decrease the need for labor. This helped Japanese manufacturers to produce goods at
relatively low cost with reliable quality. Soon, Japan took over the market, even they established
assembly plants in the US from where US manufacturers fled. Alemu (2010) Applied porter
diamond model for of Ethiopian Textile and identified that country is naturally endowed with large
populations, cheap labor supply, positive weather condition for cotton production, large water
potential (nine river basins). But they are lack of skilled and highlyproductive labor, lack of capital
resources, poor infrastructure,and deficient marketing and business information.
Rodrigues and Khan. (2015) found that India and Sri Lanka aremore potentials in factor conditions
as compared to the countries of SAFTA. India had asupportive infrastructure, having a good
quality of roads, air transportation,and telecommunication. Both have improved the efficiency of
their labor force through training and education. The Government of both countries had also played
a major role in this regard, by allocating a large amount for this purpose. But Despite being
competitive in the region Indian clothing industry is far behind world standards. The world-
classclothing industry uses automatic design, automatic material arrangement, automatic sewing,
3D ironing,and automatic packing. The majority of the world class units has moved towards the
knowledge era and are applying Enterprise Resource Planning (ERP), Customer Relations
Management (CRM) and Supply Chain Management (SCM). This possible with the use of
software technology such as a CAD, CAM,and UPS. USA IS USING 50 % of CAD /CAM
applications in its clothing industry. The EU is using 70 % and 80% in Japan. Which is almost
negligible in SAFTA. in order to be competitive in this industry this region seriously needs a
strategic change from ‘cost orientation’ to ‘value orientation’ Rodrigues and Khan. (2015).
2.1.3.9.2.2. Demand Conditions
There is a misconception that international competition would decrease the importance of home
demand. In practice, it is not true, as challenging and demanding customers, helps in achieving
international success. Home demand had a very strong effect on the speed of innovation, creativity,
quality, and quantity of products being produced by the companies. Home demand helpsdomestic
companies to forecast emerging buyer’s future needs to for timely repose to these trends and gain
a competitive advantage before foreign rivals. Demand conditions include population size,the
sophistication of home demand. Related and supporting industries includes suppliers, supporting
42
and training institutes which contribute to providing cost-effective inputs, help in the upgrading
process, on the other hand, stimulate other firms in the value chain to innovate. Firm strategy,
structure, and rivalry includestrategies, goalsof managementwhich are a key factor for success,
But the intense rivalry in the home market pressurizes other firms to upgrade competitiveness.
Porter (1990) suggests that large and high growth domestic market compels producers to be
efficient and innovative, which help them to gain a competitive advantage. Additionally, small
and low growth domestic market tries to find opportunities beyond their borders. There are both
qualitative and quantitative market aspects of home demand. The domestic demand size ascertains
the minimum amount of economic activity of local customer, which provides an estimation of
stable demand. The expectation of customersregarding the quality and service is an important
driver ofcompetitiveness a country or firm.
According to Porter(1990), Demand conditions help the country achieve a competitive advantage.
The concept was first introduced by Linder (1961) which helped in explaining intra-industry trade,
he explained that countries which have similar income patterns can have similar spending and
demand Patterns. However, Porter (1990) emphasizes more on-demand differences rather than
similarities for the explanation of competitiveness and suggests that the demand conditions can
help industries of the nation to achieve a competitive advantage in three ways.
Firstly, the industry can gain a competitive advantage in that segment, which is larger and more
visible in the home country as compared to the other countries. Secondly, buyers to sophisticated
demand pressurize firms in the industry to innovate for meeting high standards. Thirdly, domestic
industries achieve competitive advantage in the global market, if home demand helps the company
to anticipate future demand patterns of the other countries. It’s important to understand that not
only size of demand matters, but the pressure of innovation is a driving force for gaining
competitive advantage. As compared to the factor condition, demand conditions force companies
to interpret, respond and perceive their buyer’s needs. In some cases, the stringent type of needs
arises due to special circumstances of the country e.g.Japanese firms have to satisfy their customer
living in very compact, humid and small homes with smart and energy efficient products. This
pressure of local demand has forced Japanese companies to innovate, developing smart products-
small, thin, light and short, which is also more acceptable globally.
43
According to Porter(1990), domestic demand condition plays an important role in achieving
competitive advantage.The domestic demand shapes how firms in the country interpret, perceive
and respond to buyers needs and demands hypotheses assume that due to cultural nearness
domestic firms can perceive and anticipate more quickly the changes in the customer preference.
The domestic demand is less affected by changes in exchange rates or any other external market
factor due to changes in trade policy of destination countries.
2.1.3.9.2.3.Related and Supporting Industries
The third determinant of national competitive advantage is related and supporting industries.
Internationally competitive supporting industries help many downstream industries to create a
competitive advantage at an international level. Firstly, they provide cost-effective inputs in a very
efficient and effective manner. Additionally, this close bonding will create room for innovation
and up gradation. The proximity of suppliers and other supporting industries help in shortening
lines of communication and transportation, which result in swift information flow and exchange
of ideas for continuous improvement and innovation. This also givesthe opportunity to the home-
based industries to incorporate their new R&D ideas in their home market. These industries help
local producers to embrace new skills, providing a source of entrants increasing competition in the
market. The success of the Swiss pharmaceutical sector is due to their previous experience in the
dye industry. The success of the Japanese electronics industry is due to their success acoustic
instrument and consumer electronics. Porter (1980) emphasizes that companies should not confine
their suppliers to the domesticindustry because internationally competitive suppliers can bring with
them new technologies and ideas. The domestic industry is greatly supported by globally
competitive related industries. These industries include marketing, technology development
efficient distribution channels, manufacturing and marketing (Porter, 1990:100).
Clusters composed of many medium and small local firms provide a veryfirm corporation and
institutional support for economic up gradation (Marchallian, 1920). The local firms are more
likely acquiring supplies and other inputs from the local market, which will prevent leakage of
capital from the economy (Barkley, 2001; Markusen, 1996). Li andZhou (2010) used data to
measure the competitive advantage of China in 179 countries, the results suggested that integrity
of and assessment of market trend creates competitive advantage through market diversification,
44
cost reduction and differentiation . Yamin et al. (1999) worked on data from Australian firms and
favors at Porter’s general strategies.
Rodrigues and Khan.( 2015) used data on textile and clothing sector form SAFTA countries and
suggested that in order to improve the competitiveness of this region depends largely on
infrastructural development including a steady flow of electricity, paved roads, ports,highways and
administration forms and standardization of customer data. In order to improve export shipping
documentation should be processed quickly to minimize transaction cost in terms of money and
time. India is suffering 37% cost disadvantage due to poor shipping containers from
Mumbai/Chennai to the east coast of the USA, relative to similar container shipments from
Shanghai. This cost disadvantage arises from inefficiencies and delays at Indian ports. This can be
improved by introducing proper government policies which help in technological up gradation in
the clothing and textile sector. The policies of Bangladesh, India, and Pakistan should be focused
on reducing tariffs on imports of equipment, machinery and also provide cash and credit support
to modernize this sector. Alemu (2010) identified that establishment of ETGAMA, USAID
AGOA + VEGA project had a positive impact on the Ethiopian textile industry. But the industry
has very few suppliers of raw material other than cotton and apparel accessories (ETGAMA, 2009;
ITC, 2009). They have very poor integration of raw material and industrial production. Firms are
poorly vertically integrated and lack of research have avery bad impact on the industry.
Oh and Rhee (2010) suggested that Koreans car manufactured had achieved competitive advantage
by adopting the strategy of cost leadership. Feng et al. (2010) used data from Chinafrom 2008 to
2009 and suggested that continuous participation of customer and suppliers in the operational
process helps organizations to achieve competitive advantages in the industry. Bobillo et al. (2010)
used data of 1500 manufacturing companies from in France, UK, Spain, Germany and Denmark
and suggested that organizational factors (e.g. capital markets, financial liaison, and skilled
workforce) –differentiation strategies approach- can be very supportive in the attainment of
competitive advantages. Rugraff (2012) used data of car industry of Czechs republic and suggested
vertical integration through forward and backward agreement and mergers to be major source of
competitive
2.1.3.9.2.4.Firm Strategy and Rivalry
45
Country context and circumstances play a major role as to how firms are created, organized,
and managed; additionally, it also determines the nature of the rivalry. In Italy, we can find
internationallysuccessful competitors which are privately owned, small or medium-sized firm
which is operated like extended families. But in Germany we can find firms which follow strict
organizational hierarchy and management practices, having a technical expert at the corporate
level. There is no universal managementsystem, it changes with the cultural, social and market
conditions.
In a particular industry,Competitiveness is the outcome of organizationalmodels, Favorable
managementpractices and sources of competitive advantage of the country. Italian companies are
internationally competitive in footwear, lightning, woolen fabrics, furniture etc., industries which
are more customized, creative, dynamic need more niche and marketing and breathtaking
flexibility that fits both the dynamics of the industry and the character of the Italian management
system. But in the case of a German management system, they are more successful in engineering
or technical-oriented industries, complicated machinery and chemical industries where product
demand is very complicated, meet careful procedures and development process, after-sale service,
and a highly disciplined managerial structure. German companies are not very prominent in
consumer goods and service in which new models,technologies, and image marketing are critical
for competitionPorter(1990). Nations also differ in the goals that firms and individuals try to
achieve. The Goals of the firm reflect different characteristics of domestic capital markets and
managerial compensation practices. For example, in Switzerland and Germany, banks comprise a
significant part of the nation's shareholders, andthe majority of sharesis rarely traded as they are
held for long-term appreciation
Attaining international success can make an industry, prestigious, reinforcing its
advantage. The presence of strong local rivals is a final, and powerful, stimulus to the creation and
persistence of competitive advantage.
2.1.3.9.2.5. Government Policy
The government can affect all the other determinants of the diamond model significantly
(Tasevska, 2006). Government policies and other regulations formulated at all levels of the
46
government can adversely affect or benefit the competency of industry and a nation (Barragan,
2005). Thegovernment policy can create or damage the competitive advantageof a nation (Nilsson
&Peterson, 2002). Tuna (2006) identified that the role of government policy can be ascertained by
recognizing how it affects different variable in the diamond model. Theirteam, which constitute
this variable, including subsidies, education policy, taxes, financial incentives, quality standards,
capital market regulations, public procurement and antitrust laws (Mehrizi&Pakneiat, 2008.).
When antitrust laws are formulated and implemented, they will prevent unfair competition and
these regulations and change demand conditions. Education policies can influence factor
condition, as an investment in education, improve skills of human resource, which will in turn help
to upgrade and improve infrastructure, physical resources, and upgrade knowledge resources.
Acquisitions by the governments can improve and upgrade related and supporting industries (Tuna
2006). Friendly governmentpolicies create an environment which helps to encourage new
businesses and stimulate and enhance the entrepreneurial skills of people. The governmental policy
of mergers and joint ventures will help to transfer technology (Barragan, 2005). It is also very
important for governments to ascertain thepros and cons associated with particular types of
policies, as the implementation of policies without proper consideration of its adverse impact will
damage national competitive advantage. Countries which develop protectionist policies for the
development of indigenous industries will discourage them from improving quality
standards.Therefore, they are not prepared for the challenges of the global market(Barragan,
2005).
Government policies and intervention at local, national and international level can influence each
of the above four determinants of competitiveness. Chance events are occurrences that are outside
of the control of a firm. They are important because they create discontinuities in which some gain
competitive positions and some lose. Lew and Sinkovics (2013) used primary data to investigate
governance mechanisms in international technology alliances (ITAs), performance outcomes and
firm-level innovation capabilities, in the hi-tech mobile market. There are strategic alliances
between software and hardwarecompanies globally. Therefore, the study tries to analyze resource-
based and inter-firm governance view and its relationship with governance behavior mechanism,
business performance,and innovation capability. The results suggested that international level
47
strategic union helps firms to innovate, develop new products, win market share and gain
competitive advantage.
2.1.3.9.2.6. The Role of Chance
Chance events, which are non-predictable and are outside the control of the firm., play an important
role in a form of creating discontinuities that affect the competitive position of the firm. These
events, political decisions by other governments, wars, climate change, inventions, natural
disasters, the rise in prices of inputs and others, have a very strong impact on different industries
of the nation.
2.1.3.9.2.7. National Competitive Advantage
Porter (1990), defined competitive advantage to be maintained at three levels- nation,
industry,and firm level. Competitive advantage at the national level is reflected by sustained
growth in the standard of living of the citizen of that country, and it can be attained by continuous
creativity in production. Industry competitive advantage is reflected by the industry’s profitability,
inbound and outbound foreign direct investment and trade balance, and the firm-level competitive
advantage is measured by its market share, exports,and profitability (JMOP 2003). Balkyte and
Tvaronavičiene (2010) divided the competitiveness to be maintained at six levels- firms level,
sector level, regional level, national level, regional bloc level,and international level.
According to the diamond model, the prosperity of a country is not inheritedbut created through
industrial innovation and up-gradation. The companies can compete at a global level and gain
competitive advantage at an internationallevel if they face challenges and pressures in the domestic
market. The role of the nation has grown with the shift of competition bases more and more on
assimilation and creation of knowledge.Harrison, Hoskisson, and Ireland(2001). suggested that
latest literature has paid closer attention to the resource based aspect of the firm in the business
context, as this suggests that the competitive advantage of the firm is associated with the quality
and quantity of resources it possesses. These resources are interlinked with each other. If one area
is weak, it will influence other areas as well. Therefore, it is important for the organization to use
its strong resources to overcome the deficiency of its weak resources through the system of
resource creation. Nater and Cini (2009) used data from economically troubled country Osijek-
Baranja. They applied the Porter diamond model to identify opportunities for the development of
48
the home industry and identify potential threats in the long-term development of the industry in
the country.
Rodrigues and Khan (2015) applied the diamondmodel to the clothing industries of SAFTA
and suggest that this industry had provided the potential for growth and employment in the region.
They also contributed that due to many Free trade agreements in the region and government
policies and expenditure on training, providing infrastructure and cluster had a very significant
and positive impact on this said industry.Mboya and Kazungu (2015) used data from textile and
apparel industry of Tanzania to explore determinants of competitive advantage, by applyingthe
Porter diamond model. They used non probability sampling technique and collected data from
three regions, including Dar es Salaam, Arusha,and Mwanza from 204 respondents, applying
Factor Analysis, Principal Component Analysis and Structural Equation Modeling, the results
supportthe Porter diamond model as a determinant of firm competitive advantage and identified
relating and supporting industries and demand conditions critical factors for apparel and textile
industries In Tanzania.
Bashiri et al. (2013) used data from Iran by applyingthePorter diamond modelin the agricultural
sector and suggested that to be aligned with international standard countries must align themselves
with the global economy, for which they have to learn ways to compete in the global marketplace
for higher productivity and quality. International trade provides revenues, which facilitate
investment and development of new technologies which increases productivity. Oz (2002) used
the diamond model of Porter to identify Turkey’s sources of international competitiveness. The
main emphasis was to improve and understand these sources and study Turkish competitive. The
study also aims to shed some light on the competitive structure of the Turkish major industries.
The results suggested that except for domestic rivalry and government policy, Turkish industries
support porter diamond model.
Grant(1991) appreciated theory of competitive advantage and suggested that despite
having some limitation of measurability and concept determination it will help to bridge the gap
between international economics issues and strategic management by enriching both disciplines.
The analysis presented by porter had enriched the theory of competitive advantage by including
the impact of environmental issues on the competitive performance of a nation in global markets
had broadened the scope of the theory of competitive advantage by providing international and
49
dynamic aspects of competition to encompass both the international dimension and the dynamic
context of competition. The National competitive advantage is the country’s evaluation ability to
involve and participate competitively in global markets. Some countries can achieve more
advantage over the other due to many reasons. For achieving and boosting economic growth they
have to identify their strength and weaknesses and try to enhance their strengths and overcome
their weaknesses. Different frameworks were designed by Micheal Porter helping nations to assess
themselves (McMahon, 2017).
National competitive advantage can come from a variety of sources. These don’t just include
natural resources, but also human, physical, capital knowledge, talent, entrepreneurial skills and a
favorable environment for the business. Nations may enrich these resources through proper
policies and strategies in order to attain a competitive edge in the world. For example, establishing
universities to increase research and development in a different field for increased innovation and
creativity. They can also overcome their resource disadvantage by innovating new ways of doing
things. An innovation capability is a powerful tool for the success of the nation in a global
marketplace. Innovation can be encouraged by the government by introducing patent laws which
encourage innovations. The government can also finance potential new projects to encourage
innovation. Another key component of the national competitive advantage is supporting industries
the presence of major suppliers, distributors, marketing agencies will contribute positively to
achieving success. These industries develop a network will facilitate the value chain of the
production processes.
2.1.3.9.3.The Dynamics of National Advantage
The determinants of the diamondmodel, reinforce each other, which creates a system in which the
cause and effect of single determinants become blurred. The home demand stimulates high growth
rates and generates sophisticated buyers. Ifthese competitive and sophisticated customers, then
decided to enter the supplier's industry the domestic competition intensified. The domestic rivalry
helping firms to gain from the other determinants of the diamond model Porter (1990). He
connects domestic rivalry the geographical concentration of industries.The majority of industries
analyzed by Porter (1990) were situated in small regions within individual cities of the countries
and few of them was situated in adjacent areas of different countries.This suggests that proximity
and geographical concentration of industries increase information flow, clarify the competitive
50
behavior, also attract necessary resources and factors. Porter (1990) also added that this
geographical concentration develops into clusters of supporting and related industrieswhich
accelerate information flow and spreading rivalry.
Factor’s creation and a tendency to move resources away from isolated industries into cluster
ones.This reinforcement and dynamic nature of diamond determinants and the added influence of
geographical concentration and clustering generate a situation where competitive advantage
depends upon the entire diamond system. Porter states that it is not necessary that all determinants
should succeed in international competition.The disadvantage in one determinant that can be
overcome by having an unusual advantage in another one. In the more sophisticated industries, the
competitive advantage rarely comes from only one determinant.
2.1.3.9.4. The Competitive Development of National Economies
Porter (1990)analyzedthe evaluation and patterns of the success of eight nations in his book.He
extends his framework to identify the up gradation of firms in the country by linking it to the
international competition. He identified four stages of the economic development for a nation-
factor-driven, investment-driven, innovation-driven and wealth-driven. Nations belonging any
stage of development at any point in time corresponds to predominant patterns of the firm’s
competitive advantage. Although these stages do not explain everything about the country’s
development stages, it can only highlight industries attributes of the nation which are most closely
related to economic prosperity.
In the caseof the factor-driven stage, the International competitive advantage comes from basic
factors like a natural resource, semi-skilled labor, climate, and condition. The domestic
competition is largely based on prices in sectors where technology is not required or available
widely. The local demand for export products is modest and the economy is very sensitive to
exchange rate and economic cycles. The range of industries is widened with the passage of time,
creating domestic-oriented industries through import substitution. Industries in this stage lack
international competitiveness.
51
In the investment-drivenstage,the economyis characterized by the ability and willingness of
the public and sectors for aggressive investment. Firms construct modern facilities and import
technology from abroad, they have the potentialto absorb and upgrade foreign technology
according to their particular needs.These firms, governments, and citizens are also willing to invest
in education, infrastructure,and other mechanics in order to create advanced factors. Firm’s
strategy,structure, and rivalry is another source of competitive advantage for domestic firms. There
is an increasing demand for export goods, but demand sophistication is still very low and
supportingand related industries are very underdeveloped. Countries at this stage of development
can devisethe role of government in the form of temporary protection measures and capital aids.
The innovation-driven stage is a situation in which all the determinants of the diamond framework
are at work. The nation is very competitive in a wide range of industries, having deeper clusters
and even the establishment of an entirely new range of industries. Due to demanding and
knowledgeable customers and skilled human resource and infrastructure Sophisticated service
industriesdeveloped. Firms create innovative goods, production, and technological methods in
order to compete in more differentiated segments.International strategies,develop firms, design
their own international distribution and marketing networks, establishing their brands. This also
accelerates foreign direct investment which increases investment in many factors. Industries in this
state are less affected by exchange rate and price shocks in the world market. The economy of the
country is less dependent on fewer sectors. The role of the government is indirect, which
emphasizes more on up gradation of advanced factors, improvement in home demand and in the
domestic rivalry.
The fourth stage is a wealth drivenstage in which firms start to lose its competitive advantage in
many industries due to intense international competition. There is a decrease in the rivalry as
businesses are trying to preserve their position. There is less motivation for investment and
desperate need for the role of government for the protection of the status quo. Slower production
will lead to increase in wages, mergers and acquisitions will try to preserve stability, businesses
are less willing to take the risk., especially in starting a new venture or transforming an existing
one.The international competitive advantage of many industries starts to diminish causing a
declustering, where the loss of position of one industry affects all the others in its cluster. The
range of competition of the industries where the nation can compete will limit only those industries
52
which are related to personal wealth, industries where there is no technological change occurs,
basic factor or where national brands are still strong.
Porter(1990)used analysis of ten countries and categorized them according to their development
stage, he categorized Singapore in the factor-driven stage, while Korea to be moved to the
investment-driven stage. In 1960 Denmark, in1970 Japan, in 1980 Italy and Sweden soon after
the second world was moved to the innovation-driven stage. Switzerland, USA, and Germany had
moved to the innovation-driven stage before the second world war,while the UK is viewed to be
at this stage for decades (Porter, 1990: 570-572).
2.1.3.9.5. Applications of the Diamond Framework
Porter (1990) applied the diamond model in his book “The Competitive Advantage of Nations”.
He devoted three chapter to the detailed analysis of eight out of ten nations which were included
in his original work. His application cannot regard as testing of theory, as these are the nations
providing the empirical analysissince its inception. A short summary of his work will help
understand how he had applied this framework. Porter (1990) Particularemphasis was placed
particularlyon the European countries, especially Sweden and Switzerland,Italy, which had an
industrial structure of clusters and Germany, that is a major supplier and market for many
industries in the world. The other four countries-USA, Korea, Japan,andthe UK were briefly
examined. Porter had also applied his model on a number of other countries the most prominent
are New Zealand and Canada.
The first nation whichPorter declared as post world war –II winner was Switzerland, which was
very competitive in a wide range of service and manufacturing industries. Natural resources havea
very little contribution to the success of this nation.The only advance resource available was its
pleasant landscape and hydropower. Political neutrality and location advantage are as important
as skilled and educated human resource. Easily available credit and low-interest rate along with
world-class infrastructure and transportation system were basic factors which had played a major
role in the success of Switzerland economy. These basic factors were upgraded with the help of its
education system, extensivein-house training of the employees, the highlydeveloped
apprenticeship system, as well as the extensive in-house training of employees. The research work
53
at universities, especially in physics and chemistry will aid related industries, while close ties with
international research centers guarantee the assimilation of foreign technologies.
The Demand conditions of the Swiss market had played a major role in its success. The climate
and geographical conditions have resulted in a sophisticated demand for railway equipment, heat
controlling industries. The presence of multi-cultures, including French, Italian, German and has
resulted in the generationof many important competitive industries. Firms from related and
supporting industries have also initiated the creation of competitive industries. Additionally,the
interchanges among industries are open and frequent. The most successfulSwiss industries
followed the strategy to concentrate onsmall high -quality and highly differentiated segments. The
major exception was a pharmaceutical industry in which they already had a potential to compete
internationally. These firms perform very well in industries where they have close contacts with
the buyers. The domestic rivalry is the main characteristic of many Swissfirms, although many
competitions had been reduced due to carteland mergers. The Swiss government had played its
role by intervening in a modest way and impact positively, but the main advantage came from
Switzerland's neutrality in the two world wars. Demand conditions, skilled human resource,
clustering and devisingan appropriate strategy are the reasons for most successful Swiss industries.
According to Porter the trend towards innovation and reduction in rivalry are some worrying trends
and also, aggressive market seeking and risk-taking will take market share from out of favor in
many Swiss industries.
The second country studied by Porter(1990) was Sweden, which was also a post-war winner. The
country hada cluster, but avery narrower competitive industrial base. Especially transportation,
metals, materials,and forest products. The country is naturally endowed with large forest, large
iron ore deposit, and hydroelectric power. Which is very important for many Swedish industries.
Latterly, this factor played a significant role in the development of this country. The major role
played by higher standard educational institutes, the majority of excellent technical and research
universities and institutes and the early licensing of foreign technologies all these factors constitute
a competitive advantage for Swedish industries. Due to the high wages of skilled labor
manufacturing industries have led to reconstruction and automation, the long distances to
sophistication and efficient logistic and extreme winters have caused an emphasis on energy
conservation. The demandforthe reliable and efficient transportation system, due to the long
54
distance of Sweden, high level of automation and extreme climate which put pressure on mining
and power-related industries and positively affected the competitive advantage of Sweden. The
resource-related of industries of Sweden has very sophisticated industrial buyers, especially when
they are facing certain factor disadvantages. This disadvantage is evident because of the presence
of a large state sector whichsometimes havean unsophisticated buyer and low demand due to the
high tax rate,especially on luxury items.Large Clusters of industries are also present in Sweden.
The culture of cooperation and collaboration resulted inthe development of horizontal and vertical
integration in industries.
The corporate structure of open communication and trustworthinessis also very supportive in
competing for technologically intensive industries that require extensive international networks.
Strategies designed for international competition and strong capital market are also very beneficial.
Intense rivalry is present in some industries Porter (1990: 350-351). This disadvantage of less
rivalry is compensated by Swedish open economy and its presence in foreign markets. The positive
role of government is played by enforcement of strict environmental safety laws, but it is only
concentrating on large firms. The chance events have also impacted many industries. The
problematic areas of Sweden are its less rivalry, too much dependence on some industries on only
basic factors, lack of individual motivation and loss of position of Swedish firms in many
industries are worrying signs.
The third country studied by Porter was Italy is very a successful country. It has limited natural
resources and an image of chaotic government. Italy has a highly clustered f exporting industries,
The country enjoys high market household products, textiles and apparel, personal products, food
and beverages, and metal goods and associated machinery. Many highly
CompetitiveItalianindustries also geographically concentrated, situated in with smaller cities or
regions having a home base for as much a hundred of firms in different industries. Their factor
conditions are not very favorable, socially created and inherited factors are not present. Having
very few Natural resources are few, wages, are close to major Western European nations and high-
interest rates. There is a high standard Education system, both at the highschool and university
with close links with industry, which has created a major advantage. Demand conditions are the
major source of competitive advantage of Italian firms sophisticated buyers of many products such
as furniture, clothing, and presence of consumer goods buyers for machinery and inputs.
55
The major role has been played by Internationalizationwith Italian taste and style, which was
created by a worldwide exposition of Italian designs and millions of tourists visiting Italy every
year. Italian industries have deep clusters and strong vertical relationship with its related
industries, with cooperation among distribution channels. In many geographic areas, family links
are also common. The characteristic of competitive Italian firms is a high level of specialization
and constant remodeling of products, mediumthe and small size firms with simple organizational
structure and high autonomy from employees and sometimes high rivalry at personal or family
level Industries. The Italian example proves that the role of government is not central for
competitive advantage. As many disadvantagesare created by national governments for Italian
firms. Since the local government was more supportive with limited interference and proper
investment. The major chance event for Italian firms was post world war II Boom which enables
its firms to invest in modem production technologies, without anycommitments to older
generations of process technology.
The demand conditions, domestic rivalry, extensive clustering,and Geographic concentration, had
broadened and created the competitive advantage for many Italian industries. A more effective
national government,Better functioning capital markets, and properly managed and organized
large firms might have contributed to a widening in the range of industries where Italy competes
successfully.
The fourth country studied by Porter (1990: 356), is Germany which had in 1985, 345 competitive
industries, which includes both industrial and consumer industrialproducts, having very strong
positions in production machinery. The main natural resources wereiron and coal reserves, mostly
contributed to the initial formation of some competitive industries Their role is now much smaller,
a major role is played by skilled, motivated, educated workers, technical and scientific base and
highly upgradedinfrastructure, very high standard universities, colleges, and apprenticeship
System with research institutes had led to the continuous up gradation of human resource and the
knowledge base. The early saturation and large size of the market have been the majority of
German industries. In the case of demand condition, they have an extremely demanding,
sophisticated and quality conscious industrial andend-usercustomer. The collaboration between
suppliers and buyers is extensively high on technical issues clustering is also high, the emphasis
on precise engineering and hierarchical structure has led to international success in different high-
56
performance segments. The technical orientation of the German firms has resulted in the
competitiveness of many industries which require a complex production process. The rivalry is
also strong in many international competitive industries on the basis of performance and
technology. The German government had less protective but plays a substantial role in factor
creation.
The two World Wars were the source of destruction of 34 important Germanfirms but at the same
time a challenge to overcome them and recreate a strong industrial base. These German industries
have an unusualadvantage in chemistry, mechanical engineering and physics related industries
(Porter, 1990: 379). The human capital and technological knowledge have contributed to its
competitive advantage which led to the creation of wide and deep clusters. Additionally, the two
world wars had a pose a constant challenge for German industries to upgrade major threat to these
industries are the absence of position of jew industries. A Recent phenomenon, such as the
apparent consolidation in some of the strong traditional industrieshaving subdued domestic rivals,
which is threatening their competitive advantage, and also their concerns over the ‘ability to make
fundamental breakthroughs in new scientific fields’ (Porter, 1990: 380) allhave seriously raised
questionsabout the German’s industries future.
The fifth nation mentioned by Porter(1990: 384-421) was Japan, which is the first of the Asian
country studied. Japan had a rapid success in many of its industries resulting in major economic
power. The country has very scarce natural resources (except for available hydropowerand natural
ports), industries have taken advantage of its skilled, educated and disciplined workforce, superior
labor-management relationships and constructive government. These advantages were then
supplemented by low-costcapital, by a large pool of engineers, a diversified related and supporting
industries for large firms which promoted clustering. Demand condition has played a major role
in its success as, the buyers more emphasis on product quality and automation. There is Fierce and
emotional domestic rivalry which contributed more tothe competitive advantage of Japanese
industries.
Korea is another Asian country analyzed by Porter (1990: 453-479). The competitive advantage
is primarily depended on the domestic rivalry, investment-oriented company, managerial goals,
and human resources. Demand conditions are a major weakness of Korean industries except for
the defense, construction,andshipbuilding. The last country analyzed by Porter (1990) was a
57
United Kingdom (UK) the country had an advantage in all the factors ofthe diamondmodel. But
there is a decline in the rivalry, sophisticated demand,a smaller number of related and supporting
industries and low commitments from investors and employees. The same observations are made
by Porter (1990: 507-535) about the United States industries. American industries which declined
during the last two decades had the same problem. The home market size, natural resources, many
competitive industries make around the base for upgrading competitive advantage. There are many
competitive industries across the US with clusters, skilled employees, intense rivalry, sophisticated
home demand,and strong domestic suppliers.
Oz (1997: 75-94) used Porter’s methodology for the analysis of Turkey, which is very competitive
in food/ beverages, housing and household, textile and apparel and materials/metal clusters.
Turkey’s had aweak position in the machinery industry, but strong positions in final
products.Hestudied five industries in which flat steel, clothes, construction, and glass, were
competitive whereas, the automobile industry was uncompetitive. He thoroughly investigates these
industries by applying cases study approach to identify sources of competitive advantage and
disadvantage. The results found the competitive advantage (or disadvantage in the automobile
case) to closely linked to the determinants of the Porter national diamond model. There were
certain issued raised related to the basic factors like government intervention and domestic rivalry
as two of the industries –leather and clothing grew little advantage from these basic factors., there
was no domestic rivalry in flat steel and glass industries in three cases the role of government was
more direct what Porter envisages.
A lot of work can be found based on porter diamond model. But there are many researchers which
criticize this model on a different basis. The following paragraph will discuss views and
justifications of many researchers on this model.
2.1.3.9.6. Criticism of Diamond Model
Criticism of the ‘Diamond Theory’ as an interactive system comes (Krugman 1991; Dunning 1992,
1993; Cartwright 1993; Rugman & Verbeke 1993; Bellak& Weiss 1993; Rugman &D’Cruz 1993).
58
They criticized that domestic demand conditionsdo not consider the attributes of thelargest trading
partner in the domestic market (Krugman 1990) this is not acceptable in many small nations
(Bellak& Weiss 1993; Cartwright 1993).It also ignores the role played by multinational
corporations in the competitive success of many nations (Dunning 1992, 1993). Krugman (1994)
introduced an extension of the diamond model which includes attributes of largest trading partner
at home Country’s double diamond model suggeststhat competitiveness dependent on both
domestic and foreign diamonds, therefore management of the domestic companies should
understand and exploit both diamonds, in order to be globally competitive (Rugman &D’Cruz
1993). The double diamond and multiple diamond models are simply the extensions of the single
diamond model (Dunning 1992, 1993; Bellak& Weiss 1993; the extensionis helpful in explaining
the international competitive advantage of less and small industrialized countries, theadditional
impact of international factors on the national diamond. Krugman identifies three dangers
associated with competitiveness.
Firstly, it results in wastage of money to enhance Competitiveness. Secondly, it promotes trade
warfares and development of lead protectionist policies which could result in the development of
worse government policy. Certain points of responses by many other argue that trade is not a zero-
sum game, but competition among firms is a zero-sum game. Prestowitz (1994) argued that in the
case of trade between Costa Rica and the United States Krugman is correct, but it is not correct in
case of trade between Europe and the United States. Krugman also argues that an economicfortune
of the nationis determinednot only by its success in international markets but by also productivity
at domestic level. Thurow(1994) responded that to be successful at domestic level productivity,
the firm must be competitive in the international market. The obsession with competitiveness is
very dangerous and advises connecting onto productivity (Krugman, 1994). Cohen (1994)
responds and identified that focusing exclusively on productivity has many dangers. Krugman
(1994) then suggested that in the absence ofa clear definition of competitiveness, it should not be
used for policy guidance. He further added that this debate is highly practical and intellectual, but
a little confusing. Krugman (1994) also argued that majority of economist and policymakersas
they consider trade as a zero-sum game. However, Krugman (1994) criticized for not providing a
clear difference between comparative advantage and competitive advantage as a basis for a
nation’s competitiveness. There are mainly two issues in this debate. First, the absence of a clear
definition of competitiveness. Secondly, the balance of trade balance may not be a very good
59
measure of competitiveness. Therefore,a new, comprehensive model that can selectively deal with
these two issues should be proposed,
The management school of thought criticizesPorter central idea of the diamond model which
suggests that nations like firms compete with each other. Porter’s (1990) suggest that the latest and
traditional theories of international trade and inadequate to explain modern trade patterns, this view
has received much criticism from the economic school of thought.
Balcorova(2013) used the Porter diamond model and nine-factor model and suggested that the
nine-factormodel is more appropriate for less developed countries as compared to the simple Porter
diamond model. He applied both models to three countries, Hungary, Slovakia,and the Czech
Republic and added that choice of variables for both models can influence the results of the model.
Waverman (1995), criticize the diamond model on a general basis, by trying to explain every
expect of international trade but end up with a vague view of competition. It is not able to
differentiate among hypotheses, theorems, facts,and conjecturesand thus unable to prove causality.
Grant (1991) was of the view that the Porter work is a primary contribution in explaining the
patterns of investment and trade in the modern economy, better than prevailing international trade
theories. These views are in contrast to the views of Waverman (1995), Davies and Ellis (2000)
who criticize this model on the grounds that Porter’s analysis is not satisfactory as it is not based
on core theory and lacks ex-ante predictive power, and it is a typical partial equilibrium analysis
ends up leading to a misinterpretation of the new and traditional trade theories. Additionally, the
relationships betweenproductivity, trade, exports, competitiveness,and national welfarewere,
misunderstood and are not properly interpreted.
Lastly, the new and traditional trade theories help to explain trade, but not those factors which
will determine the international competitiveness of the firms in the country, which is clearly
explained in the Porter work. The latest work of Porter (2004) also focuses the micro approach of
Diamond Framework; he calls it ‘the microeconomic foundations of prosperity’. Porter (2004)
also shifted his focus to productivity associated with the location which helps firms improve
theircompetitiveness. Thus, if the location had an advantage for production, it will help nations to
increase their productivity, which will lead to the welfare of that nation. This does conclude that
nation, then becomes internationally competitive, even if the producers located there are
60
internationally competitive. The reason is that productivity of nothing to do with international
competitiveness. Of the nation (Krugman 1998). Porter’s original work provides management with
a general framework which can be used to identify and analyze sources of competitive advantage
that firms can use to evaluate area related benefits of different countries. The frameworkthus
provides a connection between the firm and country sources of competitive advantage, which has
nothing to do with the international competitive advantage of countries. Therefore, the present
study will use the Porter nation diamond model for its analysis.
2.1.10.The Trade Liberalization Era
The Second World War ended up with a huge amount of destruction and distress. This marks the
start of a new era in which it was recognized that the increase in international trade would greatly
contribute to the development of weak economies of the world, This framework of increased
cooperation rapidly increased international trade. This economic cooperation takes place in the
different level. The first and least cooperation is a free trade area, where member countries abolish
maximum trade barriers. A Custom union as the second level doesn’t eliminate all trade barriersbut
adopt a common trade policy with non-member countries. In the third level factors of production
are free to move between member countries. In the fourth level known as economic union member
countries in the union adopt the single currency. The fifth level is a more advanced form of union
in which a single government will be formed by the union. The acceleration trade integration the
outcome of establishment of GATT in 1944.GATT was a multilateral trade agreement between
23 countries, agreed to abolish protectionist policies and increase trade integration through
cooperation among member countries.It was in effective till 1995, after which it was replaced by
the WTO.
In order to achieve the advantages of trade integration South Asian Association for Regional
Cooperation (SAARC) was formed among the eight nations of South Asian 1985 these countries-
India, Pakistan, Nepal, Srilanka, Bangladesh, Maldives, Bhutan, and Afghanistan. This agreement
was to be operational till 2006 and achieve full integration till 2013. After the signing of these
agreements' member countries are struggling to increase regional cooperation by reducing tariffs
and quotas and othernon-tariff barriers Gul and Yasin(2011). Indo- Pak bilateral trade had largely
been dominated by political mindset. Although certain initiatives from both sides were trying to
increase ‘People to People contact’, two-way diplomacy or SAFTA; but still tensions remained
61
between both countries which resulted in untapped virtual opportunities. Pakistan can gain much
while increasing trade with India, which is almost one-sixth of the world market. It is beneficial
for India too perceives as it gains them trade routes from Asia to Europe, moreover, access to
natural resources of Pakistan. Cheema and Khan (2016) suggest that the Ricardian theory of
comparative advantage explains that Pakistan and India can trade with each other to their mutual
benefit even if one is more efficient in producing everything and the other county is not very
efficient and can compete by paying lower wages. Pakistan is more efficient in producing cement,
ceramic and textile due to labor expertise. As Pakistan is medium sized developing country as
compared to its neighbors especially India.So, economic cooperation and trade arebeneficial if
Pakistan selectsappropriate sector at the appropriate time and export its surplus production.
Taneja, Mehra, Mukherjee, Bimal, and Dayal (2014) used two different approaches- the trade
possibility and revealed comparative advantage approach to measure the trade potential between
Pakistan and India. The objective was to identify certain measure for normalizing trade relations
between these two neighboring countries.
Bhatti and Taga (2014) suggested that SAFTA was signed by both Pakistan and India to reduce
tariff barriers, increase regional trade to enhance regions socioeconomic development., but still
certain measure is required to improve the effectiveness of this agreement. Omar, Saleem, Jabeen,
and Hanan (2014) Performed a thorough analysis of 37 articles published in two years (2011 to
2013) in Dawn news regarding trade ties between Pakistan and India and suggested that increase
trade ties are visible but, are on the bilateral and parallel basis. The trade between India and
Pakistan did not normalize despite signing SAFTA another policy measure. Memon, Rehman and
Rabi (2014) used revealed comparative advantage method to study the effect of trade liberalization
on Pakistan’s industrial sector by using data from Pakistan, India, and China from 2003 to 2013.
The study suggested Pakistan trade pattern be diverted from China to India, which is more
beneficial. In addition, they also suggested that 18 industries should be protected from Indian
market imports to Pakistan as they have the potential of threatening Pakistan competitive
advantage in that industry. In order to identify the factors which will contribute to Pakistan’s
national comparative advantage in trade with India, Porter competitive advantage theory will be
used in the current work.
62
CHAPTER #3
THE AGENDA OF PAKISTAN AND INDIA
This chapter presents the profile of Pakistan and India. The first section has discussed the economy
of Pakistan and India. The second section will analyzein detail the trade pattern between Pakistan
and Indian and the major hurdles of trade between these two countries.
3.1 The Economy of Pakistan
Pakistan came into existence on 14 August 1947. The country has very significant development
potential. It is located at the crossroads of China, Middle East, and South Asia. It is thus at the
fulcrum of a regional market, having large population untapped potential for trade and diverse
resources. At the time of independence, Pakistan was an agricultural based country. In the first
five decades, its average economic growth was abovethe world economy in the same period
(Ahid&Wali 2017). Pakistan purchasing power parity (PPP) in 1980 was $71.81 billion. It grew
upto $793.85 billion in 2013. Pakistan wasranked 42nd in terms of GDP and 24 in terms of
PPP. With a population of over 190 million (the world's 6th-largest) with 6% of the total
population is below the povertyline, its nominal GDP per capita is $1,428 in 2016. Pakistan was
ranked 25th in 2017. Growth in GDP was 4.5 % in 2015 and 6.7% in 2016 and 5.2% in 2017 with
the expectation of 5.5% growth in 2018, with the agriculturesector contributing 25%. services 54
%, and industrial sector 20% in the total GDP (Wikipedia, 2017).
The main issue which is threatening its economic stability and growth is decades of war against
terrorism and political instability which had seriously damaged its infrastructure and other
managerial issues. Pakistan economy is semi-industrialized, which is growing along the Indus
63
River (Henneberry, 2000).A seminar on Pakistan competitiveness by Zia (2006) suggested a weak
Competitive position of Pakistani firms with stagnant growth. As compared to newly emerging
economies. The exports are mainly composed of low technology products. But, despite weak
competitive position the economy is showing signs of recovery, which might be the result of
economic reforms, concessionalfinancing, debt restructuring, structural reforms, designing of
policies with resulted in increased GDP (Zia,2006).Currently, the country is in the process of trade
liberalization and privatization of many public organizations for the attraction of FDI and also for
decreasing the problem of the budget deficit (Pakistan Country Report, 2010).
3.1.1. Major Exports
Primary export commodities include chemicals, leather, textiles, sportsgoods, medical
instruments,and carpets/rugs. (Workman,2017). Other item exported by Pakistan are Cotton,
Cereals, Ores, slag, ash, Salt, Sulphur, stone, cement, Rawhides excluding fur skin, Plastics, Food
waste, animal fodder, Copper, Fish, Gums, resins, Other textiles, worn clothing, Knit or crochet,
Clothing (not knit or crochet), Leather, animal gut articles, Medical, technical equipment, Textile
floor coverings, Furniture, lighting, signs, Plastics, Fruits, nuts, Footwear, Toys, games, Toys,
games, Manmade staple fibers, Salt, Sulphur, stone, cement, Vegetables, Alcoholic beverages,
Sugar, Base metal tools, cutlery, Coffee, tea and spices, organic and inorganic chemicals and
oilseed (Pakistan Defense Forum, 2015).
3.1.2. Factor Conditions
Factor conditions are the backbone of any economy. They play avital role in the development
and acceleration in the economic development of any country. These factors are a combination of
basic and advanced factors. As Pakistan is a factor driven economy,Therefore, the factor condition
plays a very important role in the development of national competitive advantage in Trade. The
detailed analysis of different factors of Pakistan is as follows:
3.1.2.1. Human Resource
Human capital and its development play an integral part in the development of competitive
advantage. In this regard, professional experts have strategic importance (Debrah and Ofori,
2006).For the development of the knowledge-based economy,it’s very essential to develop human
resource of the country which reduces skill mismatch in the labor market and createsa competitive
64
advantage for the nation by enhancing economic and social development for the improvement of
the wellbeing of its citizens (Khan, 2005). The Agriculture industry has employed 43% of the total
workforce, whereas, wholesale and retail sector, 9.2 %, manufacturing sector, 13.3 %, and
transportation and communication sector contribute 7.3% of the total workforce (Pakistan
economic survey 2013).Afridi (2016) suggests a positive relationshipbetween human capital and
economic growth using data from 1972 to 2013 from Pakistan they applied ARDL and VECM
models. The study suggested that it’s very important for Pakistan to invest in education and health
sector from its budgets for long-term benefits for the economy.
Pakistan has a population of over 220 million. But it is utilizing almost or less than 20% of its
workforce on the professional, managerial and technical positions, a Major portion of its workforce
is engaged in the industrial and agricultural workforce at the frontline(Afza& Nazir,
2007).Pakistan is situated in South East Asia and the majority of thisworkforce is comprised of the
labor force, themajority of countries in this region have a labor-intensive economy. As compared
to other economies of South Asia, Pakistan is in a better position, as it is using its workforce at
technical, administrative and professional positions. However, improvement is still needed in
many areas. The current education system has to be modified and upgraded, the industry and
academia should bridge the gap and work together for the development of therequired skills and
technical expertise needed. New institutes for training and development should be established.
Pakistan is ranked 147out 188 in human development index in 2016 (Human Development Report,
2016).
The education sector is dominated by poor infrastructure, ghost teaching staff in many village
schools, poor teaching staff and very inadequate learning outcomes (Arshad, 2016). In the health
sector, government spending was 1% of GDP in 2013, which makes it the lowest spender in the
health sector in the world. The outcomes of the health sector have improved but showed very low
improvement in nutritional outcomes. Which is not improved since two decades, and even
worsened. According to the survey on NationalNutrition,the 44% of child stunning rates remained
static since 1965, with 15% acutemalnutrition in under 5 yearsof age. The official statistic
suggested reduced poverty rates. Reductions in poverty have been strong in both urban and rural
areas, and the fall in rural poverty from 40 to 16 percentage points between 2002 and 2011 is
particularly striking. This decline in poverty is confirmed when examining the poverty headcount
65
according to the international poverty line of $1.25 per capita. According to this metric, poverty
in Pakistan declined from 36 % in 2002 to 11 % in 2011. Pakistan now has the second lowest
headcount poverty rate in the South Asia region, after Sri Lanka (4 %). A large mass of the
population moved from just below to just above the official poverty line, which is why small
improvements in households’ real consumption. Despite increased growth in many sectors,
Pakistan is faced with the problems of very low human development and very low labor force
participation and economic growth. It ranked 146 out of total 187 countries in 2014. Which is
lower than most of the SouthAsian countries. Access to education is very low with primary
completion very low. Government spending on education is 2.1 % of the total GDP in 2013
(Wikipedia, 2017).
3.1.2.2. Physical Resources
The major resource of Pakistan’s is its arable land and water.Pakistan has a larger irrigation system
with 25% of arable land under cultivation. It irrigates almost three times more acres than, Russia
with a favorable climate, agriculture contributes 23 % in the GDP and employs 44% of the total
workforce of the country (World Bank, 2008). The country is endowed with a largenumber of
mineral resources and a very promising area for exploration of mineral reserves. The country is
gifted with almost 6,00,000 km² of the outcrops area demonstrates a geological potential
ofdifferent varieties metallic and non-metallic mineral reserves(Wikipedia, 2017).
3.1.2.3 Knowledge Resources
There is a dire need to increase research and development culture in Pakistan to increase exports
(Manan, 2013). There are a large number of research institutions set up at federal and provincial
level by the government, but the main problem is inconsistent financial support from the
government, lack of linkage between academia and industry and lack of funding for market-based
surveys. The science and technology board of management has made significant efforts for the
development of national science policy (Butt, 2015).
3.1.2.4. Capital Resources
The banking sector of Pakistan remained very strong during the financial crises of 2008-9,
attracting a huge amount of FDI (Wikipedia,2017). The consumer financing greatly flourished in
the country during the last few years due to the privatization of banks. There is an inadequate
66
finance to many sectors. The FDI is the major external source of finance, which can help modernize
the industries and it helps to integrate the economy in world markets. Pakistan had taken reasonable
steps to increase the amount of FDI. It is categorizedas one of the top ten destinations of Asia
(SBP, 2017).
3.1.2.5. Infrastructure Resources
The Pakistan telecommunication industry has shown remarkablegrowth due to regularization
measures. In 2008 mobile subscribers reached 140 million in 2014, which was the world’s highest
mobile tele densities (Wayback machine,2010). There are above 6 million landlines having 100%
fiber-optic network. Which provide coverage to the remotest areas of the country(Wikipedia,
2017). There are almost 3.1 million fixed line users, additionally 2.4 million wireless users. The
liberalization measures had attracted almost $90 million FDI During 2007-8 (Wikipedia, 2017).
This sector attracted $1.62 billion FDI whichalmost 30% of the FDI received by the country. The
Current growth of state-of-the-art infrastructures in the telecoms sector is due to the efforts of
PTA’s vision and implementation of the updated policy. Internet and mobile phones were adopted
with laissez-faire policy. There is a rapid increase in internet users with an increased number of
people speaking in English; the Pakistani society has shown a remarkable revolution in
communication. In terms of growth in broadband internet, Pakistan is ranked 4th in the world
(Wikipedia, 2017). In 2009 the country had 20 million internet users with the capability of
absorbing 50 million in the next 5 years (Wikipedia, 2017). Every government department has
their own website. The used of search engines and messaging devices is accelerating very
rapidly.This sector had provided almost 80000 directly and 500000 jobs indirectly (Wikipedia,
2017).
3.1.3. Supporting and Related Industries
An efficient and modernized communication and transportation system is a key for the success of
a country. Public and private investment in this sector greatly reduces transportation cost and also
generates employment. Pakistan has reasonably developed its transportation infrastructure. The
country bears a load of almost 239 billion passenger kilometers domestic transport and 153 billion
kilometers per year. The demand for domestic transportation services, higher than the growth in
GDP. The road transport system plays a vital role in the overall transport system. The network of
about 3.65% of the total road network in the country. It carries loads of about 80% of the total road
67
traffic. Over the last few decades, the freight and passenger traffic has significantly grown even
more than the national economy. But there is negligence in the other modes of transportation; the
government is now trying to improve them as well. The port traffic is increasing at the pace of
*8% per annum. There are three major ports efficiently working including Karachi, PortQasim,and
Gwadar port. There are also 14 dry ports working to cater to foreign trade. Pakistan Railways (PR)
provides service for inland transportation, which cheaper than land routes. It consists of the main
North-South corridor, which connects the Karachi port and the primary production and different
population centers within Pakistan. There are 36 operational airports in the country which handle
both domestic and international cargo (Pakistan Economic Survey, 2007-8).
3.1.4. Firm Strategy and Rivalry
According to the world bank,Pakistan had made asignificant progress in doing business
index in medium and small size business. It is included in the top ten improvers of the world. The
country has also announced a roadmap for the next three years for further improvement in the
global ranking of doing business. The country has also implemented reforms in the last three years
for registering property, trading across the border and getting credit (Wikipedia,2017).
The introduction of digitalization process land transferring and other land has improved
and became more reliable. Introduction of cross-border electronic custom platforms both in
Karachi and Lahore had decreased time for fulfilling border regulation. The government of
Pakistan has also improved accessto credit information and provided a legal guarantee to borrower
right for the inspection of their data. This has also increased the country ranking in getting credit.
Despite these efforts, the domestic businessmen still face many problems in different areas
including enforcing the contracts and also getting electricity. It also takes almost 3 years to clear a
dispute in Pakistan as compared to world average of 637 days. The companies in Karachi and
Lahore faces power outages on a daily basis (Pasha & Saleem, 2013).
3.1.5. Government Policy
Amjad.et.al (2012) performed a firm-level survey using data from Pakistan and suggested that the
key impediment to Pakistan export competitiveness are, skilled labor shortages, energy crises, poor
infrastructure,and market imperfection. Which needs a clear and practical government policy to
68
be devised to solve these problems, and help to expand the export market of the country. The
growth strategy of Pakistan followed a pattern of sector-picking for the sake of import substitution
and later for export promotion. This kind of policy results in negligence of other sectors and
distortion of incentives in the public and private sectors. There is an urgent requirement of
deregulation of subsidies and tax incentives fortrue innovation and entrepreneurship (Hussain
&Ahmed,2011).
Hussain (2017) identified that the decline in the international price of oil and gas were not passed
to exporters of the country, who are not able to take advantage of cost-saving and innovate new
product to be introduced in the market. Exporters are continuously stressed by the government to
increase their exports, but they are continuously faced with the problem to load-shedding.
Additionally,their inconsistency and lack of coordination between various government policies.
Import tariffs are purely driven by or protection of domestic,import-substituting industries or
revenue mobilization. It is not beingrealized that a restrictive import regime with the tariff,nontariff
and regulatory barriers, and customs clearance procedures which are very cumbersome and
withautocratic powers enjoyed by low-level customs officials which are amenable to corruption,
would restrict entry of Pakistan into the global market. Large-scale manufacturer enjoys higher tax
incentives which restrict medium-sized firms to attain economies of scale.
In order to analyze the economy of Pakistan this work has selected five industries. A brief overview
of five selected Pakistan industries is as follows:
3.2.Pakistan Agriculture Industry
Pakistan is an agricultural economy. The majority of its population is involved in the
agricultural activities directly or indirectly. Important crops of agriculture industry are sugar cane,
wheat, cotton,and rice. Which together comprise almost 75% of the total output value of the crops.
The largest food crop is wheat. In 2005, the country had produced 21,591,400 metric tons of wheat,
which is more than all of Africa (20,304,585 metric tons) and nearly as much as all of South
America (24,557,784 metric tons), the country is expected to harvest 47 to 64 million tons of wheat
in the 2015 (FAO, 2015). Pakistan has gradually decreased the use of dangerous pesticidesand is
a net exporter of food products except for the years in which the harvest wasaffected by droughts
(Wikipedia, 2017).
69
3.2.1.Major Exports and Imports
The major exports of this industry are, cotton, fish, fruits, vegetables, rice etc. the major imports
are wheat, pulses, vegetable oil,and other consumer products. Pakistan has categorized
aslargest camel market, second-largest ghee and apricot market and third-largest milk, cotton and
onion market in Asia (FAOSTAT, 2006; Pakistan Statistical Bureau,2016).
3.2.2. Government Policy
The Pakistani government is introducing agricultural assistance policies for the improvement of
this industry. The government had introduced increased support prices for a variety of agricultural
commodities and easy credit facilities for the farmer for the purchase of good quality seed,
fertilizers,and tractors. The real growth in this industry was 5.7% on average from 1993 to 1997
but had declined to about 4%(Bakshi&Trivedi, 2011).
3.2.3. Challenges Faced by the Industry
Alam and Khan (2010) suggested that due to the global recession, poor security situation,
inflation,andan increase in production cost are major problems of this industry. The problem of
soil erosion, water wastage, use of old and conventional methods of farming, a division of land
from generation to generation resulting to small farms, water logging and salinity, low yield, lack
of communication networks (Enfopedia, 2010), had seriously damaged this sector. The
Monopoly of foreign companies and non-comprehensive government policies are added to the
difficulties of this sector (Amjad, 2010).
3.3. Textile Industry of Pakistan
Pakistan Textile industry is the largestin the manufacturing industry (Wayback Machine,2015:
Memon, 2015).It is the 8th largest exporter of textile products in Asia and contributes 8.5% to the
GDP of the country (Factsheet Pakistan, 2015). Almost 45 % of the total workforce is employed
by this sector, but unfortunately, the productivity is also very low due utilization of old technology
and methods. The country is a 4th largest cotton producer, having the third largest spinning capacity
after China and India in Asia. It has 5% of the global spinning capacity (Tahir,2013). Currently,
Pakistan has 124 large spinning units, 1221 ginning units, 442 spinning units and 425 small units
(Tribune, 2013). The country is the third largest cotton consumer in the world. The industry is a
70
backbone of Pakistan economy. The industry is facing a very tough competition internationally
due to production cost, which is even higher than its neighboring countries-Bangladesh, China and
India. The major sectors of the textile industry include Spinning, Weaving, Processing, Printing,
Garment manufacturing and Filament yarn manufacturing (Tahir, 2013). This Sector has
maintaineda 54% share of the total exports of the country (Memon, 2015). Industry clusters are in
Lahore, Karachi,and Faisalabad are the major hubs for this industry, but the clusteris also found in
Gujranwala, Gujarat, Multan, Kasur,andJhang.
3.3.1. Exports
Textile industry earns large amounts of foreign exchange. The major exports of this sector are
cottonyarn, cotton fabrics, bed wears and ready-made garments. It is the largest bed-linen supplier
to the European Union (EU). In January 2014, Pakistan was given approval for the Generalized
System of Preference (GSP), by EU (Memon, 2015).
3.3.2.Government Policy
The deregulation and privatization have placed the private sector in very domination position for
shaping the market. The government is not playing to tackle the market imperfections.
Additionally, subsidy previously provided to the industry has also eliminated (Tahir, 2013).
3.3.3. Challenges Face by the Industry.
The industry is badly hit by power cuts, which had forced many to close their operations. The
Majority had shifted their production to Bangladesh. The industry is also affected by the global
recession, increased the cost of production, which badly affected the growth rate of the industry.
Thereis alsolack of research and development, used of modernized technology, electricity
shortages, tight monetary policy, removal of subsidy and increased inflation badly impacted the
textile industry of Pakistan (Tahir,2013). The industry is highly dependent on agricultural produce,
due to which in case of a natural disaster like flood and hurricane the raw materials became scared.
There is alsolack of technical education related to this industry. The industry also faces the problem
of lack of investment and fluctuation in the raw material prices. Another challenged recently
Emerged by the imposition of strict environmental standards as part of the worldwide response of
businesses and government for ecological friendly composition and production (Memon, 2015).
Other problems include shortages of utilities, variation of yarn prices, the poor security situation
71
in the country, inflation, deficient reach activities, use of old techniques and machinery, high-risk
averse industrialist, very low R&D labor and industries shifted to other countries, quality issues
and anti-dumping duties imposed by other countries (Shah, Walayat& Kabeer, 2012)
3.4. Pakistan Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry.
Pakistan is producing a large amount of export quality dry fruits, including Almond, pine nuts,
dates, figs, walnuts, pistachio, walnuts, peanuts, dates, raisins,and dry apricots. But the actual
exports are far less than its potential due to un-standardized grading, packaging, lack of addition
and other policy constraints. The country had started mechanization of grading packaging, but the
industry had shortages of storage facilities, which results in the loss of fruit production during
harvesting, transportation,and storage (Ali, 2012).
Fresh fruit exports had shown a positive trend during the period 2006 to 2015. The production of
mangoes and citrus fruit had significantly increased from 2006 till 2010 after that it showed a
decreased trend. But joint efforts of private, public sector had prevented this industry from a
decline. The exports of citrus fruit had continuously increased, but mangos exports decline did not
impact on the export earnings (Aazim, 2016). There is a great potential for Pakistani dry fruits as
most of it is organic. But due to itsnon-compliance to the international standards, it is not successful
to increase its exports (Ali, 2012).
3.4.1. Challenges Faced by the Industry
Poor transportation facilities, unskilled labor using outdating techniques for production and
post-harvesting, poor financial capacity and ignorance of producers, products are not produced
according to market demand and the main problem is apoor-quality certification which never let
producers improve the quality of their products (Ali, 2012.). The other crucial issues of this sector
are soil erosion and low levels of water (Abass,2013). Hughes (2014) identifies food, water,and
energy security and falling agricultural production major challenges of this industry.
3.4.2. Government Policy
The government is trying to encourage the privatesector for the development of production
centersin northern areas and also developed solar proceeding units and initiated different projects
of dry fruit processing in D.I.Khan, Turbat,and Khairpur. Additionally, they had also sent delegates
72
of exporters to participate in international food exhibitions and fairs (Ali, 2012).But practically no
concrete steps were taken., it was evident fromthat, out of many horticulture projects initiated by
Pakistan Horticulture Development and Export Company (PHDEC) not a single was associated
with this sector. In KPK where major production of dry fruit is done, an army led efforts had
contributed a lot in increasing its production (Aazim, (2016).
3.5. Pakistan Sugar Industry
The Sugar industry is the second largest agro-based industry of Pakistan. The industry is playing
a very significant role in creating economic activity in the country for farmers and sugar
manufacturers contributing its rolein the economic development of the country. Pakistan is the
sixth largest producer of sugarcane in term of acres, in term of production of refined sugar it stands
12th in the world. Sugarcane is grown on approximately 1 million hectares, which provide raw
material to 84 sugar mills.The byproducts of sugar, molasses is also used in fuel grade ethanol,
paper production,andchipboard manufacturing. Another byproduct, bagasse is utilized in
chipboard and paper manufacturing (JCR-VIS, 2013).
3.5.1. By-Products of the Sugar Industry
The byproducts of this industry are bagasse, molasses,and press. Bagasse which isused for the
production of paper or fiber boards which are used for light furniture making. Molasses, which is
used for the making of ethanol, a high-grade fuel press is used for the making of fertilizer
manufacturing (JCR-VIS, 2013).
3.5.2.Challenges Faced by the Industry
The industry is facing a situation which is very similar to the textile industry, which stems from
the government unchecked growth. The projects are sanctioned on the basis of political grounds
without the consideration of market size and availability of raw material. The newly established
units are facing this problem more adversely, because of their low crushing capacity and more
financial losses (Wayback Machine, 2015). The average yield per hectare of sugar is very low as
compared to the world and even below India, which had similar soil and weather condition. There
is also a large gap between the yield obtained from the ordinary farmer field and yield from
experimental stations. Sugar mills are also producing below their capacity. The main reason
behind these problems is that most of the sugar mills are owned by political personalities, many of
73
which were financed by DFIs which results into working capital crisis, resulting into close down
of many mills (Whizz Mag,2009). Other problems include late planting, early and late harvesting,
outdated methods of planting and agricultural practice, very low soil fertility, poor management,
low Variety of output, non-availability of credit. Khushk, Memon,and Saeed (2011) suggestthat
the growers blame that the crises in the sugar industry are created artificially to provide benefit to
the mill owners to maintain sugar cane prices less than support prices, for the generation of
abnormal profits. Additionally,they also identified that increased transportation cost had
contributed to the problems of growers.
3.5.3. Government Policy
The procurement prices for sugar are set by provincial governments with the consultation of
representatives of farmers and sugar industry, which was based on guideline provided by ministries
of agriculture and National Food Security and Research. In order to boost sugar exports, the
government of Pakistan had announced export subsidies of $100 per metric ton and imposed
25%tariff on imports. The problem is that the sugar area under cultivation has not increased over
the last few years, despite the increase in its procurement prices (Rehman, 2015).
3.6. The Chemical Industry of Pakistan
In 1950’sgovernment established Pakistan industrial development council (PIDC) for the
industrialization of the country. As a result, many large chemical estates were established,
including Maple leaf cement, Pak American Fertilizers, Pak Dyes and Antibiotics (Penicillin), at
Iskanderabad (DaudKhel), district Mianwali. This area played a major role in the development of
the cement industry in Pakistan. Later on in another estate was established near Kala Shah Kaku,
Lahore. In Karachi, many chemical factories started to emerge due to flexible credit policy by the
government. But in 1970 privatization policy badly hit the growth of this industry and never pickup
after that resulting into increase in the imports of chemicals from abroad (Paracha, 2012).
3.6.1. Challenges faced by the Industry
The industry is exposed to international competition due to negligence by the government,
import substitution policies, high tariffs, intellectual property rights and, trade defense laws and
patents, etc. ((Paracha, 2012). Adress (2015) stressed the importance of increasing the potential
of this industry as almost 17% of the total imports comprise of chemical products. Pakistan has
74
made substantial development in basic chemicals like Caustic Soda, Soda Ash, Bleaching powder,
Sulphuric Acid (H2SO4) and Chlorine and has constructed sufficient production capacity of these
chemicals to meet the needs of the local industry, while leftover is being exported. The main
challenge faced by the industry is its independence on imports, which results in high production
cost. Secondly, poor infrastructure and technology, financial resources, sufficient research and
development,and trade policy deficiencies result in weakening of this industry(Adress, 2015).
3.6.2. Government Policy
The country has a very good organized system for imports and exports of chemical material. The main
problem is that the imports are more than exports. The government should try to devise policies for the
improvement of exports in this sector (Zeenat, 2011).
3.3.Overview of the Indian Economy
According to international monetary fund (IMF) and central statistics organization India is the
world’s fastest growing economy. India is the world'sthird-largest economy as measured by PPP
and seventh largest by nominal GDP. It is classified as a newly industrialized country, categorized
as the major economy of G-20. The average growth rate is 7% in the last two decades. In 2014,
India became the fastest growing economy, which can surpassChina (ESOPB,2015). India has the
largest young population and low dependency ratio and healthy savings due to increased
investment rates and increased integration into the global economy (CIA,2017) the potential
economy of India suggest that it will be the third largest economy till mid-century.(IMF,2015).
India is a major exporter of IT-related products, software-related products,and BPO services with
about $167.0 billion worth of service exports in 2013-14. IT is a fast-growing sector of the Indian
economy (The Hindu, 2014).
The IT sector is regarded largest employer of the private sector in India (Livemint,2015). It is also
the third largest hub of startups in the world (money control, 2014). The countrystands second in
the world farm production. The agriculture industry is the largest employer but contributes only
17 % to its GDP in 2013-14(Press Trust of India,2015). Whereas, the industry contributes about
26% of GDP in 2013-14 (The Economic Times, 2014). The major prominent industry is
itsautomobile industry, which produces almost 21.28 million vehicles in 2013-14 (Share of the
different sector in Indiaeconomy,2015). The retail market, ofIndia, comprisesof $600 billion in
75
2015 and including the fastest growing E-Commerce markets of the world. There are two stock
exchanges in India-the National Stock Exchange of Indiaand Bombay Stock Exchange. Having a
market capitalization of $1.68 trillion and $1.71 respectively in ranking 12th and 11th in the
world(Bhupta, 2015).
3.3.1.Factor Conditions
Factor conditions refer to available factors which contribute to the competitive advantage of
nations. The detailed analysis of factor conditions of India is given below:
3.3.1.1.Human Resource
Population growth shows that Indialabor will reach up to 160-170 million till 2020. India has very
rigid labor laws, which has hindered the growth of the labor market (Planning Commission of
India, 2007). India is included in three large economies of PPP. The population median age is 25,
putting it in a very favorable demographic position (HSBC, 2012).
3.3.3.2. Physical Resources
India is naturally gifted with a large land area which includes regions having heavy rainfall
to barren deserts, coastline,and large forest area. Due to climatic variation and difference in
altitude, different types of forest are present. Almost 21 % of the total area covered with forest.
Forests are the main source of drugs, paper, firewood, spices, gums and herbs and many more.
They significantly contribute to the national GDP (Planning
Commission,Government ofIndia,2013). The country receives an average rainfall of 1,208mm
annually. The total precipitation of 4000 billion cubic meters annually. The utilizable water
includes groundwater consist of 1123billion cubic meters (Wikipedia, 2016). The cultivated area
is 546,820 square kilometers of the total land (Wikipedia, 2016). The Indian inland water
resources include lakes, rivers, wells, canals and also large marine sources which consist of west
and east coast of theIndian ocean and also bays and gulfs, providing employment to over 6 million
people in fishery industry(Wikipedia, 2016). The agricultural growth has increased due to use of
high yielding seeds, improved quality fertilizers and proper irrigation system, which has increased
the crop productivity, crop pattern and strengthen the backward and forward linkage of industry
and agriculture (Arunabha,2004). However, some categorized it as an unsustainable effort, which
76
resultsin the development of capitalistic farming, increasing income disparities and ignoring
institutional reforms (Taskforce, 2006).
3.3.3.3. Infrastructure Resource
In the internet users, India isexpected to reach 850 million till 2025 (BCG, 2017). The use of the
internet is increasing in men as well and women and it is spread through rural areas. The major
challengesfaced by internet service is the very low average of broadband bandwidth as compared
to developed countries. Additionally, internet penetration rate is also very low, almost 75% of
broadband are in major 30 cities of the country (Telecom Regulatory Authority of India, 2007).
3.3.3.4. Capital Resources
The Indian banking sector is highly regularized with 75% of the total banking, asset in publicly
owned banks, as compared to foreign and private banks' asset holding 6.5% to18.2 %. The gross
domestic saving of the country is usually in physical assets and gold. The liberalization efforts of
the country had reduced interference of the government increasing competitiveness and
profitability, additionally, thegovernment had open its door for private and foreign companies
(Datt.et.al. 2009). Since liberalization, the government has approved significant banking reforms.
While some of these relate to nationalize banks – such as reforms encouraging mergers, reducing
government interference and increasing profitability and competitiveness – other reforms have
opened the banking and insurance sectors to private and foreign companies. (D'Silva, 2007).
3.3.3.5. Knowledge Resources
The R&D environment in India provides a very significant opportunity for MNCs research,the
ecosystem in India around the globe due to its intellectual capital available in the country. The
competent engineers and researchers working at competitive cost are available. Many MNCs had
shifted their research centers to India. These centers are very helpful in meeting the demand
(IBEF,2017).
3.3.2. Supporting and Related Industries
The transportation sector contributes almost 5% of the GDP of India. The country has 5,472,144
kilometers networking 2015. This was ranked second in the world. The quantitative density of
77
Indian roads is higher than inmany developed countries. The roads of the country are a mix of
paved, modernized, unpaved and slightly improved highways (Wikipedia,2017). The problem
with Indian inland road is traffic congestion, the country is trying to improve its infrastructure and
building 4 to 6 lane highways to connect major manufacturing, cultural and commercial center.
The inland road bears 60% of freight and 85 % of passenger traffic (Wikipedia 2016). The Indian
railways are ranked fourth in the world, having a 114,500-kilometer track length and 7,172
stations. It carried a 23NSN average OF 23 million Passengers a day. The country has a coastline
of 75000 kilometers, having 13 ports and 60 major ports. There are 125 airports from which 66
are licensed for handling logistics and passengers (. McKinsey and Company, 2007). The Indian
mobile subscription had drastically increased with the addition of 3 million every month
(Gopal&Srinivasan, 2006). The country has the fastest growing market with ease of getting
connected in even rural and remote areas (EY,2016).
3.3.3.Demand Conditions
The increasing middle class of the Indian economy had made it the largest buying economy
(HBFC,2012). Agarwal (2013) suggested that the large size and increasing disposable incomes of
Indiahave made a profitable market. The consumer is highly informed and demanding which made
market customer oriented, but despite having a higher disposable income they have less time for
evaluation and selection of their desiredproducts, due to increased working hours. The political,
social and technological environment had transformed the behavior of Indian consumer. The
behavior of Indian consumer has changed in recent years, they are now spending more on different
items. The widespread increase of the use of the internet and social media and urbanization had
contributed a lot in this changing purchasing patterns (Dey,2017).
3.3.4. Firm Strategy and Rivalry
Poddar(2004) used panel data and identified that the trade liberalization policy of the
Indiangovernment had led to increasing the competition, creating a healthy environment for the
businesses.Foreign investors are very keen to invest in India, despite having developed economy
the country is providing excellent services to investors. The transformation of the Indian economy
from socialism to the capitalisticeconomy has made economy open for the producers to innovate
goods and services (Marketing and Strategy Article, 2014).
78
3.3.5. Government Policy
Since independence, the economic policy of India was dominated by Indian colonial experiences.
The domestic policy was dominated by protectionism, having a strong emphasis on
industrialization, import-substitution and economic interventionism (IMF, 2015)]. The policies
related to foreign investment and trade were quite liberal (Gurcharan,2002). After the end of the
British occupation,India was dominated by social democratic policies and Fabian socialism,
protectionism and import substitution. Their economy was extensively regularized, having a
largemonopoly, protectionist policies, pervasive corruption and slow growth
(Gagan,1992). Since, 1991 after the Indian economicliberalization initiative, the countryshifted
towards market-based economy (OECD, 2011), and till 2008 it was ranked as the world’sfastest
growing economy. But the growth was significantly slowed down to 7% in 2008 -09, which was
slightly recovered to 7.4 % in 2009-10. The fiscal deficit rose from 5.9% to a 6.5% 2009-10.
(Sachs,2007) accountdeficit rose up to 4.1 % of GDP, in the second quarter of 2011. In 2012-13
the unemployment rate was, according to the Government of India's LaborBureau, were 4.7%
nationwide, by UPS method (Kumar,2013) and 3% by NSSO method. The inflation rate ranges
from 8.9% to 12% in 2012-13 (Habib,2004). Poddar (2004) used panel data and identified that
India wasfacing a serious balance of payment in 1990, due to which series of trade liberalization
reforms were introduced, this resulted in a boom in exports of goods and services. In2001, the
country used nontariff barriers and technical standardrules for the regularization of trade,even in
2005 they introduced a new patent law for the protection of intellectual property rights
(HSBC,2012).
The brief overview of the selected industries from India are as follows:
3.5.Textile Industry in India
After agriculture, the textile is the largest industryin India, which had a generated large amount of
employment for the skilled and unskilled labor force. It had employed almost 35 million people in
India. The export of this industry was almost 11.04%in 2010 (Ministryof Textile India, 2017).
There was almost 2,500 textile weaving firms and 4,135 textile finishing firms in 2010 all of India
(Wikipedia, 2017). According to AT Kearney’s ‘Retail Apparel Index’, India was declared as
fourth mostpromising retailapparel market in 2009.In Jude production, India is first in capturing
79
almost 63% of the global market. It also stands second in world textile, silk,and cotton production.
They allow 91% FDI in the textile sector via the automatic route. Many foreign textile companies
had invested, and many are working in India(Business Standards,2014)
2.5.1. Production
India stood second in the production of fiber in the world. The major produced fiber is cotton. The
many other fibers produced by India,is silk, jute, wool, and man-made fibers. But almost 60% of
the IndianTextile Industry is based on cotton. The major determinant of the huge growth of the
textile industry is due to huge domestic demand and revival of the market in 2009. The prices of
cotton were increased 50%from 2009 to 2010. The reason for increased prices was flooded in
Pakistan and China. The cotton textile industry was previously concentrated in Maharashtra and
Gujarat, which was cotton production belt. The industry was facilitated by the proximityof raw
materials and labor availability, transport, moist climate,and many such factors contributed to its
localization. Spinning was centralized in Maharashtra, Gujarat and Tamil Nadu, as compared to
weaving which is highly decentralized. Till 30 September 2013, there were almost 1962 cotton
textile mills in India, 80% of which are in the private sector and 20% is in the cooperative and
public sector. There are also many small factories with four to ten looms working in India
(Wikipedia, 2017).
2.5.2. Major Exports
India exports yarn to Russia, United States, Japan, United Kingdom, France, Singapore, Sri
Lanka,and Nepal and other countries. The installed capacity of spindles in India is the world largest
after China. Despite India’s largest share of cotton yarn in the world market, its garment export
comprises only 4 % of the world market. The reason might be its local incompetency in the
spinning and weaving mills of yarn processing. Despite having large companies, but the majority
of production is fragmented in small units, which are only capable of entertaining the local market.
Other reasons are outdated machinery, power supply shortages,low labor output and the threat of
competition with synthetic fiber sector (IBEF,2008).
80
3.5.3. Challenges Face by the Industry
Oneof the major challenges faced by the textile industry in India is stiff competition from synthetic
fiber industry and also from other countries like Thailand, Brazil, Philippines, Bangladesh,and
Egypt.
3.5.4. Government Policy.
In order to improve the working of India textile industry,the Indiangovernment in 2000 had passed
the National Textile Policy. The ministry of textile is working to improve the coordination of
human-madefiber like cotton, silk, Jude, wool industry, promotion of exports, decentralization of
power loom industry, use of information technology etc (IBEF,2008).
3.6. Indian Inorganic Chemicals Industry
The inorganic chemical industry produced products of intermediate products, which are used as
inputs in many industries and production processes. This industry is comprisedof two Sections,
which are alkaline and basic inorganic chemicals.Chemicals included in inorganic chemical are-
carbon black, Aluminum Fluoride, potassium chloride, Calcium Carbide. Alkali chemicals
include-liquid chlorine, caustic soda and Soda Ash (IBEF,2008)
3.6.1. Market Size
The market size was about approximately 5.8 million tons in 2006-07. In which basic chemical
contributed 0.6 million tones and alkaline contributes 5.26 million tonnes. In alkaline chemical,
the largest segment is soda ash, which comprisesabout 40% of output. Caustic soda contributes
36% and 24 % is contributed by liquid chlorine. In the case of basic chemical, carbon is the largest
segment, comprising a share of 71% of total output. 16 % is contributed by calcium carbide and
1% by titanium dioxide and other significant segments ( Bysani, 2010).
3.6.2.Market &Opportunities Inorganic Chemicals
The domestic production of the inorganic chemical industry is increasing in India, imports and
exports of these chemicals had also increased there had been imports of 256,000 tons in 2001-02
to 842,000 tones in2005-06, at an increased 34.7%. There was also a similar trend in exports during
that period, which was about 24.2 % in 2006-07(IBEF,2008).There has been increased demand for
these chemicals in the world, which had increased the exports of titaniumdioxide carbon black and
81
aluminum fluoride. This had pushed the industry to a saturation point in many key segments which
suggests that in order to increase exports of these chemicals capacity has to be increased.
3.7. Agriculture Industry In India
Agriculture industry had played a vital role in India’s economy. It is priciple livlihood of over
58% of the rural population. Agriculture, along with forestry and fisheries, is one of the largest
contributors of the India's GDP. As per the 2nd advised estimates of Central Statistics Office
(CSO), the share of agriculture and allied sectors (including agriculture, livestock, forestry,and
fishery) is expected to be 17.3 % of the Gross Value Added (GVA) during 2016-17 at 2011-12
prices (IBEF,2017). India has an agrarianculture supported by the regionalclimate whichhad
significantly contributed tothe world food needs (IBEF, 2017).
3.7.1. Major Products
The major products of this region are spices, mangos, curries,and snacks, which are known for
their excellent quality. India shares 10% of the global food and agriculture market. India ranks first
in pulses and milk production and second in vegetable production.
3.7.2.Export
From April-August 2016, the agricultural and other processed food exports amounted to US$ 6.4
billion, for animal products and cereal it was almost 41.16 % of the total exports, for livestock
products it was 25.98 %, 6.94% of processed foods,8.32%of fresh fruits and vegetables, 6.52%
was for processed fruits and vegetables and 1.09% for floriculture and seeds. The Indian
agricultural and processed food products are exported to more than 100 countries including EU,
US, Middle East, Southeast Asia, SAARC countries.
3.7.3. Government Policy
In order to meet the growing food and for industrial base needs of India the government had
introduced a number of technical measures such as providing high yield seeds, irrigation facilities,
land reforms in which their elimination of intermediaries, tenant and landlord regulation for the
security of tenants. Credit facilities were introduced for farmers. Procurement or support prices
and subsidies were announced for fair returns to farmers. The Food security system was maintained
to tackle any shortages of food. Certain measures were also introduced for people living below the
82
poverty level. Lastly, the government also introduced employment development plans for rural
areas (Chand, 2016).
3.8. The Sugar Industry of India
Indian sugar industry is a fourth major producer of the world. It stands second largest Agro-based
industry of India. It not only serves its world’s largest domestic marketbut also provides
employment to almost 50 million farmers and their families. The industry has accelerated growth
in the rural areas of India by providing employment and with the socio-economic change (Pandey,
2007).
3.8.1. Exports
Since 2005 Indian sugar industry contributes 17 % of the world’s sugar production. Exports of
sugar were also grown in the year 1998 to 2003, but due to decrease sugar production the exports
of sugar gradually declined and in 2005 the country has to import sugar for its domestic
consumption (Pandey, 2007). India is not competitive in the production of raw or white sugar
the country has the capability for sugar production, but not at competitive levels (Mahajan,2017).
The country needs support from the government for its recovery.
3.8.2. Government Policy
It is a government-controlled industry through the commodity act of 1955 (Pandey,2007). In
1998 the government-initiated liberalization policies in an effort to globalize trade of this industry,
which created significant improvement and led to the growth of sugar mills. The government de-
licensed the industry announced Statutory Minimum Price (SMP) and fix State Advised Price
(SAP). All these measures played important role in the production of sugar. Despite continuous
liberalization efforts, there are still regulations on the entire value chain sugarcane procurement,
sugarcane price, land demarcation, sugar production and sale of sugar by mills to international and
domestic customers (Mahajan, 2017).
3.8.3.Challenges Face by the Industry
The major challengesfaced by this industry is lack of alignment between sugarcane prices and
sugarcane production, which leads to arrears in payment to producers. The=is leads needs
government support packages which are also not very stabilized. Another problem is the low yield
83
of sugar cane. Even the large-scale companies are struggling to maintain their profitability due to
fixed mandate prices of sugar cane (Mahajan,2017). Pandey (2007) identified that the industry is
facing an infrastructural problem, low utilization capacity and shutting down of many sugar mills
due to low profitability. The major problem is the utilization of sugar prices as a political tool.
3.9. Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry of India
India is enjoyinga comparative advantage in the production of coconut, Areca nut,and cashew. It
is ranked second in the production of lime and a significant producer of banana and mango. It is
ranked 8th in the production of walnut and comprises of 1.05% of world walnut production (Mir
&Kottaiveeran, 2016). Newsletter (2016) stated that India dry fruit industry will reach 30000
crores till 2020, due to awareness of the health benefits associated with the use of dry fruits,
increased disposable income, consistent quality, proper labeling,and packaging. In 2016 it was
round about 15000 crores. The household consumption of dry fruits is also increasing the demand
(Netscribes,2013).
3.9.1.Major Products
Cashew is the major product consumed in India, including Almonds, pistachio, walnuts
raisin, fig, dates,and apricot. The dried fruit is majorly consumed within the domestic
food processing industry, making of sweet Kaju Barfi and also other dry fruits are used for
garnishing of bakery products, cereals, confectionary products and desserts (Netscribes,2013).
3.9.2. Challenges Faced by the Industry
The India dry fruit industry is facing many problems. The dry fruits from Jammu and Kashmir,
which is the largest producing area of dry fruit is going waste due to unorganized markets. High
freight, income taxes,and storage charges. The industry is also facing financing problems as
financing institutions are not providing loans to dealers and growers. India is ranked second in the
production of horticulture products, but due to lack of storage facilities,poor-quality packaging,
poor infrastructure, lack of transportation facilities, power supply,andinorganized markets, the
industry is not able to flourish and increase its exports (Mir &Kottaiveeran,2016 ).
84
3.9.3.Government Policy
Due to low profile government policies, the industry is unable to cope with the challenges. The
imposition of General Sales Tax (GST) is also playing a negative role in the exports of this
industry.
After the overview of different industries of Pakistan and India, the following section will
discuss the patterns of trade between both countries and opportunities and impediments to
increasing trade between them.
3.10. Overview of The Pak-India Trade Relations
At the time of independence, India was Pakistan's major trading partner accounting for 70 % of its
total trade. In comparison, India accounted for less than 5 % ofPakistan's trade. However, the
bilateral trade picked up in 2009-10. Pakistan's positive list for trade with India was further
increased to 1938 items and the total trade recovered from USD 1.8 billion in 2008-09 to USD 2.7
billion by 2010-11. The bilateral trade balance at present is heavily in favor of India. Since, 1975
when the Trading Corporation of Pakistan, a state-owned company, was allowed to import 40
commodities, Pakistan has gradually increased the number of commodities permitted to be
imported from India. It was only in 1982 that private corporations in Pakistan were allowed to
import from India. Pakistan started trading with India based on the positive list approach which
included the approved imports from India. Trade started picking up corresponding to the number
of commodities in the positive list, which reached 571 items by 1989 (Khan, 2013). The decline
in global trade following the subprime crises impacted Indo-Pak trade as well.Pakistan's share in
India's total exports increased from 0.33% in 2001-2002 to 0.99% by 2010-11 and imports from
Pakistan as a percentage of total imports of India, marginally declined from 0.13% in 2001-02 to
0.09 % by 2010-11.The formal trade between India and Pakistan increased from $144 million in
2001-02 to $2.7 billion 2010-11.
Acharya and Marwaha (2012) stated that Pakistan and India are the two largest and
populous economies of the South East Asian, but the bilateral trade remains negligible and both
are not in the category of each other’s top trading partner. At present investment flows from
Pakistan are not allowed into India. Also, no Indian investment has been done in Pakistan, despite
85
having a large potential for cross-border investments. India and Pakistan have common
multinational companies operating in their countries. These can act as meaningful conduits for
trade and investment. Pakistan,Indiarelations continue to be tense despite efforts from both sides
for their normalization (Nazir, 2005). In an age of globalization and information technology,
which is adorned with an age of MNCs, there is a need for cooperation at both ends at
theinternational and regional level,therefore, bilateral relations are very important (Ahmed, 2004).
Choudary (1975) suggests that countries haveanalyzed the foreign policy problems of their citizens
and also different factors which have affected the foreign policy of both countries.It is also tragic
that both countries are neighbors, but they consider themselves their enemies. Additionally, both
countries are charged with elements such as nationalism, prejudice' bigotry' and religious hostility
since independence
The trade relations were suspended by the end of 1949 and at the beginning of the 1950s, but after
one year in 1951 the Pakistan currency worth was accepted by India and trade agreements were
restored (Bhutto 1972). Due to the war of 1965, trade relations between both countries were
suspended,but, again in 1966-67 trade relations were restored, after signing of the Tashkent pact
by the leaders of both countries. Although the scope of bilateral trade was limited at that time,
these trade relations were again suspended due to the war of 1971 but normalized in 1972 after
Shimla Pact. In 1975 a trade agreement was signed between both countries, also railway corridors
were established. In 1988 after nuclear testing by both countries the trade relations harmony was
disturbed. The trade relations were again suspended in2002, when India accused Pakistan of an
attack on its parliament in December 2001. After the withdrawal of Indian troops in 2002 these
relations were again restored (Mitra &Pahariya, 2008). In 2011 improved relations were witnessed
due to dialogue between India and Pakistan leaders. The reason for improving relations might be
increased globalization, which promoted regional economic integrationand co-operation in the
region. The increased bilateral trade was initiated by the business communities of both nations
(Askari, 2012).
Both nations are trying to take steps in the form of bilateral Composite Dialogue toimprove
economic and political relations. For this reason, both countries have signed SAFTA (South Asia
Free Trade Agreement) which was tobe operational in 2006 and fully till the year 2015 (Baroncelli,
86
2007). In 2012 both countries decided to cooperate in custom and recognition of standards,
Pakistan also announced to open trade in 6800 fields, previously banned. Visa policies were also
relaxed from both sides the same year.A mutual agreement was also made for business travelers
for the improvementof economic partnership (Siddique, 2013). Tabish and Khan (2011)
appreciated that these efforts will help in confidence building between these two countries andwill
open avenues for free trade and also decreasecross-border tensions. The study bySaleem,Jabeen,
Omer,and Hanan (2014) suggested that for normalization of trade ties betweenPakistan and India
there is a need for confidence-buildingmeasures for enhancing trade volumes. These measures
may include strategies for combating terrorism, fruitful negotiation on Kashmir dispute and an
uninterrupted dialogue for solving water disputes and civil society may contact between two states.
Khan (2013) surveyed different chamber of commerce of different cities of Pakistan and suggested
that they were positive about trade with India and recognize it as a major opportunity. Many of the
members havetraded with India without any hurdle at the individual level for several years. They
are skeptical of the free trade with India due to entrepreneurial weakness. They identified that for
the successful implementation of SAFTA as a strategic bloc, trade relation between India Pakistan
is very critical. The private sector of Karachi was also of the view that regional trade will be
successful if ties between India and Pakistan improve. Khan (2013) estimated that in case of
normal trade relation, the trade between two countries could eventually increase almost 20 times
to its current levels, which is $2.5 billion will be increased to $50 billion if normal trade relation
is restored in the next five years it will cross to $6 billion to $10 billion.
Table 3 1 Pakistan India Trade Share Analysis
Period Pakistan Exports
to India
% Share in
Pakistan Total
Exports
Pakistan Imports
from India
% Share in
Pakistan total
imports
Total Imports
Trade Balance
with India
1994-95 41.60 0.51 63.99 0.62 -22.39
1995-96 40.74 0.47 94.50 0.80 -53.76
1996-97 36.13 0.43 204.66 1.72 -168.53
1997-98 88.97 1.30 153.41 1.52 64.4
1998-99 174.72 2.25 145.60 1.54 29.12
1999-2000 53.65 .63 127.35 1.24 -73.70
2000-01 55.40 .60 235.09 2.19 179.69
87
2001-02 49.20 0.54 186.50 1.80 137.30
2002-03 70.70 .63 166.50 1.36 95.80
2003-04 93.70 .76 382.40 2.45 288.70
2004-05 288.20 2.00 548.20 2.66 260
2005-6 32.67 1.92 111.4 3.88 -78.73
2006-7 29.16 1.64 126.6 3.99 -97.44
2007-8 35.46 1.74 169.1 3.42 -133.64
2008-9 23.53 1.34 108.0 4.15 -84.47
2009-10 27.49 1.28 155.9 3.69 -128.41
2010-11 27.28 1.07 160.7 3.59 -133.42
2011-12 34.79 1.41 157.2 4.28 -122.41
2012-13 40.27 1.6 187.4 4.43 -147.13
2013-14 39.22 1.58 210.4 3.8 -171.18
2014-15 31.28 1.413 166.9 3.5 -135.62
Source Pakistan economic survey
Table #3.1 shows the trade share of Pakistan and India. The table suggests that trade balance was
highly in favor of India.
3.10. Major Issues in Pak- India Trade
Pakistan and India are two important nations in Southeast Asia. Despite export potential
on both sides of the border, there is insignificant trade between both countries. There are many
impediments to trade, which had to be removed for the development of the total region.The major
impediments are identified below.
3.10.1. Ill-legal trade
Acharya and Marwaha (2012) stated that the illegal trade, including third country trade between
India and Pakistan, is estimated at USD 10 billion. The ill legal tradehas flourished as Pakistan
only allows imports from India based on a positive list of 1938 items. Trade through third countries
or circular trade is mainly conducted through agents operating in free ports like Dubai or Singapore
and the Central Asian Republic (CAR) countries. The size of circular trade underlines the potential
of improving bilateral trade between the two countries. The formal trade between India and
Pakistan increased from USD 144 million in 2001 to USD 2.7 billion in 2010.
88
Taneja et al. (2011) stronglyrecommendthe normalization of trade relation between Pakistan and
India to increase formal trade between these countries. Acharya and Marwaha (2012) stated that a
large number of productsare traded between Pakistan andIndia through informal channels,
including smuggling or througha third country. This ill-legaltradehappens in goods which are not
in the positive list of Pakistan and cannot be imported legally (Pharmaceuticals, cosmetics,
jewelry) or have a very high import tariff in Pakistan (e.g. Beetle leaves, tractor tires). The ill legal
tradeis estimated to be $500 million, which is almostfive times the size of the formal trade
(Acharya and Marwaha,2012). Nakhoda (2016) suggested that the ill legal tradebetween Pakistan
and India mainly comprise of machinery parts, jewelry and textiles the main reason of ill legal
tradeiscross-border trade restrictions and maintenance of sensitive list maintained by both
countries. The main items of import from India are cloth, tires, pharmaceutical and textile
machinery, cosmetics, livestock,and medicines, accounting roughly 80% of the total import value.
While Pakistan's informal exports mainly consist of textiles, in which 88 % was routed through
third countries. The main implications of ill legal tradearea loss of tax revenues and the high
process of products due to increased transportation cost major informal route include via Dubai,
Singapore,and Afghanistan.
3.10.2. Pakistan Granting MFN Status to India
Khan (2013) suggested that for granting MFN status, traders and manufacture have divergent
views. The manufacturers are circumspect and cautious about the trade liberalization within India
whereas, traders are confident and hopeful of improving trade relations with India Engelken (2013)
suggest that the key to Pakistan’s success and escaping from economic trap and downfall is to
increase trade with India. He worked for many years on different issues of South Asian, as deputy
chief of the U.S. Embassy in Islamabad during 2010-11 and also as acting counsel general in
Peshawar in 2012 and was convinced that the only way left for Pakistan and India to escape from
old enmities is normal and peaceful trade relations. He suggested that if we want to expand trade
in this region, the region is to remain peaceful. Taneja et al. (2011) stated that in the case of normal
trade between Pakistan and India, the trade potential will be increased in both countries. They
added that in order to grasp this opportunity both countries have to work together in many areas
for tapping this trade potential. Both governments are only taking incremental steps for the
movement of goods across borders.
89
In July 2011, the foreign minister of Pakistan announced that the government of Pakistan is taking
positive for granting Most Favored Nation (MFN) status to India. In November 2012, Pakistan
announced, that it will grant MFN status to India, in principle. For this, the first step would be to
replace, the positive list with the negative list Indian imports. After preparation and finalization of
the negativelist, the next step would be to grant MFN status to India. But still, Pakistan had not
granted MFN status to India. To increase awareness and cooperation among business community
of both countries, there is a dire need for exhibitions, trade fairs,and business seminars. etc. the
interaction between the chamber of commerce of both countries had institutionalized as India-
Pakistan Chamber of Commerce.
In order to improve trade relations a comprehensive international, transportation policy is needed
for land, sea,andrailroads for the swift movement of goods between Pakistan and India and their
connectivity with other parts of the world. Certain steps have to be taken for smoothening of these
trade relations. India should relax. Its non-tariff barriers, also both countries should put their efforts
to overcome hurdles and help business to enter each other’s markets fearlessly with their country
labels displayed. The interest and overwhelming response of both countries customer were seen
when exhibition and fairs held inPakistan and India.
Saleem. et al., (2014) suggest that due to changes in world scenario no country can survive in
isolation and every country is bound to improve trade relations with each other. Currently,
Pakistan hada great threat of terrorism, which is badly affecting its economy. The conventional
capabilities of Pakistan are not sufficient to address this issue. There is a desperate need for
improving trade relations with our neighboring countries especially with India; which is a very
fast-growing economy in the region. Pakistan needs hisplatform to boost its economic
growth.Therefore,a visionary approach requires, development of an appropriate strategy which
will be based on cost-effective analysis for the nation. So, granting MFN status to India,
development of the free trade market,and mutual confidence and peaceful dialoguesare very
important steps which require to continue trading on an equity basis. It also requires an active
participation of political leaders, a neutral thinking on both sides and realistic goal of economic
stability by ignoring existing stereotypes and prejudices about each other.
90
3.10.3.Non-Tariff Barriers(NTBs)
Non-Tariff Barriers include all those measures, other than tariffs, which restrict trade and protect
domestic industry.Taneja. et al. (2011). Pakistan has allowed almost 1,9003 Indian products and
is regularly imported, but Pakistan exports are restricted to very few items due to NTBs imposed
by India. The Indian tariff rates also remained high for exports intensive good in Pakistan such as
leather, mineral onyx,and textile. In 2009 the exports of Pakistan to India were only 30% of total
imports from India, in 2010 it fell to 24 % and to 20% in 2011. Acharya and Marwaha (2012)
also identified that Pakistan is facing non-tariff barriers from India, including standard
certification, customs inspections, sampling requirement, visa issues,and other certification, etc.
Pakistan had sought clarification on non-tariff barriers which its trading groups face in India. These
are related to visas, requirement sampling or customs inspection, the requirement of technical or
standard certification (e.g.cement, textiles, leather), labeling and marking rules (e.g. processed
foods), packaging rules specification, multiple certifications (e.g. surgical instruments) and
investment-related issues. These issues are being pursued by both sides. Recently the two have
signed agreements on “Acceptance of Certification of Internationally Accredited Laboratories”
and “Redressing of Grievances” to remove non-tariff barriers. An analysis by UNCTAD and world
bank suggest that is compared to Pakistan, India had imposed higher technical barriers for imports,
including textiles and agricultural goods (Adil,2016).
3.10.4.Land Route Restrictions.
Pakistan agreed to remove its resent restriction on the number of commodities traded by land route
through Wagah, once the construction of new infrastructure is completed.At the April 2011
meeting, the Commerce Secretaries of both countries decided to set up the Customs Liaison Border
Committee (CLBC) to formalize the customs liaison arrangements. At the end of the first meeting
of CLBC in June2011, it was decided to set up a telephone hotline at the Attari International
Railwaystation for improved communication. The hotline became operational after the CLBC
meeting in December. It was also decided that the trade routes be open on Sundays to clear the
heavy backlog of trucks which are standing on both sides of the border. Pakistan and India have
finalized an agreement to increase trade through the land border. In addition to the opening of the
second gate at the integrated check post, the following steps are being taken to improve trade,
increasing trading hours to take advantage of the improved infrastructure. Facilitating movement
91
of large vehicles and containerized cargoes. Data sharing (examination report sharing in real time)
in Customs Co-operation Agreement to avoid arbitrary stoppages of goods at each other's ports
(Taneja et al, 2011)
3.10.5.Visa Restrictions
Taneja et al. (2011) state that a liberal visa system should be adopted by both countries. For this
an updated automated system, such as the Smart system, should be adopted for the screening of
visa application, also tracking the physical movement of people. This will minimize the
unnecessary harassment of genuine and potential trader.The restrictive visa policy had limited the
access, of many traders willing to trade with India (Khalid, 2012).Easing of Visa restrictions (only 3
cities, police reporting, same city entry and exit, Multiplevisas for Business Men, Tourist Visa)
3.10.6. Political Tensions
The political relation between Pakistan and India remain a major hurdle in trade normalization.
The violent partition of British India in 1947, the Kashmir issue and various military conflicts their
relationship had been plagued by suspicion and hostility. Masood (2014) identified that situation
on the line of control is closely linked to the stabilization of trade relations. Nakhoda (2016) also
identified that the main interference in the success of SAARC is the cross-border tension between
Pakistan and India.
3.10.7. Restriction on FDI’s
Taneja et al. (2011) suggested that in order to get the benefit of Pak- India trade, restriction on
capital movement should be minimized. This will open new doors for investment, businesses from
Pakistan and India, which were previously fearful and reluctant in these kinds of investments. The
investment in India is also risky due to the Hindu extremist policy adopted by the Indian
government.
3.10.8.inefficient Telecommunication Channels
Taneja et al. (2011) Telecommunication channels also need to be opened foster people-to-people
contact, reducing business costs. The current communication system between Pakistan and India
does not allow travelers to use their mobile phones in the other country. The purchase of local
SIM is not easy as it required a lot of documentation; as a result, travelers and businessmen have
92
to use certain informal mechanisms to attain local SIM cards via relatives and friends. The issue
of improved telecommunications between the two countries also was raised in the in different
rounds of talks and is expected to be part of the trade normalization process.
3.10.9. Payment and Dispute Resolution System
Taneja et al. (2011)suggested that India and Pakistan Should constantly engage with each other to
understand regulatory regime both countries. As new entrepreneurs are engaged into trade
relations, it is very crucial to have forums that bridge gap between buyers and sellers.
Guaranteedpayments are very essential for creating new and lasting business partnerships, for
which banking channels need to be upgraded and improved. An innovative dispute resolution
system should also be put in place. Dubai has acted as a facilitator fortrade and guaranteed
payments between India and Pakistan since several years. A third countrythat is trusted by both
countries had served an effective dispute resolution mechanism. Moreover, it is very important to
create new and innovated business communities to create multi-level channels of communication
that can reduce misconceptions, bridge information gaps and generate a significant change in the
business environment of both countries. All these holistic measures could facilitate in realizing the
untapped trade potential between both countries.
3.10.10.Information Gap
Khalid (2012) suggested that a huge information gap exists between both sides on products
which can be imported by both India and Pakistan. There are very few items, which have trade
potential with Pakistan and are at the positive list of Pakistan. Additionally, there are many
products which India imports from other parts of the world and not from Pakistan. Businessmen
willing to invest could enter into joint ventures without physically located in each other’s territory
as the first step to entry until legal systems are set up to safeguard investments and investor
confidence improves.
3.11. Benefits Of India - Pakistan Trade
The Pak- India trade is very insignificant in India's international trade. However, the
amount of ill legal tradeand the third world trade volume suggestsa tremendous potential for
bilateral trade between Pakistan and India. Restrictions on official trade between these countries
compel both them to import certain products from far off sources, which they can easily import
93
from each other. Asthe increase in bilateral trade would ensure low transportation cost, cheaper
raw materials and insurance cost which will enhance the quality of goods and their availability at
competitive prices for both countries. While consumers would gain in terms of lower prices, higher
purchasing power and greater choice of trade goods; manufacturers will have access to the wider
markets in the neighborhood. The Government would have revenue gains by bringing ill legal
tradeinto the formal channel. Ultimately, this would result in a win-win situation for everyone.
Trade in Electricity between both the Countries will also help in reducing problems associated
with electricity load shedding.
Based upon all the discussed issues mentioned above. The work has tried to apply Porter national
diamond model for both countries based upon the conceptual framework mentioned below.
3 .12. Conceptual Framework
Based on the above discussion the following conceptual frameworkwas designed
H1
H3
Human resources
Physical
resourcesknowledge
resources
Capital resources
infrastructure
Skilled labor
technology
Supporting industries
Related industries
Irrigation system
Home demand
composition
Demand size and
pattern
Internationalization
ofdomestic demand
Intense competition
Quality and
quantity of
products
Industry status
RTAs
Tariffs
Accountability and transparency
Factor conditions
Government Policy
Demand
conditions
Supporting and related
industries
Firm strategy,
structure and rivalry
National
Competitive
Advantage
in Trade
94
Figure 2.2 Conceptual Framework
3.12. Hypotheses
Basedupon the discussion above and the conceptual model following hypotheses was generated
H1= Factor endowment has a significant relationship with National competitive advantage in trade.
H2= demand conditions have a significant relationship with National competitive advantage in
trade.
H3= Supporting and related industries havea significant relationship with National competitive
advantage in trade.
H4= Firm strategy, structure,and rivalry has a significant relationship with National competitive
advantage in trade
H5= Government policy has a significant relationship with National competitive advantage in
trade.
95
CHAPTER# 4
METHODOLOGY
This chapter will present the methodology and sources of the data. Proxies and other methods for
the calculation of variables. Exports are the important driver of the economy, which helps to boost
the level of economic growth, the balance of payment and employment. After independence
Pakistan had facedsince its independence in 1947. At that time, the economy was based on
agriculture. The economy had shown a positive growth since independence and developed as a
semi-industrialized country, which was greatly based on agriculture, food products,and textiles.
But it is not able to bridge a gap between itself and developed countries. As export is one of the
components of aggregate demand, an increase in exports will increase economic growth. The
export growth also accelerates service sector and benefit the local economy. There are many
factors which will determine the level of exports conducted by the country are its -
Competitiveness, value addition of exports, exchange rate, sustained productivity and economic
growth. The balance of trade compares the value of a country's export of goods and services against
its imports. When the export of the country is greater than its imports the country tends to have a
positive or surplus balance of trade. The surplus balance of trade is beneficial for the economy,
but unfortunately, Pakistan is facing the deficit balance of trade since very long. A serious effort
is required to overcome this situation. In this regard series of steps has taken by the government to
liberalized trade
This work had tried to analyze prospects of trade liberalization of Pakistan with India. The study
had analyzed different industries of Pakistan and India with an intention to identify sources of
competitive advantage of Pakistan and India by applying Porter National diamond model. The
ultimate purpose was to ascertain that after so many trade liberalization efforts and implementation
of SAFTA there exist trade creation or trade diversion in Pakistan. Additionally, is it in the favor
of Pakistan to grant MFN status to India and identify challenges associated with trade liberalization
The current study had used secondary data. The panel and time series data was collected for the
period 2005 to 2015. Based upon the number of trade patterns, data for 5 Pakistani and Indian
sectors was selected textile, Sugar and Sugar Confectionaries, Inorganic Chemicals, edible fruits
and nuts, food and agriculture. In assessing the competitiveness of Indian and Pakistani different
96
industries in both countries, export performance was used and for that used Revealed Comparative
Advantage (RCA). Which was also used by Mukhtar and Javed(2009) Rattanavijit,
Somboonwiwat and Khompatraporn. (2012). The trade data which was used in the study was
collected from a different source which is clearly identified in Table# 4.1. the proxies used for a
different variable have also mentioned the Table4.1. Different variables were identified, but the
problem was the standardization of value as a different variable is expressed in different
measurement scales. For standardization of variables, z-score was calculated and a means were
calculated for the computation of the variable.
4.1. Casual Research
The casual research basically intends to answer certain questions which are related to a problem
and tries to find out the reasons to solve that problem. It also helps to identify the nature and extent
of cause and effect relationship and helps to measure and assessthe impact of certain changes on
various processes and norms. This type of study focusses on examining the situation for an
explanation of the relationship and certain patterns between variables. This type of research is
usually conducted in the social sciences. The empirical research is mostly done on preexisting or
secondary data.The current study is also based on secondary data of Pakistan and India.
Table 4.1 Variable Proxies Data Source and references
Variables Components Proxies Sources References
Factor
conditions (FC)
Human Resources (HR)
Labor force
Participation rate
World bank Wijinads, et.al (2005)
Tuerck et al. (2007b,
2008)
Education Index HDR Report Wang, Chaing,and Yin
(2004)
GDP Per Capita World bank Wijinads, et.al (2005)
Physical Resources (PH) Agricultural land World bank Wijinads, et.al (2005)
Gawad, lkhteeb,
Intezar (2014)
97
Knowledge Resources (KR)
R&D
expenditure (%
of GDP)
World Bank Wijinads, et.al (2005
Balcarova (2013)
Capital Resources (CR)
Getting credit World bank Wijinads, et.al (2005)
FDI Inflows
(billion USD)
World
Development
Index
Wijinads, et.al (2005)
Infrastructure (IF) Internet Users per
1000 individuals
World
Development
Index
Wijinads, et.al (2005)
Demand
conditions
(DC)
Home demand composition
(HD)
Total population
(million people)
World bank Wijinads, et.al (2005)
Vu and Pham (2016
Demand Size and Pattern
(DSP)
GDP (billion
USD)
Pakistan Bureau
of statistics
Vu and Pham (2016)
Internationalization of
Domestic Demand (IDD)
Total export
value industry
(billion USD)
Pakistan Bureau
of statistics
Vu and Pham (2016)
Home Demand Composition
(HDC)
GDP per capita
(USD)
World bank Wijinads, et.al (2005)
Vu and Pham (2016)
Related and
Supporting
Industries
(RSI)
Domestic Supporting
Industries (DSH)
Mobile
subscription
World bank
Related industries(RI) Rail lines (total
route-km) and
Roads, paved (%
of total road
World bank Wijinads, et.al (2005)
Balcarova (2013)
Firm structure,
rivalry,and
strategy
(FSRS)
Domestic Rivalry (DR) The intensity of
local competition
Prices of
products
Wijinads, et.al (2005)
Business Context (BC) World bank DTF
points
World bank Vu and Pham (2016)
International Rivalry (IR) Market share of
the country in the
global market
World bank Vu and Pham (2016)
Government
Policy (GP)
Regional Trade Agreement
(RTA)
Dummy variable World bank Herath,
Liang,Yongbing (2014)
Tariffs (TF) Average Tariff
Rate
World Bank David (2007).
98
4.2. Variables and their Proxies
The current work had applied Porter national diamond model for the analysis of trade pattern
between India and Pakistan. Porter presented this model to explain variables in the economy,
which will help an economy to be competitive internationally. In his view in order to be
internationally competitive as a nation had been domestically competitive. The model is based on
many other theories previously presented by many authors details of the variable and proxies been
used are described below. The current study had used secondary data. The panel and time series
data were collected for the period 2005 to 2015. Based upon the number of trade patterns, data for
5 Pakistani and Indian sectors was selected textile, Sugar and Sugar Confectionaries, Inorganic
Chemicals, edible fruits and nuts, food and agriculture. In assessing the competitiveness of
Indiaand Pakistan different industries in both the countries, export performance was used and for
that used Revealed Comparative Advantage (RCA). Which was also used by Mukhtar and Javed.
(2009) and Rattanavijit, et. al.(2012). The trade data which was used in the study was collected
from a different source which is clearly identified in Table# 4.1. The proxies used for a different
variable are also mentioned the Table# 4.1.The different variables were identified, but the problem
was the standardization of value as different variables are expressed in different measurement
scales. For standardization of the variable z-score was calculated and a means were calculated for
the computation of the variable.
The independentvariables used in the model were as follows:
4.2.1. Factor Conditions
Factor conditions are endowed factors in the economy, which helps an economy to develop a
competitive advantage. These factors are a combination of many other subfactors, including
human, physical, knowledge, infrastructural and capital and resources. The brief overview of
different the factors included the model are as follows.
National
Competitive
Advantage In
Trade
(NCA)
Exports Revealed
comparative
advantage
Pakistan
statistical bureau
Mukhtar. and Javed
(2009)
Rattanavijit et al (2012)
99
4.2.1.1. Human Resources
Labor or human resource is one part of a component of the diamondmodel (Byoungho, 2004)
worked in the apparel industry of newly industrialized countries of South East Asia and contributed
that skilled labor, which is creative, energetic and hardworking is an integral determinant of
competitive advantage of the firm. Porter(1990) suggested that is not labor but the efforts of its
motivation, and upgradation to overcome factor disadvantage is important for achieving a
competitive advantage.
The success of any nation depends upon the number of competent people which have higher
competency. As these people serve as a valuable asset and most important factor of production to
create economic goods and services. As these competent people take charge of all the other
economic activities, i.e., transaction, production,and consumption, to create value for the firm as
well as nationally. Human resource can actively work as a labor force to create value, by the
interaction of other resources, According to Romer (1990) with the investment in human capital,
the knowledge and skills are transferred to create valuable economic goods and services. Frank
and Bemanke (2007) explain human resource to be a combination of intelligence, education,
training, experience, energy, work, trustworthiness,and habits, which impact the value of the
employee and its productivity. Human resourceis divided into three component-quantity, skills
cost. These three components are explained below
4.2.1.1.1.Quantity of Labor
The quantity of labor is an absolute term as different countries have different amount and sizes of
labor, which is significantly linked to the population of that country. As Pakistan and India Labor
participation might help in indicating the effective exploitation of this valuable resource. The
increased level of labor participation ratio indicates less unemployment and labor scarcity in the
region. The assumption there will be higher wages which leads to potential competitive
disadvantage. Tuerck et al. (2007) also suggested that regions having a higher labor participation
ratio perform better. The education level and quality of the labor force is very crucial for driving
economic efficiency in the country (Eberts et al., 2006; Lucas, 1988). This educated workforce is
very helpful in providing flexibility and creativity in production, especially in the knowledge
economy (Florida, 2002; Glaeser, 2005; Glaeser and Saiz(2003). The quantity of labor was
100
measured by labor force participation. This proxy was used by Wang, et. al(2004), Wijinads, et.al
(2005).
4.2.1.1.2. Skills
The skills and quantity of human resource are a significant factor in achieving competitive
advantage. There isa limitation in data availability for this variable, but many different measures
are available in the world bank database for including literacy or participation in primary
education. In order to measure skills of labor this work had used education index of Human
Development Report (HDR), which is a comprehensive measure, including population with
secondary education, literacy rate, trained teachers or education expenditures or gross enrollment
ratio (UNDP, 2014), a significantly high index ratio indicates increased human resource skills
contributing to its competitive advantage.
4.2.1.1.3.Costs
In order to measure the labor cost GDP per capita can be used. In major cost associated with of
labor is their wages, which can be reflected in GDP per capita. A high level of GDP/capita indicates
a competitive disadvantage.
4.2.1.2.Physical Resources
The physical resource includes natural resources, including land, water,and climate. Porter (1990)
suggests that the quality, abundance,and accessibility of these resources helps countries achieve
competitive advantage. Endowed resources can be divided into mineral, agricultural, forestry,
fishery and environmental resources. Mineral resources are depleting, other energy resources such
as coal, oil and natural gas can be distinguished from non-energy resources such as iron ore,
gold,and silver. Agriculture, forests and fish stocks are renewable and environmental factors are
composed of land, weather, water,andanother natural advantage. All these resources can form
inputs into economic activities, and they may add to a nation’s international competitiveness.
The availability of agricultural land is an appropriate indicator for potential production, as the
quality of land, should be included in the analysis but due to the limitation of data availability the
area of agricultural land was used as a proxy for increasing production. A large amount
agricultural area suggests the potential contribution of this factor in a country’s competitive
101
advantage. This measure was also used by Ratinger (2001), Wijinads, et.al (2005) and Gawad,
Ikhteeb,andIntezar (2014)
4.2.1.3.Knowledge Resources
Massa and Testa (2009) found through surveys that management of knowledge resource
effectively hasa positive impact on the competitive advantage of the nation. This will help firms
in the country to use effective strategies of differentiation, cost leadership,and centralization. Liao
and Hu (2007) emphasize the importance of proper knowledge transfer in the economy and also
its proper implementation as in case of uncertain external environment it negatively impacts
nations competitive advantage.
Whitehill (1997) was of the view that knowledge-based strategies, which are difficult to be
replicated by competitors as they are intangible, and help achieve competitive advantage for the
firm. Whiteley and Hessan (1996) also contributed that application of customer-oriented approach
also help firms to achieve competitive advantage through centralization strategies and
differentiation. Adams and Lamont (2003) recommended in their study that knowledge
management, organizational resources, innovation and differentiation of products, and
organizational learning are the outcome of effective utilization of knowledge resources.Swink and
Chuang (2004) also found a positive impact on a knowledge resource on competitive advantage.
Song (2007) states that increase innovation and deployment of new products in the country will
increase the competitive advantage of the firms in the country. Knowledge recourses include the
amount and quantity of technical, scientific and market knowledge on services and goods. In order
to measure this variable, the amount of research and development expenditure will be used.
Increase the level of expenditure suggestsknowledge inputs. The proxy used for the measurement
of knowledge resources of the country was R&D expenditure at %age of GDP. This measure was
also used by Wijinads et al (2005), and Balcarova (2013).
4.2.1.4.Capital Resources
The amount of availability and cost of capital is also a significant factor in contributing competitive
advantage as it has a significant impact on productivity. In order to measure this variable two
indicators can be used – getting credit and FDI inflows.
102
4.2.1.4.1 Getting Credit
In case of getting credit, the world bank used it in its doing business report, which measures the
lenders and borrowers’ legal rights, security of transaction and credit information sharing. This
indicates measures the facilitation of lending in the country through laws of collateral, bankruptcy,
coverage and the accessibility and scope of credit information(World Bank, 2014, p125). This
indicator ranks countries, lowest rank suggestsa high contribution of this variable in countries
competitive advantage.
4.2.1.4.2. Foreign Direct Investment (FDI)
The financial resources coming from outside the country can play a major role to developa
competitive advantage as they increasethe capital resources. If the country is successful enough to
attract a large amount of FDI they will definitely increase their capital resources. If FDIs are
consistent and not speculative than they can contribute significantly tothe country’s competitive
advantage. The amount of FDI is also independent of the size of the economy, therefore FDI is
measured by FDI as %age of GDP. This Measure Was Used ByWijinadse t al (2005), Wang. et.al
(2004) Nan and Lei (2013) and Rantinger (2001).
4.2.1.5. Infrastructure
The Infrastructures is comprised of the transportation system, mail system, communication and
also institutions which affect the standard and quality of life ((Porter, 1990) p.75). The internet
access is the major component of communication infrastructure as it helps not only in connecting
people but also helps in mobile banking, retrieving information and documentation. In order to
measure this variable, this work used internet user per 1000 people. This measure was used by
Wijinads, et.al (2005)
4.2.2. Demand Conditions
Alemu (2010) suggests that the Ethiopian textile industry has is benefited by increased domestic
demand, large population and potential domestic market. The industry has very low-level demand
sophistication, due to low purchasing power due to very low GDP per capita of the country.
Rodrigues and Khan (2015) suggested that GDP per capita growth rates during the last few years
were, approximately, 5 % in India, this showthat demand conditions depend more on international
103
demand than internal (domestic) demand in the case of these countries. However, countries like
India have a large population (World Fact Book 2014), therefore with economic development and
a change in the consumptionstructure, the domestic demand for clothing will increase. Similarly,
with a rise in the middle class in Bangladesh, Pakistan,and Nepal, domestic demand will increase.
Currently, however, the domestic clothing consumption is not mature and, in the t, lacks elite
consumption group. There is ahigh demand forthe clothing industry in SAFTAregion, particularly
in Bangladesh, India, Pakistan rank 4th and 6tth and 9th respectively, in the top 10 clothing
exporters (WTO, 2014).
4.2.2.1. Size of Home Demand
This suggests that due to the proximity of buyers and cultural nearness the buyers help firms to
develop products that satisfy the demands of local customers (Porter, 1990) p 89). According to
Porter (1990),a largenumber of buyers will help in encouraging new entrepreneurs and motivate
investment and generate market information. If a country has a large number of buyers it will help
in achieving a competitive advantage.The proxy used for this measure was the total population of
the country. This measure was also used byWijinadset al (2005), and Vu and Pham (2016).
4.2.2.2. Internationalization of Domestic Demand (IDD)
In case the domestic buyers are mobile or a multinational company it creates an advantage for the
domestic firms as their domestic customers are also foreign customers. Porter (1990) also
suggested that if the domestic demand is internationalized foreign sales will help in creating an
advantage for the nation. The proxy used for this item was the total exports of the industry.
4.2.3.Related and Supporting Industries
The third major determinant of the diamond model is Related and supporting industries. The
existence of suppliers and other related industries in the country which are internationally
competitive (Porter, 1990). These include Clusters composed of many medium and small local
firms providing a very firm,corporation and institutional support for economic up gradation
(Marchallian, 1920). The local firms are more likely acquiring supplies and other inputs from the
local market, which will prevent leakage of capital from the economy (Barkley, 2001; Markusen,
1996). Li and Zhou (2010) studied the effective factor on attaining competitive advantages in 179
104
foreign countries in China with the presumption that these companies have accepted market
tendency and integrity of management. They found that market trend and management integrity
create competitive advantage through attenuating costs, differentiation, and diversity in the market.
Yamin et al. (1999) showed in their study on Australian manufacturing industries follow Porter’s
general strategies (cost leadership, differentiation, and centralization strategy) were effective on
competitive advantages and performance of the company.
Rodrigues and Khan.(2015) used data on textile and clothing industry form SAFTA countries and
suggested that the improvement of the competitiveness of this region requires serious steps for the
development of infrastructure, including a steady flow of electricity, paved roads, ports,highways
and administration forms and standardization of customer data. In order to improve export
shipping documentation should be processed quickly to minimize transaction cost in terms of
money and time. India is suffering 37% cost disadvantage due to poor shipping containers from
Mumbai/Chennai to the east coast of the USA, relative to similar container shipments from
Shanghai. This cost disadvantage arises from inefficiencies and delays at Indian ports.
This can be improved by introducing proper government policies which help in technological up
gradation in the clothing and textile industry. The policies of Bangladesh, India, and Pakistan
should be focused on reducing tariffs on imports of equipment, machinery and also provide cash
and credit support to modernize this industry.
Alemu (2010) identified that establishment of ETGAMA, USAID AGOA + VEGA project had a
positive impact on the Ethiopian textile industry. But the industry has very few suppliers of raw
material other than cotton and apparel accessories (ETGAMA, 2009; ITC, 2009). They have very
poor integration of raw material and industrial production. Firms are poorly vertically integrated
and lack of research has avery bad impact on the industry.
Oh and Rhee (2010) argued that the Korean car industry has achieved competitive advantages in
the world industry by combining the capabilities of suppliers and merging (cost leadership
strategy). Feng et al. (2010) conducted a study in China between 2008 and 2009 and concluded
that customer and suppliers’ participation throughout the process of attaining competitive
advantages (cost leadership strategy) improves competitive advantages of the industry.
105
Bobillo et al. (2010) studied 1500 manufacturing firms in Germany, France, the UK, Spain, and
Denmark and maintained that organizational factors (e.g. Capital markets, financial liaison, and
skilled workforce) –differentiation strategies, approaches- have a positive effect on attaining
competitive advantages.
Rugraff (2012) worked in Czechs car industry and suggested that two main factors of creating
competitive advantages in the industry aretoothe forward-looking and backward-looking merger
or the suppliers in the industry(participation in and sharing the resources of customers and
suppliers).This variable is composed of two items, including – supporting and related
industries.Communication and transportation both serve as related and supporting industries. They
are vital in the global market for enhancing competitiveness (Hult (2012); Kenji (2013); Morgan
2014)). In order to measure the transportationnetwork. Length of railway lines was used. This
measure was also used by Vu and Pharma (2014)
In order to measure communication system mobile cellular subscription per year was used.
This measure was also used by Rodrigues and Khan. (2015).
4.2.4.Firm Strategy Rivalry and Structure
The fourth determinant of the diamond model is a firm strategy, rivalry,and structure, it actually
measures the context in which business is ‘created, organized and also the nature of rivalry at home
market (Porter, 1990:107).The nation will gain success in the industries in which the management
practices and modes of the companies are highly favored by national businesses and serve as a
source of competitive advantage. Schumpeter (1942) emphasis on the importance of having inter-
firm competition in the industry, he categorized it as a function of industry structure, which not
only includes firm size butalso barriers to entry. In case of a smaller number of skilled human
resource, there will be a competition for market share as well as for these scarce human resources
as well. Schumpeter (1942) also introduced a term creative destruction, which means the closing
of firms which are less innovative and productive and the opening of new firms which are more
innovative and productive. Therefore, intercompany competition increases productivity and
innovation.
Henderson et al. (1995) stated that for a newly established firm’s urbanization of economies,
whereas for mature industries localized economies are very important. The reason might be needed
106
for general avail services available in the urbanization addition flow of ideas between industries
also add to its benefits. On the other hand, mature industries require more communication networks
and a service agglomeration which is built with time for satisfying the needs of particular
industries.
Olson et al. (1998) suggests that marketing efforts, including introduction of line of products,
pricing strategies, customer relationship and available resources and production facilities and
strategic design including centralization or decentralization of business and mergers and
acquisition strategies of an organization can plays a vital role in development of competitive
advantages.
Alemu (2010) identified a strong vertically integrated textile industry in Ethiopia. The country
has Nine ginneries with an average annual ginning capacity 42.000 tons. But he identified that
this industry is faced with the very poor strategy of firms, underdeveloped production facility and
very limited capacity to produce large volume.
Rodrigues and Khan.(2015) suggested that in the case of SAFTA countries this variable had been
neglected. There are almost no clusters related to the clothingindustry. Additionally, the exports
of clothing sector had taken an L-shape which has major clusters of dying, knitting manufacturing,
and printing. Also,a different firm which produces accessories and washing mills. There are poor
management and organization system, andthe majority of world leading brands uses SMEs and
privately-owned firms for their production outsourcing. To take advantage of the low-cost labor
of the region. These SMEs still used old style household management which emphasized the
achievement of targets rather than long-term objectives of skills and quality improvement. In order
to measure these variable threedifferent proxies were used, which are discussed below:
4.2.4.1 Domestic Rivalry
Rivalry in the domestic market encourages firms to upgrade their operations and upgrade their
competitive advantage by selling abroad to increase their profits. It also,influences firms to
innovate, create and upgrade their operations to achieve competitive advantage. Domestic
competition results first in higher efficiency and lower prices. As this indicator was measured by
an index intensity of local competition. The range of this index is from 1-7 in which 1 shows
107
limited competition in most industries and 7 shows very intense competition in most industries
(www.weforum.org/docs).
4.2.4.2. Business Context
This variable was measured by World bank DTF points. This index helps in assessing the
performance of the country and its improvement overtime. This shows the distance of each country
to its frontier, representing superior performance on different indicators across all the countries.
This index is helpful in identifying a gap between the performance of a country with the best
performing economy (The World Bank, 2016). This measure was also used by Vu and Pham
(2016)
4.2.4.3. International Rivalry
The International share of the industry is very important. International rivalry shows the
competitiveness of the industry in the international market in order to measure this variable
Market share of the country in the global market this measure was also used byVu and Pham
(2016).
4.2.5.Government Policy
The government can affect all the other determinants of the diamond model significantly
(Tasevska, 2006). Government policies and other regulations formulated at all levels of the
government can adversely affect or benefit the competency of industry and a nation (Barragan,
2005). Thegovernment policy can create or damage the competitive advantageof a nation(Nilsson
&Peterson, 2002). Tuna (2006) identified that the role of government policy can be ascertained by
recognizing how it affects different variables in the diamond model. The components, which
constitute this variable, include subsidies, education policy, taxes, financial incentives, quality
standards, capital market regulations, public procurement and antitrust laws (Mehrizi&Pakneiat,
2008).
This variable was measured by three items -Regional Trade Agreement (RTA), tariffs and
transparency, accountability and corruption in public index. The details are given below.
108
4.2.5.1.Regional Trade Agreement
The regional trade agreements are a very prominent feature of international trade. WTO
encouraged to notify whenever they sign a new agreement. There are many economic and non-
economic benefits associated with this agreement. They will secure foreign market entry they
improve the bargaining strength of members protect infant industry and drive trade to the desired
areas (Economy and Finance, 2014).It was measured as a dummy variable. This measure was
also used by Herath, Liang,andYongbing (2014).
4.2.5.2. Transparency, Accountability, and Corruption in the Public
This variable was measured by CPIA transparency, accountability, and corruption in the
public sector rating. The ratio ranges from 1-6, in which 1 represent lowest and 6 represent highest
levels.
4.2.5.3.Tariffs
Tariffs are the taxes upon imports from any other country. These tariffs play a significant role in
increasing or decreasing trade from any country. This item was measured by the average tariff rate.
The same measure was used by David (2000).
4.2.6. National Competitive Advantage
Garelli (2003) suggests that national competitiveness is achieved through firm competitiveness.
Nations should provide an environment for the firms, so they outperform and excel their
capabilities and achieve competitive advantage in their business. Firms are now trying to cooperate
rather than compete due to advancement in technology, increased domestic and international
competition in the market and changing demand patterns, because of trade liberalization and
globalization. (Ortmann, 2001; Trienekens, 2011).
The World Competitiveness Yearbook (WCC, 2013), stated that competitiveness is the field of
study that tries to analyze countries enhance the ability of its firms to the facts and policies that
helps to create an environment for its firms, so they can create value, and on long-run increase the
standard of living of the its people.
109
Porter (1990), defined competitive advantage to be maintained at three levels- nation, industry,and
firm level. Competitive advantage at the national level is reflected by sustained growth in the
standard of living of the citizen of that country, and it can be attained by continuous creativity in
production. Industry competitive advantage is reflected by the industry’s profitability, inbound and
outbound foreign direct investment and trade balance and the firm-level competitive advantage is
measured by its market share, exports,and profitability (JMOP 2003).
Balkyte and Tvaronavičiene (2010) divided the competitiveness to be maintained at six levels-
firms’ level, sector level, regional level, national level, bloc level,and international level.
Kulikov (2000) identifies two types of competitiveness- real and nominal Competitiveness. Real
competitiveness is reflected by market’s fairness, openness and continuous innovation and
improvement in the quality of goods and services offered by the county of origin and
additionally,the standard of living of the citizen of the country. Therefore, the real competitiveness
can be achieved by free and fair markets that can meet domestic and international markets.
Whereas, nominal competitiveness can be achieved by introducing government policies, providing
a supportive macroeconomic environment through state subsidies, cash grants and tax exemptions
to domestic producers. Therefore, the real competitiveness can only be achieved, if the country
provides a creative and innovative environment to its domestic firms to meet international quality
and design for both domestic and international customers.
According to the diamond model, the prosperity of a country is not inherited but created through
industrial innovation and up gradation. The companies can compete at a global level and gain
competitive advantage at an internationallevel if they face challenges and pressures in the domestic
market. The role of the nation has grown with the shift of competition bases more and more on
assimilation and creation of knowledge.
Harrison. et al(2001) suggested that latest literature has paid closer attention to the resource based
aspect of the firm in the business context, as this suggests that the competitive advantage of the
firm is associated with the quality and quantity of resources itposses. These resources are
interlinked with each other. If one area is weak, it will influence other areas as well. Therefore, it
is important for the organization to use its strong resources to overcome the deficiency of its weak
resources through the system of resource creation. Nater and Cini (2009) used data from
110
economically troubled country Osijek-Baranja. They applied the Porter diamond model to identify
opportunities for the development of the home industry and identify potential threats in the long-
term development of the industry in the country.
Astarlioglu (2012) used Porter’s Generic Strategies and diamond model for analysis and suggests
that generic strategies help firms achieve success at the national and international level. On the
other hand,the diamond model will help them understand that why some firms are successful while
others are not. Aghdaie, Seidi,andRiasi (2012) worked on data from Iran’s Saffron industry by
applying the diamond model to identify the potential barriers to Iran’s saffron export to
international markets. They used practical and empirical analysis and used descriptive analysis,
including, cognition and survey methods for data collection techniques. The results suggested that
important barriers in saffron export are demand conditions, related and supporting industries, firm
strategy, structure, and rivalry, government, and chance. Factor condition was not an important
barrier to Iran’s saffron export.
Bakan and Dogan (2012) used data from the city of Kahramanmaraş to apply Porter diamond
model by using both primary and secondary data in order to understand the situation of different
industries, to improve the competitivenessof these industries. Bashiri, Baziyar,
Balakshahi,andMojib (2013) Used data from Iran to assess the prospects of olive exports by
applying Porter diamond model to compete internationally. He suggests increased exports
revenues for the investment in the latesttechnologies which will increase productivity to increase
exports.
Taga(2014) suggested that SAFTA was signed by both Pakistan and India to reduce tariff barriers,
increase regional trade to enhance regions socioeconomic development., but still certain measures
are required to improve the effectiveness of this agreement. Rodrigues and Khan (2015) appliedthe
diamondmodel to the clothing industries of SAFTA and suggest that this industry had provided
the potential for growth and employment in the region. They also contributed that due to many
Free trade agreements in the region and government policies and expenditure on training,
providing infrastructure and cluster had a very significant and positive impact on this said industry.
Mboya and Kazungu (2015) used data from textile and apparel industryof Tanzania to explore
determinants of competitive advantage, by applyingthe Porter Diamond Model. They usednon-
111
probability sampling technique and collected data from three regions including Dar es Salaam,
Arusha,and Mwanza from 204 respondents, applying Factor Analysis, Principal Component
Analysis,and Structural Equation Modeling.The results support the Porter Diamond Model as a
determinant of firm competitive advantage and identified relating and supporting industries and
demand conditions critical factors for apparel and textile industries In Tanzania.
Bashiri et al (2013) used data from Iran by applying the Porter diamond model inthe agricultural
sector and suggested that to be aligned with international standard countries must align themselves
with the global economy, for which they have to learn ways to compete in the globalmarketplace
for higher productivity and quality. International trade provides revenues, which facilitate
investment and development of new technologies which increases productivity.
Oz (2002) used the diamond model of Porter to identify Turkey’s sources of international
competitiveness. The main emphasis was to improve and understand these sources and study
Turkish competitive. The study also aims to shed some light on the competitive structure of the
Turkish major industries. The results suggested that, except for domestic rivalry and government
policy, the Turkish industry supportsPorter Diamond Model.
Robertm. (1991) appreciated theory of competitive advantage and suggested that despite having
some limitation of measurability and concept determination it will help to bridge the gap between
international economics issues and strategic management by enriching both disciplines. The
analysis presented by porter had enriched the theory of competitive advantage by including
theimpact of environmental issues on the competitive performance of a nation in global market
had broadened the scope of the theory of competitive advantage by providing international and
dynamic aspects of competition to encompass both the international dimension and the dynamic
context of competition. The National competitive advantage is the country’s evaluation ability to
involve and participate competitively in global markets. Some countries can achieve more
advantage over the other due to many reasons. For achieving and boosting economic growth they
have to identify their strengths and weaknesses and try to enhance their strength and overcome
their weaknesses. Different frameworks were designed by Micheal Porter helping nations to assess
themselves (McMahon, 2017). National competitive advantage can come from a variety of
sources. These don’t just include natural resources, but also human, physical, capital, knowledge,
talent, entrepreneurial skills and a favorable environment for the business. Nations may enrich
112
these resources through proper policies and strategies in order to attain a competitive edge in the
world. For example, establishing universities to increase research and development in a different
field for increased innovation and creativity. They can also overcome their resource disadvantage
by innovating new ways of doing things. An innovation capability is a powerful tool for the
success of the nation in a global marketplace. Innovation can be encouraged by the government by
introducing patent laws which encourage innovations. The government can also finance potential
new projects to encourage innovation. Another key component of the national competitive
advantage is supported industries the presence of major suppliers, distributors, marketing agencies
will contribute positively to achieving success. These industries develop a network will facilitate
the value chain of the production processes. Demand conditions in the local market will also help
nations. A tougher condition in the home market will help companies to develop a competitive
base for international competition. Through this rivalry, creativity and innovation make it pace and
the industry become dynamic. The internal pressure from domestic market makes the industrial
diamondof four key variables that can be assessed, compared and contrasted for determining
national competitive advantage. This variable was measured by Revealed Competitive Advantage.
This measure was used by Bonzanier (2015), Blgirat(1999), Van royenetal (2001) Taneja at
al.(2013) and Hallat(2005).
4.3. Sources of Data
The work was based on secondary data, various data sources were used in the work. The list of
data sources is given below:
• World Integrated Trade Statistics (WITS)
• UNCOMTRADE.
• Bureau of Statistics Pakistan.
• State Bank of Pakistan.
• Pakistan Economic Survey.
• SAARC Statistical Yearbooks of the sample period.
• SAARC trade database
113
• Books, journals and articles.
• Trade map
4.4. Data
4.4.1.Population
The population of this work was industries of Pakistan and India. The work had tried to find the
source of competitive advantage in both countries, applying national diamond model presented by
Porter (1990). The panel data was used to analyze the overallexport competitiveness of Pakistan
and India. Time series data was used for the analysis of individual industries of each country.
4.4.2.Sample
The sample consists of five industries from Pakistan and five industries from Pakistan. The
industries include Agriculture, Textile, Sugar and Sugar confectionaries,Edible fruits and nuts and
inorganic chemical industry.In order to select sample 5 Pakistan industries where selected based
on their trade potential by matching import potential for India.
4.4.3.Sample Size
The sample consists of five industries from Pakistan and five industries from India for the
period 2005-2015.
4.4.4.Sampling Techniques
The sampling techniques used for the analysis were purposive sampling. In order to analyze
industries of Pakistan and India.The main purpose was to identify export potential Pakistani
industries and match them with import potential Indian industries.
4.4.5.Data Analysis
The data were collected from the sources mentioned above. After the collection of the data,
the thorough check was done for identifying error entries, outliers etc.The z- values were calculated
for standardization. After those descriptive statistics were calculated for checking the normality of
the data. The correlation matrix was also calculated between the independent variables for the
114
detection of the multicollinearity problem. In orderto select between fixed effect or random effect
model,the Hausman test was calculated. In order to check before applying the model data should
be tested for Stationary andautocorrelation. For stationary unit root test and for testing of
autocorrelation Durban Watson test was used. Individual variables were tested for stationary. For
panel data panel unit root test was applied and for time series data Augmented Dickey-Fuller test
was applied. In case a variable is non-stationary the first difference was taken.The value of
Durban, Watson test should be around 2 or less than 2.
4.4.6. Research Approaches
Two types of analytical approaches will be applied.
The First approach will be based on calculating ratios for an assessment of the state of trade flows
and trade patterns between Pakistan and India in selected industries. In the calculation of ratios
first three ratios were calculated for Pakistan and India overall trade patterns to identify the trade
intensity, trade share,andintra or extra-regional trade bias. The other three ratios used were
revealed comparative advantage, regional orientation and Complementarity index, they were
calculated for trade patterns ofindividual industries. This will help in the assessment of individual
industry performance in the global market.
The second approach applied was the calculation of multiple regression models. Panel data were
used for assessment of India and Pakistan national competitive advantage. The fixed effect model
was used for the analysis. In the case of individual industry analysis, time series data was used for
which, a simple linear regression model was applied.In assessing the competitiveness of India and
Pakistan, the trade patterns of different industries from both countries were used and Revealed
Comparative Advantage (RCA) was applied.The trade data which was used in the study was
collected from a different source which is clearly identified in Table 4.1.The proxies used for a
different variable are also mentioned in the Table4.1. The different variable was identified, but the
problem was the standardization of value as different variables were expressed in different
measurement scales. For standardization of the variable z-score was calculated and a means were
calculated for the computation of the variable.
115
4.9.1. Ratio Analysis of Trade Indicators
The ratio analysis is the first step toward trade policy analysis, they help an analyst to have an idea
about the general pattern of trade. The following Ratios will be calculated:
4.9.1.1 Indicators of Regional Trade Interdependence
These include the following of ratios:
1. Intraregional Trade Share
2. Intraregional Trade Intensity
3. Regional trade introversion index
4. Revealed comparative advantage.
5. Regional Orientation index
6. Complementarity index
4.10 Model Specification
4.10.1 The Multiple Regression Analysis
This work had used a fixed effect model for India and Pakistan overall panel data,
Housman’s testwas applied to select between fixed and random effect model for the analysis and
fixed effect model was preferred. For a fixed effect model, the values of Bayesian criterion (SBC)
Akaike information criterion (AIC), Schwarz and Hannan-Quinn criterion (HQC) were also lower.
By including fixed effect, the average differences across variables were controlled in any
observable or unobservable predictors. The Fixed Effect Model greatly reduced the threat of
omitted variable bias. The following fixed effect model was applied to the panel data:
NCAit = α0 + α1 (FC)it + α2 (DC)it + α3 (FSRS)it + α4 (RSI)it + α5(GP)it + u
116
4.10.2. Multiple Regression Model
The Linear regression model is used for individual sector analysis is a statistical technique used
for estimating the relationships among dependent and independent variables. This work will use
the linear regression model, but Following model will be used:
NCA = α0 + α1 (FC) + α2 (DC) + α3 (FSRS) + α4 (RSI) + α5(GP) + u
Where:
FC = HR + PH +KR + CR + IF
DC = HDC +DSP+ IDD+HDC
RSI= SH+RI
FSRS = DSI +RI +IR +BC
GP =RTA + SD + TC
117
CHAPTER #5
RESULTS
This section will apply the methodology identified in the previous section. The results will be
analyzed and discussed thoroughly.
5.1. Ratio Analysis
The ratio analysis was used to access the current trade patterns of India Pakistan. The ratio
calculated includes an indicator of regional trade interdependence. These ratios are helpful in
measuring the current situation of trade pattern and trade interdependence between different
partners or regional groups. For each indicator, a higher value indicates the lowest trade cost in the
proposed region and vice versa.
5.1.1.Intra Regional Trade Share
The first ratio used was Intraregional trade share. This ratio identifies the ratio of the trade between
countries to theratio ofthe total trade of countries. This ratio is helpful in identifying the relative
trade importance of trade between countries compared to trade with other countries of the
world.The ratio was calculated as under:
Interregional trade share= Tii/Ti
Where Tii = exports from India to Pakistan plus imports from Pakistan to India
Ti= total exports fromIndia Pakistan to imports from India to the world.
Source: Anderson and Norheim (1993)
5.1.2.Intra Regional Trade Intensity
The second ratio appliedwas interregional trade intensity which was used to measure the
intraregional share of the trade of Pakistan and India with the world trade share. This ratio helps
to measure the trade intensity within the region, whether it is greater or smaller than expected on
the basis of the importance of the region for world trade. If the index is greater than the one it
118
shows that trade flows are greater than expected and shows the importance of the region in the
world trade. The calculation method is given below:
Intra-regional trade intensity index = (Tii/Ti) / Ti/Tw)
In the above formula:
Tii = exports from India to Pakistan plus imports from Pakistan to India
Ti= total exports from India Pakistan to imports from India to the world.
Tw= world total exports plus world total imports.
Source: Anderson and Norheim (1993)
5.1.3. Trade Introversion Index
This ratiowas introduced by Lapadre (2006) to measure relative intensity trading within the region
compared with outside the region. The range of this ratio is between -1 to +1. In this index,
intraregional trade intensity (HIi) and extra-regional trade intensity (HEi) are functions of the
region ‘s share of outsider ‘s total trade and not of world trade as in the previous trade intensity
index. The significance of this index is that it increases or falls if the intraregional trade intensity
increases or falls. The zero indexesshowthat trade in the region is neutral. More than zero suggest
an intraregional bias and less than zero suggest extra-regionalbiases. The formula for the ratio is
given below:
Regional Trade Introversion Index i = [HIi – HEi] / [HIi + HEi]
HIi = (T ii / Ti)/ (TOi / TO) and HEi = [1 –( T ii / Ti)]/ [1 – (TOi / TO)]
Tii = exports of region i to region i plus imports of region i from region i
Ti = total exports of region i to the world plus total imports of region i from the world
TOi = exports of region i to outsiders plus imports of region i from outsiders
TO = total exports of outsiders plus total imports of outsiders
Source: Anderson and Norheim (1993)
119
Table 5 1 Indicators of Regional Trade Interdependence
Years Intra-Regional Trade Share Intra-regional
Trade intensity
Intra-regional
Trade introversion index
2005 0.002 0.19 -0.53
2006 0.004 0.30 -0.36
2007 0.004 0.30 -0.37
2008 0.003 0.21 -0.51
2009 0.003 0.17 -0.57
2010 0.004 0.19 -0.54
2011 0.002 0.10 -0.72
2012 0.002 0.10 -0.72
2013 0.002 0.12 -0.66
2014 0.003 0.13 -0.64
2015 0.003 0.14 -0.62
Source:Prepared by the Researcher
In order to calculate the ratio for the analysis of Pakistanand Indiatrade, Import and export trade
patterns of both the countries were collected from the World Integrated Trade Solution website.
Table 5.1 shows the result of the three ratios;the first ratio of intra-regional trade shows a very low
value for intra-regional trade that future trade will be costly between Pakistan and India. The
second ratio of intra-regional trade intensity was less than one for all the years analyzed and
suggest that collective trade of Pakistan and India is not very significant in the world. The ratio of
Intraregional trade introversion index gives negative values for all the years which suggests an
extra-regional bias.
5.1.4. Revealed Comparative Advantage
This index is used to measure the comparative advantage or disadvantage of a country in certain
good or commodities as evident from their trade flows. Greater than one index shows that a country
has a comparative advantage in that particular commodity. Less than one shows that the country
has a comparative disadvantage in a particular industry or commodity. The index is based on the
Ricardian concept of comparative advantage. The Balassa index was used to measure the
competitive advantage, which was introduced by Balassa and Noland (1965).
120
Table 5.2 Pakistan Revealed Comparative Advantage In Different Industries
(2005-2015)
Table 5.2 presented the resultsof revealed comparative ratio of different industries of Pakistan the
results suggest that the textile and clothing industry of Pakistan performed very well in 2005 with
the Revealed comparative advantage of more than 12 but the performance was declining after that,
but the industry remained competitive withthe Revealed comparative advantage of more than one,
but in the year 2009, 2013 and 2014 it lost its competitiveness but regain it in 2015. In inorganic
chemical industry, the result showed Pakistan is not at all competitive in this industry withthe
Revealed comparative advantage of less than one in all the years under study. In the agriculture
and food industry, theRCA results show that the country is not competitive in all the years. The
same results were found in Sugar and edible fruits and nuts industries.
Table 5 3 Indian Revealed Comparative Advantage In Different Industries
(2005-2015)
Years Textile and
clothing
Inorganic
chemicals
Agriculture Sugar and sugar
confectionaries
Edible fruits and
nuts
2005 12.19 0.01 0.88 0.39 0.21
006 1.80 0.00 0.10 0.32 0.21
2007 1.53 0.01 0.09 0.19 0.19
2008 1.35 0.00 0.09 0.64 0.18
2009 0.11 0.02 0.12 0.22 0.21
2010 1.16 0.01 0.10 0.13 0.22
2011 1.17 0.01 0.11 0.07 0.21
2012 1.28 0.01 0.14 0.30 0.24
2013 0.94 0.01 0.09 0.68 0.24
2014 0.97 0.01 0.09 0.55 0.24
2015 1.13 0.01 0.07 0.55 0.24
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
121
Years Textile Inorganic
Chemicals
Agriculture Sugar and Sugar
Confectionaries
Edible Fruits and
Nuts
2005 3.23 1.08 0.74 0.31 1.82
2006 3.16 1.00 1.06 2.28 1.59
2007 3.00 0.72 1.26 3.35 1.35
2008 2.87 0.85 1.20 4.17 1.40
2009 0.25 0.68 0.82 0.19 1.07
2010 2.73 1.37 1.26 1.58 0.98
2011 2.89 0.60 1.08 2.31 0.99
2012 3.24 0.85 1.32 2.63 0.97
2013 2.77 0.65 1.40 1.28 0.94
2014 2.73 0.70 1.19 1.66 0.92
2015 3.25 0.70 1.16 2.18 0.88
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table5.3 shows the results of the revealed comparative advantage of different industries of India.
The results suggest that India remained competitive in the textile industry and is able to sustain
that position consistently. In inorganic chemical industry the result showed that in 2005 and 2006
the country gainedthe comparative advantage, but, lost this advantage in 2007, 2008 and 2009, but
regain its competitive advantage in 2010 but was not able to sustain that position for the rest of the
year. The agriculture industry in India has gained competitive advantage except for the year 2005
and 2009. In the sugar industry in 2005 they country performance was not very good, but it gainsa
competitive advantage in all the other years except for 2009. The edible fruits and nuts industry
were very competitive from 2005 till 2009 but lost its competitiveness afterward.
5.1.4. Regional Orientation
The ratio of regional orientation suggests that whether the exports of certain goods are more
oriented toward a certain region as compared to other regions. This ratio is composed of two
shares. Firstly, the numerator comprisesof the share of Pakistan’s exports of the product to India,
in Pakistan’s total exports. The denominator is the share of Pakistan’s exports of the product to
other countries in the country’s total exports to other countries. If the value is more than 1, it
indicates the regional bias of the country of exports of a particular product, and if it is less than 1
than the country has no regional biases.
122
This ratio along with revealed comparative advantage helps to identify trade diversion or trade
creation after signing of a particular free trade agreement. The country’s Revealed comparative
advantage value less than 1and regional trade orientation is more than 1 than the Free Trade
Agreement will cause trade diversion.In order to calculate this ratio following formula was used:
Regional Orientation Index = (Xcgr /Xcr) /= (Xcgr-r /Xcr-r)
where,
Xcgr = exports of industry g by Pakistan to India
Xcr = total exports of Pakistan to India
Xcg-r = exports of the industry by Pakistan tocountries other than India outside the region.
Xc-r = total exports by industry to countries outside region r.
Source: Anderson and Norheim (1993)
Table 5 4 Regional Orientation of Pakistan Trade with India
Years Textile and
clothing
Inorganic
chemicals
Agriculture Sugar & Sugar
confectionaries
Edible Fruits and
Nuts
2005 0.37 2.17 0.15 0.03 1.07
2006 0.58 2.57 0.19 0.00 1.13
2007 0.71 2.58 0.39 0.00 1.29
2008 0.58 3.70 0.83 0.00 1.20
2009 0.75 4.93 0.50 0.00 1.49
2010 0.70 13.7 0.63 0.00. 1.05
2011 0.59 8.73 0.50 0.00 1.17
2012 1.05 8.81 2.61 0.04 1.19
2013 0.65 6.18 1.66 0.20 1.07
2014 0.75 6.47 2.04 0.00 0.93
2015 0.76 8.02 2.46 0.00 1.19
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.4 suggests the regional orientation of Pakistan and India in trade the textile and clothing industries
shows a value less than 1 for all the years except for 2012. In inorganic chemical, the value is more than 1
for all the year. The agriculture industries showa value less than 1 from 2005 to2011, after that, it shows
that value more than 1, for sugar and sugar confectionaries the value is more than 1 in 2009 and 2010., for
123
the remaining years it showed avalue less than 1. In Ediblefruits and nuts Industries,the value was greater
than 1 for all years except for 2014.
5.1.5.Trade Complementarity Index
This index helps to measure the degree to which export pattern of one country is similar to the
import pattern of the other country. The value ranges from 0 to 1, which shows no overlapping
and 1 suggest a perfect match of trade pattern. A high index suggests favorable prospects for the
future arrangement. The formula for measuring this index was as follows:
1 − [∑ abs(
MrgMr⁄ )−
Xcg
Xc
2∂
]
Mrg = imports of good g by region r
Mr = total imports of the region
Xcg = exports of good g by country c
Xc = total exports by country c
Source: Anderson and Norheim (1993)
Table 5 5 Trade Complementarity Index
Years Textile and
clothing
Inorganic
chemicals
Agriculture Sugar & sugar
confectionaries
Edible Fruits
and nuts
2005 0.06 0.99 0.93 0.81 0.90
2006 0.09 0.99 0.94 0.83 0.90
2007 0.19 0.99 0.95 0.89 0.91
2008 0.23 0.99 0.94 0.63 0.91
2009 0.92 0.98 0.91 0.83 0.86
2010 0.15 0.98 0.92 0.90 0.84
2011 0.02 0.98 0.90 0.93 0.83
2012 0.003 0.98 0.89 0.76 0.82
2013 0.16 0.98 0.91 0.41 0.79
2014 0.18 0.98 0.91 0.53 0.81
2015 0.09 0.99 0.94 0.55 0.81
124
Source: Prepared by the researcher
Table 5.5 shows the results of the trade complementarily index. The trade complementarity index
washigh for all the industries except for the textile and clothing industry.
5.2 Regression Analysis
The regression analysis is a technique used to identify the variation independent variable caused
by individual or more than one independent variables. Before calculating regression, the
normality of the data was checked the descriptive statistics for each model was calculated.
Forchecking the problem of multi-collinearity Pearson correlation test was applied. ADF test was
applied to check stationarity of each variable.
Table 5 6 Summary Statistics Pakistan
Variables Mean Median Min Max SD skew Kurt
FC 6.3e019 -0.026 -0.0784 0.193 0.077 0.270 1.022
DC 7.2e-008 0.0378 -0.0378 0.274 0.183 -0.051 -1.361
SRI -9.0e-009 0.0090 -0.186 0.106 0.081 -0.903 0.202
FSSR 0.0042 -0.002 -0.396 0.263 0.114 -0.901 2.000
GP -0.0002 0.0060 -0.104 0.060 0.048 -0.595 -0.433
Source: Prepared by the researcher
Table 5.6 shows the summary statistics of Pakistan. In order to check the normality of the data the
value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all the variable shows less than 2 value. This
suggests that the data is normally distributed.
Table 5 7 Correlation Matrix Pakistan
FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.00 0.65 -0.31 0.14 -0.47
DC 1.00 0.021 0.34 0.19
SR 1.00 0.30 0.51
FSSR 1.00 0.22
GP 1.00
Source: Prepared by a researcher
125
Table 5.7 showsthe correlation matrix of explanatory variables oftheoverall Pakistan model. The
result suggests that the problem of multicollinearity is not present in the data.
Table 5 8 ADF Panel Unit Root Test Result Pakistan
Variable Estimated –value Test statistic P-value
CA -1.03 -3.32 0.04
FC -1.41 -4.11 0.01
DC -1.72 -3.34 0.01
SRI -0.03 -0.28 0.55
FSSR -0.96 -4.94 0.00
GP -0.60 -2.00 0.04
Source: Prepared by a researcher
Table 5.8 shows the results of the ADF test for each variable. This test was run individually for
each Variable. In case the variable is nonstationary, the first difference was taken.
Table 5.9 Hausman Test Result -Pakistan
Null hypothesis : GLS estimates are consistent
Chi-square 0.095
p-value 0.00953
Source:Prepared by the researcher
Table 5.9 shows the results of the Hausman test (Gujarati, 2003). The analysis of the test suggests
that the fixed effect model should be used.
Table 5 10 Regression Results- Pakistan
126
VARIABLE Coefficient Std. Error t-ratio p-value
FC −0.01 0.074 −0.12 0.89
DC 1.14 2.19 0.51 0.60
SR 0.23 0.83 0.28 0.77
FSSR −0.64 1.13 −0.57 0.56
GP 2.44 0.74 3.27 0.002
Adjusted R-squared 0.28
F statistic 5.23
P-value (F) 0.00
Durbin-Watson 1.79
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.10 presents regressionresults Pakistan. The adjusted R square was28.14 %, which suggests
that almost 28.14 % changes in the selected data were due to above motioned explanatory
variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variable is −0.01 and shows a negative relationship
between factor condition and competitive advantage. The coefficient of demand conditions is1.14
which shows that there is a positive relationship between demand conditions and competitive
advantage. The coefficient for supporting and related industries is 0.23 and shows a positive
relationship with the competitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for firm strategy and
rivalry is −0.64 and shows a negative relationship with the competitive advantage of the country.
The coefficient for government policy variable is 2.44 and shows a positive relationship with the
advantage of the country. The overall model is statistically significant with F value of 5.23 and
P-value 0.00. The T-statistics show that only government policy is statistically significant at 5%
significance level. The DW statistics suggest the data is free from Auto Correlation.
Table 5.11 Summary Statistics -India
Variables Mean Median Min Max S.D Skew kurt
FC 9.09e007 0.030 0.680 0.486 0.351 0.339 0.850
DC -3.63e-007 0.090 1.546 1.305 0.907 -0.211 -1.425
SRI -8.8e-018 0.101 1.146 1.360 0.919 0.100 1.551
FSSR -1.9e-018 0.079 -1.079 1.024 0.472 -0.462 0.039
GP 4.3e-018 -0.021 -0.949 1.341 0.618 0.5676 0.149
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
127
Table5.11 shows the summary statistics of India. In order to check the normality of the data the
value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all the variable shows less than 2 value. This
suggests that the data is normally distributed.
Table 5.12 Correlation Matrix - India
FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.0000 0.347 0.068 -0.135 -0.522
DC 1.000 0.280 0.470 -0.472
SR 1.000 0.178 -0.472
FSSR 1.000 -0.410
GP 1.000
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.12 shows the correlation matrix of explanatory variables of overallIndia. The result
suggests that the problem of multicollinearity is not present in the data.
Table 5 13 Panel Unit Root Test Result - India
VARIABLE ESTIMATED –VALUE TEST STATICIC P-VALUE
CA -1.035 -3.311 0.042
FC -0.993 -2.801 0.092
DC -0.224 -1.413 0.532
SRI 0.0116 0.1341 0.950
FSSR -0.969 -5.179 0.003
GP -0.6011 -1.893 0.321
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.13 shows the results of the ADF test for each variable. This test was run individually for
each Variable. In case the variable is not stationary, the first difference was taken.
Table 5.14 Hausman Test Result - India
Null Hypothesis GLS estimates are consistent
128
Chi-square 0.053
p-value 0.019
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.14 shows the results of the Hausman test (Gujarati, 2003). The analysis of the test suggests
that the fixed effect model should be used.
Table 5 15 Regression Results- India
Variable Coefficient Std. Error t-ratio p-value
FC 0.131 0.445 0.294 0.769
DC 0.808 0.510 1.584 0.120
SR −0.83 0.495 −1.67 0.100
FSSR 0.925 0.344 2.68 0.010
GP 0.823 0.286 2.87 0.006
Adjusted R-squared 0.34
F –statistics 6.66
P-value(F) 0.00
Durbin-Watson 1.87
Source:Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.15 presentsthe regression results for India. The adjusted R square was 34.40% which
suggests that almost 34.40 % changes in the selected data were due to the five above mentioned
explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variablewas 0.131and shows a positive
relationship witha competitiveadvantage. The coefficient of demand conditions was 0.808 which
shows that there is a positive relationship between demand conditions and national competitive
advantage. The coefficient for supporting and related industries was−0.83 and shows a negative
relationship withthe national competitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for firm
strategy and rivalry was 0.925 and shows a positive relationship with national competitive
advantage. The coefficient for governmentpolicy variable is 0.823 and shows a positive
relationship with national competitive advantage. The overall model was statistically significant
withan F value of 6.66 and P-value 0.00. The T-statistics showsthat only firm strategy and
rivalry andgovernment policy variables were statistically significant at 5% significance level. The
DW statistics suggest the data is free from Auto Correlation.
Table 5 16 Summary Statistics Pakistan - Agriculture
129
Variables Mean Median Min Max S.D Skew Kurt
FC -9.9e-007 0.03 -0.68 0.48 0.36 -0.33 -0.85
DC -9.0e-007 0.23 -1.51 1.07 0.94 -0.27 -1.45
SRI -8.8e-018 0.10 -1.14 1.36 0.95 0.100 -1.55
FSSR -1.3e-017 0.04 -1.07 1.02 0.59 -0.39 -0.09
GP 4.13e18 -0.02 -0.94 1.34 0.64 0.568 -0.15
Source:Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.16 shows the summary statistics of Pakistan agriculture industry. In order to check the
normality of the data the value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all the variable shows
less than 2 value. This suggests that the data is normally distributed.
Table 5 17 Correlation Matrix Agriculture Industry Pakistan
FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.OO 0.66 -0.31 0.48 -0.47
DC 1.00 0.038 0.91 0.13
SR 1.000 -0.11 0.51
FSSR 1.00 0.30
GP 1.00
Source:Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.17 shows the correlation matrix of explanatory variables of Pakistani agriculture
industry. The result suggests that the problem of multicollinearity is not present in the data.
Table 5.18 ADF Unit Root Test Result Agriculture Industry Pakistan
Variable Coefficient T-value P-VALUE
CA -0.95 -3.53 0.03
FC 0.25 0.72 0.98
DC -0.11 -0.74 0.78
SRI -0.67 -1.99 0.28
FSSR -0.22 -4.11 0.01
GP -0.42 -1.02 0.69
Source:PreparedBy Researcher
130
Table 5.18 shows the results of the ADF test for each variable. This test was run individually for
each Variable. In case the variable is not stationary, the first difference was taken.
Table 5.19 Regression Results Pakistan Agriculture Industry
Variable Coefficient Standard Error Test Statistic P-Value
FC 9.42 4.39 2.14 0.04
SR −9.66 3.52 −2.74 0.05
GP 27.09 6.74 4.01 0.01
FSSR −4.61 3.96 −1.16 0.30
DC 4.71 3.99 1.18 0.30
Adjusted R-squared 0.84
F (6, 4) 4.78
P-value(F) 0.010
D.W −1.94
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.19 presents the regression results for Pakistan agriculture industry. The adjusted R square
85 %, which suggests that almost 85% changes inthe agriculture industry were due to these five
explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variable is 9.42 and shows a positive
relationship between factor condition and national competitive advantage. The coefficient of
demand conditions was 4.71 which shows that there is a positive relationship between demand
conditions andNational competitive advantage. The coefficient for supporting and related
industries was -9.66 and shows a negative relationship with the nationalcompetitive advantage of
the country. The coefficient for firm strategy and rivalry was −4.61 and shows a negative
relationship withnational competitive advantage. The coefficient for governmentpolicy variable
was27.09and shows a positive relationship with the advantage of the country. The overall model
was statistically significant with F value of 4.78 and P-value 0.01.The T-statistics show that firm
strategy and rivalry, government policy and supporting and related industries are significant. The
DW test suggests that the data is free from autocorrelation.
Table 5 20 Summary Statistics Pakistan Edible Fruits and Nuts
Variables Mean median Min Max SD skew Kurt
FC -6.3e-019 -0.02 -0.07 0.19 0.08 0.27 1.02
DC 3.1e-018 -0.03 -0.30 0.27 0.19 -0.00 -1.27
SRI -9.0e-009 0.009 -0.18 0.10 0.08 -0.903 0.20
FSSR 1.8e-008 0.014 -0.1 0.12 0.07 -1.16 1.79
GP -0.02 0.006 -0.104 0.06 0.05 -0.59 -0.43
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
131
Table 5.20 shows the summary statistics of Pakistan edible fruits and nuts industry. In order to
check the normality of the data the value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all the variable
shows less than 2 value. This suggests that the data is normally distributed.
Table 5 21Correlation Matrix Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry-Pakistan
FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.OO 0.69 -0.31 0.23 -0.47
DC 1.00 -0.00 0.37 0.14
SR 1.00 0.78 0.51
FSSR 1.00 0.25
GP 1.00
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.21 shows the correlation matrix of explanatory variables of edible fruits
and nuts industry Pakistan. The result suggests that the problem of
multicollinearity is not present in the data.
Table 5 22 ADF Unit Root Test Result- Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry
Pakistan
VARIABLE ESTIMATED –VALUE TEST STATICIC P-VALUE
C -0.29 -1.01 0.70
FC 0.25 0.72 0.98
DC -0.04 -1.02 0.69
SRI -0.67 -1.99 0.28
FSSR -0.58 -1.82 0.34
GP -0.42 -1.02 0.69
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.22 shows the results of theADF test for each variable. This test was run individually for
each Variable. In case the variable isnot stationary, the first difference was taken.
Table 5 23 Regression Results- Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry Pakistan
Variable Coefficient Std. Error T-value p-value
FC −0.48 1.59 −0.30 0.77
DC 0.36 1.05 0.34 0.74
SR 1.87 2.29 0.81 0.44
FSSR −0.55 2.28 −0.24 0.81
GP −1.94 2.29 −0.84 0.43
132
Adjusted R-squared 0.25
F(5, 5) 0.38
P-value(F) 0.84
Durbin-Watson 1.92
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.23 presents the regression results for edible fruits and nuts industry Pakistan. The adjusted
R squarevalue was 25.50%, which suggests that almost 25.50 % changes in the dependent variable
are due tothese five explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variable was
−0.48and shows a negative relationship between factor condition and national competitive
advantage. The coefficient of demand conditions was 0.36 which shows that there is a positive
relationship between demand conditions and national competitive advantage. The coefficient for
supporting and related industries was1.87 andshows a positive relationship with
nationalcompetitive advantage. The coefficient for firm strategy and rivalry was −0.55 and shows
a negative relationship withthe nationalcompetitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for
government policy variable was −1.94 and shows a positive relationship with national advantage.
The overall model was statistically significant with F value of 0.38and P-value 0.84. The T-
statistics show that only, firm strategy and rivalry variable is statistically insignificant at 5%
significance level. The DW statistics suggest the data is free from Auto Correlation.
Table 5 24 Summary Statistics -Pakistan Sugar and sugar confectionaries
Industry
Variables Mean median Min Max SD Skew Kurt
FC -6.3e-19 -0.02 -0.07 0.19 0.08 1.27 1.02
DC 1.8e-007 -0.03 -0.29 0.24 0.19 -0.02 -1.43
SRI -9.0e-09 0.00 -0.18 0.10 0.08 -0.90 0.20
FSSR 0.0215 0.031 -0.22 0.26 0.13 -0.01 -0.10
GP -0.000 0.006 -0.10 0.06 0.05 -0.59 -0.43
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.24 shows the summary statistics of Pakistan sugar and sugar confectionaries industry. In
order to check the normality of the data the value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all
the variable shows less than 2 value. This suggests that the data is normally distributed.
133
Table 5 25 Correlation Matrix Sugar Industry Pakistan
FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.OO 0.68 -0.31 -0.05 -0.47
DC 1.00 0.01 0.01 0.18
SR 1.00 0.50 0.51
FSSR 1.00 0.21
GP 1.00
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.25 shows the correlation matrix of explanatory variables of the sugarand sugar
confectionaries industry of Pakistan model. The result suggests that the problem of
multicollinearity is not present in the data.
Table 5 26 ADF Unit Root Test Result Sugar Industry Pakistan
Variable Estimated –value Test statistic P-value
CA -0.55 -1.78 0.36
FC 0.25 0.72 0.98
DC -0.11 -1.01 0.70
SRI -0.67 -1.99 0.28
FSSR -0.69 -2.16 0.22
GP -0.42 -1.02 0.69
Source: Prepared by Researcher
Table 5.26 shows the results ofthe ADF test for each variable. This test was run individualy for
each Variable. In case the variable is notstationary, the first difference was taken.
Table 5 27 Sugar Sector Pakistan-Regression Results
Variable Coefficient Std. Error T-ratio P-value
FC 3.91077 6.00101 0.6517 0.5434
DC_1 0.623263 5.64619 0.1104 0.9164
SR 4.75694 6.45376 0.7371 0.4942
FSSR_1 −0.372647 2.72561 −0.1367 0.8966
GP 6.93072 13.6185 0.5089 0.6325
R-square 0.356062 Adjusted R-squared 0.354152
F(5, 5) 0.552944 P-value(F) 0.734359
Durbin-Watson 1.951973
134
Source: Prepared by Researcher
Table 5.27 presents the regression results of Pakistani Sugar and sugar confectionaies industry.
The adjusted R square 35.42% which suggests that almost 35.41 % changes in the selected data
are due to these five explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variable is 3.91
and shows a negative relationship between factor condition and competitive advantage. The
coefficient of demand conditions is 0.62 which shows that there is a positive relationship between
demand conditions and a competitive advantage. The coefficient for supporting and related
industries is 4.75 and shows a positive relationship with the competitive advantage of the country.
The coefficient for firm strategy and rivalry is -0.37 and shows a negative relationship with the
competitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for government policy variable is 6.93 and
shows a positive relationship with the competitive advantage of the country. The overall model
is statistically significant with F value of 0.552 and P-value 0.73. The T-statistics show that all
the variables are statistically insignificant at the 5% significance level. The DW statistics suggest
the data is free from Auto Correlation from Auto Correlation.
Table 5 28 Summary Statistics Pakistan Inorganic Chemicals
Variable Mean Median Min Max S.D skew Kurt
FC -6.308e-19 -0.03 -0.08 0.19 0.08 1.27 1.02
DC 3.154e-018 -0.03 -0.31 0.27 0.19 -0.01 -1.28
SRI -9.090e-09 0.01 -0.18 0.10 0.08 -0.90 0.20
FSSR 1.818e-008 0.015 -0.19 0.12 0.08 -1.17 1.79
GP -0.0002 0.006 -0.10 0.06 0.05 -0.59 -0.43
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.28 shows the summary statistics of Pakistaniinorganic chemical industry. In order to
check the normality of the data the value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all the variable
shows less than 2 value. This suggests that the data is normally distributed.
Table 5 29 Correlation Matrix - Inorganic Chemical Industry Pakistan. FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.O0 0.54 -0.31 -0.16 -0.47
DC 1.00 0.04 0.22 0.30
135
SR 1.00 0.89 0.52
FSSR 1.00 0.49
GP 1.00
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.29 shows the correlation matrix of explanatory variables of the inorganic
chemical Pakistan model. The result suggests that the problem of the multicollinearity
is not present in the data.
Table 5 30 ADF Unit Root Test Result Inorganic Chemical Industry
Pakistan VARIABLE ESTIMATED –VALUE TEST STATICIC P-VALUE
CA -0.61 -1.92 0.31
FC 0.25 0.72 0.98
DC -0.13 -2.44 0.15
SRI -0.67 -1.99 0.28
FSSR -0.93 -2.63 0.12
GP -0.42 -1.02 0.69
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.30 shows the results of the ADF test for each variable. This test was run individually for
each Variable. In case the variable is notstationary, the first difference was taken.
Table 5 31 Regression Results Inorganic Chemical Industry Pakistan
Variable Coefficient Std. Error t-ratio p-value
FC −0.99 0.83 −1.19 0.29
DC 0.96 0.27 3.45 0.02
SR 0.15 0.89 0.17 0.87
FSSR 0.79 0.71 1.10 0.33
GP 1.53 0.96 1.59 0.18
Adjusted R-squared 0.79
F(5, 4) 7.74
P-value(F) 0.03
Durbin-Watson 1.82
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.31 presents the results of regression results for the inorganic chemical industry of Pakistan.
The adjusted R square 78.92 %,which suggests that almost 78.92 % changes in the selected data
are due to these five explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variable is 0.99
and shows a positive relationship between factor condition and competitive advantage. The
136
coefficient of demand conditions is 0.96 which shows that there is a positive relationship between
demand conditions and competitive advantage. The coefficient for supporting and related
industries is 0.15 and shows a positive relationship with the competitive advantage of the country.
The coefficient for firm strategy and rivalry is 0.79and shows a positive relationship with the
competitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for government policy variable is 1.53 and
shows a positive relationship with the advantage of the country. The overall model is statistically
significant with F value of 7.74and with P-value 0.03. The T-statistics show that only demand
conditions are variable is statistically significant at 5% significance level. The DW statistics
suggest the data is free from Auto Correlation.
Table 5 32 Summary Statistics Pakistan Textile
Variable Mean median Min Max S.D Skew Kurt
FC -6.3e-019 -0.02 -0.07 0.19 0.08 1.27 1.02
DC 1.8e-007 -0.04 -0.29 0.24 0.19 -0.02 -1.43
SRI -9.0e-009 0.001 -0.18 0.10 0.08 -0.90 0.20
FSSR 3.6e-008 -0.01 -0.02 0.12 0.04 2.76 5.82
GP -0.00 0.01 -0.10 0.06 0.05 -0.59 -0.43
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.32 shows the summary statistics of Pakistan edible fruits and nuts industry. In order to
check the normality of the data the value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all the variable
shows less than 2 value. This suggests that the data is normally distributed.
Table 5 33 Correlation Matrix Textile Industry Pakistan
FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.OO 0.68 -0.31 -0.26 -0.47
DC 1.00 0.01 -0.53 0.18
SR 1.00 0.32 0.51
FSSR 1.00 -0.30
GP 1.00
137
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.33 shows the correlation matrix of explanatory variables of the textile industry of
Pakistan model. The result suggests that the problem of the multicollinearity is not present in the
data.
Table 5.34 ADF Unit Root Test Result Textile industry Pakistan
Variable Estimated –value Test statistic P-value
CA -0.93 -24.49 0.00
FC 0.25 0.72 0.98
DC -0.10 -1.01 0.70
SRI -0.67 -1.99 0.28
FSSR -0.93 -24.49 0.00
GP -0.42 -1.02 0.69
Source: Prepared by Researcher
Table 5.34 shows the results of theADF test for each variable. This test was run individually for
each Variable. In case the variable is not stationary, the first difference was taken.
Table 5.35 Regression Results- Textile Industry Pakistan
Variable Coefficient Std. Error T-ratio P-value
FC −0.57 0.33 −1.72 0.14
DC −0.01 0.60 −0.01 0.99
SR −0.34 0.30 −1.12 0.31
FSSR 0.52 0.89 0.58 0.58
GP −0.06 0.54 −0.11 0.91
R-squared 0.42
Adjusted R-squared 0.28
F(5, 5) 0.74
P- value 0.62
Durbin Watson 1.038158
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.35 presents the results of regression results for the textile industry of Pakistan. The
adjusted R square 28.30%, which suggests that almost 28.30 % changes in the selected data are
due to these five explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variable is -0.57 and
shows a negative relationship between factor condition and competitive advantage. The
coefficient of demand conditions is −0.01 which shows that there is a positive relationship between
demand conditions and competitive advantage. The coefficient for supporting and related
138
industries is−0.34 and shows a negative relationship with the competitive advantage of the country.
The coefficient for firm strategy and rivalry is 0.52 and shows a positive relationship with the
competitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for government policy variable is - 0.06
and shows a positive relationship with the advantage of the country. The overall model is
statistically insignificant with an F value of 0.74 and P-value 0.62. The T-statistics show that all
the variables in the model are statistically insignificant at 5% significant level. The DW statistics
suggest the data is free from Auto Correlation.
Table 5.36 Summary Statistics – Sugar and sugar confectionaries Industry
India Variables Mean Median Min Max S.D skew Kurt
FC -9.09 0.03 -0.68 0.48 0.36 -0.34 -0.85
DC -0.001 0.09 -1.46 1.30 0.98 -0.08 -1.43
SRI -8.e-018 0.10 -1.14 1.36 0.95 0.10 -1.55
FSSR -1.e-017 0.08 -0.88 0.73 0.46 -0.51 -0.29
GP 4.3e-01 -0.02 -0.95 1.34 0.64 0.57 -0.14
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.36 shows the summary statistics ofSugar and sugar confectionaries Industry India. In
order to check the normality of the data the value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all
the variable shows less than 2 value. This suggests that the data is normally distributed.
Table 5 37 Correlation Matrix Sugar and sugar confectionaries Industry
India
FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.OO 0.35 0.37 -0.07 -0.52
DC 1.00 0.09 0.58 -0.35
SR 1.00 0.45 -0.56
FSSR 1.00 -0.09
GP 1.00
Source; prepared by the researcher
Table 5.37shows the correlation matrix of the independent variable. All the values are below
0.6, therefore, the problem of multicollinearity
139
Table 5 38 Unit Root Test Result Sugar and sugar confectionaries industry
India
Variable Estimated –value Test Statistic P-value
CA -1.04 -3.31 0.04
FC -0.99 -2.80 0.09
DC -0.2 -1.41 0.53
SRI 0.01 0.13 0.95
FSSR -0.97 -5.17 0.00
GP -0.60 -1.89 0.32
Source; Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.38 shows the results of the ADF test for each variable. This test was run individually for
each Variable. In case the variable is not stationary, the first difference was taken.
Table 5 39 Regression Results- Sugarand sugar confectionaries India
Variable Coefficient Std. Error T-ratio P-value
FC 0.94 0.62 1.51 0.21
DC −0.48 0.81 −0.60 0.59
SR −0.08 0.23 −0.34 0.75
FSSR −0.69 0.44 −1.58 0.21
GP 1.58 0.37 4.28 0.02
Adjusted R-squared 0.79
F(5, 6) 6.85
P-value(F) 0.01
Durbin-Watson 1.98
Source Prepared by Researcher
Table 5.39 presents the results of regression results of Indian Sugar and sugar confectionaries
industry. The adjusted R square 79.58%,which suggests that almost 79.58% changes in the
selected data are due to these five explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions
variable is 0.94 and shows a positive relationship between factor condition and competitive
advantage. The coefficient of demand conditions is −0.48 which shows that there is a negative
relationship between demand conditions and competitive advantage. The coefficient for
supporting and related industries is −0.08 and shows a negative relationship with the national
competitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for firm strategy and rivalry is -0.69 and
shows a negative relationship with the national competitive advantage of the country. The
coefficient for government policy variable is 1.58 and shows a positive relationship with the
140
advantage of the country. The overall model is statistically significant with F value of 6. 85and
P-value 0.01 The T-statistics show that demand conditions and firm strategy and rivalry variable
are statistically significant at 5% significant level. The DW statistics suggest the data is free from
Auto Correlation.
Table 5 40 Summary Statistics India Edible Fruits and Nuts
Variables Mean Median Min Max S.D Skew Kurt
FC -9.0e-007 0.03 -0.68 0.48 0.36 -0.34 -0.85
DC -9.0e-007 -0.012 -1.40 1.23 0.97 -0.08 -1.46
SRI -8.8e-018 0.10 -1.14 1.36 0.95 0.10 -1.55
FSSR 6.3e-018 0.08 -0.64 0.79 0.45 0.051 -0.90
GP 4.1e-018 -0.021 -0.95 1.34 0.64 0.57 -0.15
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.40 shows the summary statistics of India edible fruits and nuts industry. In order to check
the normality of the data the value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all the variable shows
less than 2 value. This suggests that the data is normally distributed.
Table 5 41 Correlation Matrix - Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry India FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.OO 0.37 -0.01 -0.50 0.06
DC 1.00 0.048 -0.51 0.25
SR 1.00 -0.39 0.10
FSSR 1.00 -0.47
GP 1.00
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.41 shows the correlation matrix of explanatory variables of edible fruits
and nuts industry India model. The result suggests that the problem of the
multicollinearity is not present in the data.
Table 5 42 Unit Root Test Result Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry
India Variable Estimated –value Test Statistic P-value
CA -0.28 -2.71 0.10
141
FC -0.99 -2.80 0.09
DC -0.05 -0.76 0.78
SRI 0.012 0.13 0.95
FSSR -1.32 -3.51 0.03
GP -0.60 -1.89 0.32
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.42 shows the results of the ADF test for each variable. This test was run
individually for each Variable. In case the variable is nor stationary, the first
different was taken.
Table 5 43 Regression Results- Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry
India Variable Coefficient Std. Error t-ratio p-value
FC 0.85 0.35 2.43 0.06
DC −2.50 1.30 −1.92 0.11
SR 1.70 1.25 1.37 0.23
FSSR 0.07 0.25 0.32 0.77
GP 0.57 0.32 1.81 0.13
Adjusted R-squared 0.43
F(5, 5) 1.77
P-value(F) 0.27
Durbin-Watson 1.63
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.43 presents the results of regression resultsinIndia, Ediblefruit and nuts industry. The
adjusted R square 43.37 %, which suggests that almost 43.37 % % changes in the selected data are
due to these five explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variable is 0.85 and
shows a positive relationship between factor condition and competitive advantage. The coefficient
of demand conditions is −2.50which shows that there is a negative relationship between demand
conditions and competitive advantage. The coefficient for supporting and related industries is
1.70 and shows a positive relationship with the national competitive advantage of the country.
The coefficient for firm strategy and rivalry is 0.07 and shows a negative relationship with the
national competitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for government policy variable is
0.57 and shows a positive relationship with the advantage of the country. The overall model is
statistically insignificant withF value of 1.77 and P-value 0.273. The T-statistics show that not
a single variable is statistically significant at the 5% significance level. The DW statistics suggest
the data is free from Autocorrelation.
142
Table 5 44 Summary Statistics -India Inorganic Chemicals
Variable Mean Median Min Max S.D Skew Kurt
FC -9.09e-007 0.030 -0.68 0.48 0.36 -0.34 -0.85
DC 0.0000 0.44 -1.40 0.94 0.90 -0.34 -1.54
SRI -8.83e-018 0.10 -1.14 1.36 0.95 0.10 -1.55
FSSR 6.93e-018 0.048 -0.93 0.83 0.51 -0.25 -0.58
GP 4.10e-018 -0.021 -0.95 1.34 0.64 0.56 -0.15
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.44 shows the summary statistics ofIndian Inorganic Chemicals. In order to check the
normality of the data the value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all the variable shows
less than 2 value. This suggests that the data is normally distributed.
Table 5 45 Correlation Matrix Inorganic Chemical Industry India
FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.00 0.24 -0.33 -0.50 0.07
DC 1.00 0.37 -0.53 0.41
SR 1.00 -0.63 0.45
FSSR 1.00 -0.47
GP 1.00
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.45 shows the correlation matrix of explanatory variables of the inorganic
chemical industry of India. The result suggests that the problem of multicollinearity
is not present in the data
Table 5 46 Unit Root Test Result Inorganic Chemical Industry
India
Variable Estimated –value Test statistic P-value
CA -1.29 -4.02 0.014
FC -0.99 -2.80 0.092
143
DC -0.23 -1.32 0.57
SRI 0.011 0.13 0.95
FSSR -1.03 -3.14 0.05
GP -0.60 -1.89 0.32
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.46 shows the results of the ADF test for each variable. This test was run individually for
each Variable. In case the variable is not stationary, the first difference was taken.
Table 5 47 Regression Results -Inorganic Chemical Industry India Variable Coefficient Std. Error T-ratio P-value
FC 0.06 0.48 0.14 0.89
DC −0.59 0.22 −2.71 0.05
SR 0.40 0.34 1.17 0.30
FSSR −0.36 0.81 −0.44 0.67
GP 0.06 0.25 0.25 0.80
Adjusted Square 0.084
f-statistics 4.343545
p-value 0.0089865
Durban Watson 2.146090
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.47 presents the regression results for the inorganic chemical industryof India. The adjusted
R square 8.040% which suggests that almost 8.4 % changes in the selected data are due to these
five explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variable is 0.06 and shows a
positive relationship between factor condition and competitive advantage. The coefficient of
demand conditions is−0.59 which shows that there is a negative relationship between demand
conditions and competitive advantage. The coefficient for supporting and related industries is
0.40 and shows a positive relationship with the national competitive advantage of the country.
The coefficient for firm strategy and rivalry is −0.36 and shows a negative relationship with the
national competitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for government policy variable
is0.06 and shows a positive relationship with the advantage of the country. The overall model is
statistically significant with F value of 4.343545 and P-value 0.00898 The T-statistics show
that all the variables are statistically insignificant at 5% significant level. The DW statistics
suggest the data is free from Auto Correlation.
Table 5 48 Summary Statistics India Textile
Variables Mean Median Min Max S.d Skew Kurt
FC -9.9e-7 0.03 -0.68 0.48 0.36 -0.33 -0.85
DC -9.099 0.09 -1.46 1.30 0.98 -0.08 -1.43
SRI -8.8e-18 0.10 -1.14 1.36 0.95 0.10 -1.55
144
FSSR -1.4193 0.08 -0.88 0.72 0.46 -0.51 -0.29
GP 4.1e-18 -0.02 -0.94 1.34 0.64 0.56 -0.14
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.48 shows the summary statistics of the Indian textile industry. In order to check the
normality of the data the value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all the variable shows
less than 2 value. This suggests that the data is normally distributed.
Table 5 49 Correlation Matrix Textile Industry India
FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.OO 0.37 0.36 -0.19 -0.52
DC 1.00 0.69 0.71 -0.53
SR 1.00 0.70 -0.56
FSSR 1.00 -0.34
GP 1.00
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.49 shows the correlation matrix of explanatory variables of the Indian
textile industry. The result suggests that the problem of multicollinearity is not
present in the data.
Table 5 50 Unit Root Test Result Textile Industry India
Variable Estimated –value Test staticic P-value
CA -0.98 -2.78 0.095
FC -0.99 -2.80 0.092
DC -0.05 -0.75 0.788
SRI 0.011 0.134 0.950
FSSR -0.62 -2.21 0.213
GP -0.60 -1.89 0.321
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.50 shows the results of the ADF test for each variable. This test was run
individually for each Variable. In case the variable is nor stationary, the first different
was taken.
Table 5 51 Regression Results- Textile Industry India
Variable Coefficient Std. Error T-ratio P-value
FC −5.30 1.564 −3.38 0.01
DC −1.49 3.597 −0.41 0.69
145
SR 3.76 3.57 1.053 0.34
FSSR −4.38 1.50 −2.90 0.03
GP −0.22 0.72 −0.31 0.76
Adjusted-R square 077
F -Value(5,5) 3.37
p-value (F) 0.103
Durbin-Watson 2
Source: Prepared by Researcher
Table5.51 presents the regression results for the textile industry of India. The adjusted R square
77.16%, which suggests that almost 77.16 % changes in the selected data are due to these five
explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variable is -5.30 and shows a negative
relationship between factor condition and competitive advantage. The coefficient of demand
conditions is −1.49 which shows that there is a negative relationship between demand conditions
and competitive advantage. The coefficient for supporting and related industries is 3.76 and shows
a positive relationship with thecompetitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for firm
strategy and rivalry is −4.38 and shows a negative relationship with the competitive advantage of
the country. The coefficient for government policy variable is −0.22 and shows a positive
relationship with the advantage of the country. The overall model is statistically significant with
F value of 3.37 and P-value 0.103 The T-statistics show that all the variables are statistically
significant at 5% significance level. The DW statistics suggest the data is free from Auto
Correlation.
Table 5 52Corrélation Matrix Agriculture Industry-India
FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.OO 0.26 -0.16 -0.50 0.06
DC 1.00 0.57 -0.47 0.31
SR 1.00 -0.53 0.26
FSSR 1.00 -0.47
GP 1.00
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.51 shows the correlation matrix of explanatory variables of
IndianAgriculture industry. The result suggests that the problem of
multicollinearity is not present in the data.
Table 5 53 Panel unit Root Test Result Agriculture Industry India
146
Variable Estimated –value Test Statistic P-value
CA -0.95 -3.53 0.03
FC -0.99 -2.80 0.09
DC 0.14 -1.45 0.51
SRI 0.01 0.13 0.95
FSSR -0.80 -2.94 0.07
GP -0.60 -1.89 0.32
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table 5.53 shows the results of the ADF test for each variable. This test was run individually for
each Variable. In case the variable is not stationary, the first difference was taken.
Table 5 54 Regression results for Agriculture industry- India.
Variable Coefficient Std. Error T-ratio P-value
FC 9.97 5.70 1.75 0.14
DC_1 5.36 3.93 1.36 0.23
SR −11.63 4.07 −2.85 0.03
FSSR_1 −7.441 5.20 −1.42 0.21
GP 27.88 8.19 3.40 0.01
Adjusted R-squared 0.75
F(5, 5) the 3.26
P-value(F) 0.11
Durbin-Watson 1.86
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
Table5.54 presents the regression results for agriculture industry India. The adjusted R square
75.90 %,which suggests that almost 75.90 % changes in the selected data are due to these five
explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variable is 9.97 and shows a positive
relationship between factor condition and competitive advantage. The coefficient of demand
conditions is5.36 whichshow that there is a positive relationship between demand conditions and
competitive advantage. The coefficient for supporting and related industries is −11.63 and shows
a negative relationship with the competitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for firm
strategy and rivalry is −7.441 and shows a negative relationship with the competitive advantage of
the country. The coefficient for governmentpolicy variable is 27.88 and shows a positive
relationship with the advantage of the country. The overall model is statistically significant with
F value of 3.26 and P-value 0.11 The T-statistics show that only government policy variable is
147
statistically significant at 5% significance level. The DW statistics suggest the data is free from
Auto Correlation.
CHAPTER # 6
ANALYSIS AND DISCUSSION
This chapter will provide an analysis of the results presented in the previous chapter. The
research was conducted with the intention to find the sources of competitive advantage for Pakistan
and India. Both neighboring countries are sharing a common border, culture, climatic condition,
common language, values, rituals and demand patterns, but still, there are many hurdles in the free
trade between both countries. This chapter will provide a detailed analysis and discuss
opportunities, hurdles and any other problems faced by the selected industries of both countries.
6.1. Ratio Analysis
The ratio analysis is the first step toward trade policy analysis, they help an analyst to have
an idea about the general pattern of trade.
The first ratio applied was the Interregional trade ratio, which shows a very low value for
intra-regional trade between Pakistan and India for all the industries, suggesting a costly future
trade between two countries. The second ratio applied was the intra-regional trade intensity
suggests that the results are less than one in all the years analyzed and suggest that collective trade
of Pakistan and India is not very significant in the world. The ratio of Intraregional trade
introversion index gives negative values for all the years which suggest and extra-regional bias.
The third index used was Revealed Comparative Advantage to measure the comparative
advantage or disadvantage of a country in certain good or the commodities measuring of its trade
flows. The results of the ratio when applied to Pakistani industries suggest that the textile Pakistan
performed very well in 2005 with RCA of more than 12 but the performance was declining after
148
that, but the industry remained competitive with RCA of more than one, in the year 2009, 2013
and 2014 it lost its competitiveness but regain it in 2015. In inorganic chemical industry, the result
showed Pakistan is not at all competitive in this industry with RCA of less than one in all the years
under study. In the agriculture and food industry, the RCA results show that the country is not
competitive in all the years. The same results were found in sugar and edible fruits and nuts
industries. Mehmood (2004) also applied RCA indices to Pakistani nonagriculturalproducts from
1990 to 2000 and found that except for 1999-2000, 20 out of top 25 product line were from textile
and clothing industry In 1999 and 2000 18 and 19 respectively were from textile and clothing.
The revealed comparative advantage was relatively stable during the entire period under study,
this was due to its consistency in natural climate and human resource available in the country. The
analysis reveals the failure of Pakistan to upgrade its technology in the value chain and had not
moved from low-value-added products to technology-intensivehigh-value products.
In the case of India, this ratio suggests that India is very competitive in the textile industry and
is able to sustain that position consistently. In inorganic chemical industry, the result showed that
in 2005 and 2006 the country had a comparative advantage, but lost this advantage in 2007, 2008
and 2009, but regain its competitive advantage in 2010 but was not able to sustain that position for
the rest of the years. The agriculture industry in India has gained competitive advantage except for
the year 2005 and 2009. In the sugar industry in 2005 the country’s performance was not very
good, but it gains a competitive advantage in all the other years except for 2009. The edible fruits
and nuts industry were very competitive for 2005 till 2009 but lost its competitiveness afterward.
The comparative analysis of revealed comparative advantage (Annexure # 1) suggests that India
is more competitive in different industries, as compared to Pakistan.
6.2. Regression Analysis
Before applying regression augmented Dickey-Fuller unit root test was applied to test the
stationarity of the data, otherwise the findings of the study would be inconsistent and biased
(Breusch and Pagan,1980; Pesaran, 2004).
6.2.1. Regression Analysis –Pakistan
The results of the fixed effect model show that overall model is significant, which suggests
that the overall model is significant,therefore, Pakistan’s national comparative advantage can be
explained by the independent variables tested and identified in the model. This favors the national
149
diamond model presented by Porter (1990). The regression results for Pakistan suggested a
significant impact of factor conditions, demand condition, supporting and related industries and
government policy on the national competitive advantage. This shows that Pakistani exports are
positively affected by the abundant natural resources available in the country which supports the
results of Zia (2006) who also suggestthat Pakistan is factor driven country and there are signs of
growth in the economy. This also supports the results of Raja (2015) that Pakistan is endowed with
fertile soil, climate, hardworking human resource working in the areas of information technology,
finance and engineering, who is providing a strong base for exports. The variable of factor
conditions suggestsan insignificant negativerelationship withthe national competitive advantage
of Pakistan. This contradicts the resultsof Abbas and Waheed (2015), who suggested a positive
relationship between the irrigated land area and exchange rate against US dollars with the export
competitiveness of Pakistan. It also contradicts the results of Afridi (2016). Who found a positive
relationship between different factor conditions, including human capital on the economic growth
of Pakistan and suggested an investment in education and health sector to achieve long-term
benefits. As the p-value is greater than 0.05 therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship
between factor conditions and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The reason might
be unskilled labor situation with an increase in the flight of both skilled and unskilled human
capital to developed countries suggested by (Husain, 2001). As compared to India and China the
development of human capital is very weak, with very low productivity. There is also a very slow
growth in private investment with poor infrastructure which are major impediments to the growth
of the economy (Chaudry, 2007). As suggested by Afza and Nazir (2007) that despite having a
large population majority, Pakistan has utilized only 20% of its population on professional,
managerial and technical positions, a Major portion of its workforce is engaged in the industrial
and agricultural workforce at the Frontline. Financial resources for the business sector are also
rudimentary and very restricted as compared to countries following export growth led policies.
FDI can be identified as a potential external source of finance and continuous inflow of its help in
value addition of much industry, transfer of technology and improvement of labor skills but
Pakistan is also lagging behind to attract the potential amount of FDI. Additionally, Pakistan is
not efficiently in research and development as compared to East Asian countries, for the
achievement of sustainable growth (Mahmood & Ahmed, 2017).
150
The results of demand conditions suggest positive and insignificant with national
competitive advantage. This suggests that demand conditions are not playing a significant role in
the national competitive advantage of Pakistan. This contradicts the results of Abbas and Waheed
(2015) suggested who suggested a negative relationship between domestic consumption demand
with the export competitiveness. The reason might be the low technology production trap
identified by Zia (2013), the preference of buyers to purchase to export items, lack of purchasing
power of the majority population due to high poverty levels. Therefore the hypothesis of a
significant relationship between demand conditions and the national competitive advantage is
rejected
The variable of supporting and related industries suggests a positive but insignificant relationship
with national competitive advantage national competitive advantage. The reason might be the
critical challenges faced by the transport and logistics sector include non-declaration of transport
and logistics as an industry by the government, lack of proper investment in transport infrastructure
by the government, no government licensing authority for freight cargo transporters, no official
law enacted for transport sector in Pakistan, outdated legal framework for carriage of goods by
roads, lack of rail services and logistics to transport containers from ports, damage of roads and
other infrastructure due to floods, run down roads and transport network, restrictions on provision
of bonded transport, high cost for less than container load, non-operation of Pakistan Railways on
commercial basis, lack of road safety devices, resulting in road accidents (Masood ,2011).
Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between related and supporting industries
and the national competitive advantage is rejected
Firm strategy and rivalry showa negative and insignificant relationship with the national
competitive advantage of Pakistan. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
firm strategy and rivalry and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The reason might
increasethe cost of doing business in Pakistan identified by the Department of International Trade
(2015). Mahmood and Ahmed (2017) also identified the increased cost of setting and running a
business in Pakistan, which might be the result of high inflation and poor security situations.
National Tariff Commission (NTC),(2015) also identified the high cost of doing business and the
veryunfriendly socioeconomic environment in Pakistan.
151
The variable of government policy shows a positive and significant relationship with
national competitive advantage showing government positive role in increasing the national
competitive advantage of the country. The reason might be the liberalization policies introduced
in the country. It is also supported by Pakistan country report (2010), whi9ch suggest that the
country is trying to adopt trade liberalization policies, privatization of many public owned
organizations and attracted FDI which might have impacted the positive impact on the national
competitive advantage. According to Mahmood & Ahmed (2017), increased tariffs had restricted
the imports of certain items which boosted some domestic and increases exports of the country,
but in the long run, they will seriously damage the competitive advantage of the country so applied
tariffs should be decreased. Amjad.et. al (2012) performeda firm-level survey using data from
Pakistan and suggested that the key impediment to Pakistan export competitiveness are, skilled
labor shortages, energy crises, poor infrastructure,and market imperfection. A clear and practical
government policy should be devised to solve these problems which help to expand the Pakistan
export market. Another issue identified by Husain and Ahmed (2017) was sector picking for export
promotion which boosts exports of the certain sector but seriously damages others. Therefore,
uniform policies should be devised for the balanced growth of the economy. The benefits of
decreased Soil prices should be passed to manufacturers for cost saving (Hussain, 2017). Another
issue of customs clearance and shipping documentation should also be revised for better
performance. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significantrelationship between government policy
andthe national competitive advantage is accepted is rejected.
6.2.2. Regression Analysis- India
The results of fixed effect model show that the overall model is significant for India
therefore in national comparative advantage is determined by the independent variables
identified in the model which follows the national diamond model presented by Porter (1990).
The empirical results suggest a positive but insignificant relationship between factor conditions
and national competitive advantage of India. This follows the results of planning commission of
India, suggesting that despite having abundance labor force, the rigid labor laws had restricted
the growth and seriously hindered the labor market growth. Therefore, the hypothesis of a
significant relationship between factor conditions and the national competitive advantage is
rejected.
152
The result shows a positive but insignificant relationship between demand conditions and a
national competitive advantage. The hypothesis of a significantrelationship of demand condition
and the national competitive advantage is rejected. This follows the result of Agarwal (2013)
suggested that the large size and increasing disposable incomes of Indian population has made a
profitable market., addition highly demanding and informed customer can play a vital role in
improving the competitive advantage of the Indian market but due to increased working hours
customers have less evaluation and selection of their desired products, this contradicts the result
of Dey (2017) who suggest That the political, social and technological environment had
transformed the behavior of Indian consumer. As they now spending more on different items. The
widespread increase of the use of the internet and social media and urbanization had contributed a
lot in this changing purchasing patterns.
In the case of Supporting and related industry, results suggest a negative and insignificant
relationship between supporting and related industries and national competitive advantage.
Therefore, the hypothesis of an insignificant relationship between this variable is rejected. The
reason might be the problem of traffic congestions, which greatly contributed to the problem of
the Indian economy. Additionally, the Indian mobile subscription had drastically increased with
the addition of 3 million every month (Gopal &Srinivasan, 2006). But still, they are not able to
contribute to the exports of the country.
Firm strategy and rivalry showa positive and significant relationship with the national competitive
advantage of India. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between firm rivalry and
strategy and the national competitive advantage is accepted. This is due to favorable business
conditions and ease of doing business in India which showed improvement in world bank ranking
(George, 2015).
The variable of government policy shows a positive and significant relationship with
national competitive advantage showing that Government policy is playing a positive role in
increasing the national competitive advantage of the country. Therefore, the hypothesis of a
significantrelationship between government policy and the national competitive advantage is
accepted. The reason might be the liberalization policies adopted by the Indian government
(Gurcharan,2002). Poddar (2004) also identified that in order to overcome the balance of payment
problem Indian government had introduced a series of trade liberalization reforms and positively
153
impacted exports. India continued to follow the policy of Since, 1991, continued to follow the
policy of economic liberalization and shifted towards market-based economy (OECD, 2011).
6.2.3. Regression Analysis -Pakistan Agriculture Industry
The result of the regression model expressed that the overall model is significant for
Pakistani agriculture industry. It confirms that all variables identified in the model collectively
have a significant impact on the national competitive advantage of trade Pakistan agriculture
industry.
The empirical results suggest a negative and significant relationship between factor
conditions and national competitive advantage. The results are significant; therefore, we will
accept the hypothesis of a significant relationship between factor conditions and national
competitive advantage. This shows that factor conditions are negatively impacting competitive
advantage, the reason might health issues andnoncollaboration of research institutions and crop
growers identified by Afridi (2016). Requiring heavy investment and serious policy consideration
in these areas overcoming numerous growing constraints which are affecting yield and quality of
crops to achieve long-term benefits in Pakistan economic development. Additionally,
Insufficiency of research due to the lack of financial assistance by the government and; the spread
of crop diseases might be negatively affectingthe competitiveness of this industry.
The result found a positive and insignificant relationship between demand conditions and
a national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of the significant relationship of
demand condition with the national competitive advantage was rejected. This supports the results
of Zia (2013) who identified thatin Pakistan low technology production trap and buyerspreference
to purchase, exported goods, and lack of purchasing power of majority population due to high
poverty levels. It also supports the results of Abbas and Waheed (2015) who found a highly
competitive advantage for Pakistanis agriculture industry from 2003 to 2014 but with sluggish
growth.
A significant and negative relationship was found between supporting and related industry
and national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
firm strategy and rivalry was accepted.
154
Firm strategy and rivalry show negative and insignificant relationship with national competitive
advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between firm strategy and rivalry
is rejected. The reason might increasethe cost of doing business in Pakistan identified by the
Department of International Trade (2015). Mahmood and Ahmed (2017) also identified the
increased cost of setting and running a business in Pakistan, which might be the result of high
inflation and poor security situations. NTC, (2015) also identified the high cost of doing business
and the veryunfriendly socioeconomic environment in Pakistan.
The variable of government policy shows a positive and significant relationship with
national competitive advantage showing government positive role in increasing the national
competitive advantage of the country. Therefore, the null hypothesis of a significant relationship
was accepted.
6.2.4. Regression Analysis- Edible Fruits And Nuts Industry Pakistan
The result of the regression model expressed that the overall model is insignificant for
Pakistani edible fruits and nuts industry. The shows that the independent variable identified in the
model are not determining the competitive advantage of this industry. In the case of Factor
condition the empirical results suggest a negative and an insignificant relationship between factor
conditions and national competitive advantage, therefore the hypothesis of a significant
relationship between factor condition and the national competitive advantage is rejected. This
contradicts the results of Afraid (2016) who found suggested a positive relationship between
different factor conditions including human capital on the economic growth of Pakistan. This
results also follow the results of World Bank, (2009) which suggest that this industry has weak
factor condition like unskilled labor and advance factors and low research and development.
The results suggest a positive and insignificant relationship between demand conditions
and a national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship
between demand conditions and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The main reason
might be is that, despite rising demand for horticultural products, the growers only increasing the
quantity of the production, not the quality of production (World Bank, 2006). Another reason
might be the low technology production trap identified by Zia (2013). The lack of purchasing
power of the majority population due to high poverty levels. Another issue might be lack of
demand-oriented production accompanied by a poor-quality certification (Ali, 2012.). potential
155
international demand is also not catered, because of noncompliance with the international
standards (Ali, 2012).
There is a positive and insignificant relationship between supporting and related industry
and national competitive advantage, therefore the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
supporting and related industry is rejected. The reasons might be unstandardized grading,
packaging, lack of addition and other policy constraints. The country had started mechanization of
grading packaging, but the industry had shortages of storage facilities, which results in the loss of
fruit production during harvesting, transportation,and storage (Ali, 2012).
Firm strategy and rivalry show negative and insignificant relationship with national
competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between firm
strategy and rivalry and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The reason might
increasethe cost of doing business in Pakistan identified by the Department of International Trade
(2015). Mahmood and Ahmed (2017) also identified the increasedcost of setting and running a
business in Pakistan, which might be the result of high inflation and poor security situations. NTC,
(2015) also identified the high cost of doing business and the veryunfriendly socioeconomic
environment in Pakistan.
The variable of government policy shows a negative and insignificant relationship with
national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
government policy and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The reason might be
inconsistence policies and lack of execution of plans. The government is following a restrictive
policy which is seriously harming the industry (World Bank, 2006). The Delegates attend seminars
and exhibitions abroad but are not contributing to the development of the industry as identified by
Aazim (2016). As Pakistan is an agricultural country and the government should design proper
policies and ensure their implementation for the deployment of this industry.
6.2.5. Regression Analysis-Sugar and Sugar Confectionaries Industry
Pakistan
The regression results show that the overall model is insignificant. This suggests that national
comparative advantage of Pakistan sugar and sugar confectionery industry is not determined by
the independent variable identified in the model. The empirical results suggest that there is a
156
positive but insignificant relationship between factor conditions and national competitive
advantage, therefore the hypothesis of a significantrelationship between factor conditions and the
national competitive advantage is rejected. This result is inconsistent with the results of Afridi
(2016) who suggested a positive relationship between different factor conditions and national
competitive advantage.The reasons might be critical problems faced by the sugar industry, delayed
payment by the millers to growers, the unscientific and obsolete technology used by farmers and
delayed crushing due to delayed payment to farmers (ICMAP, 2015). The average yield per
hectare of sugar is also very low as compared to the world and even below India which had similar
soil and weather condition. There is also, a large gap between the yield obtained from the ordinary
farmer field and yield from experimental stations. Sugar mills are also producing below their
capacity. The main reason behind these problems wasthat most of the sugar mills are owned by
political personalities, many of which were financed by DFIs which results into working capital
crisis, which results in to close down of many mills (Whizz Mag, 2009). Other problems include
late planting, early and late harvesting, outdated methods of planting and agricultural practice, very
low soil fertility, poor management, low Variety of outputs, non-availability of credit.
The results showed a positive and insignificant relationship between demand conditions and
a national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
demand conditions and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The reason might be the
low technology production trap identified by Zia (2013). The buyers prefer to purchase, export
goods. The lack of purchasing power of the majority population due to high poverty levels. The
results suggest a negative and insignificant relationship between supporting and related industry
and national competitive advantage, therefore the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
supporting industries and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The main cause might
be the increased transportation cost identified by Khushk et. al (2011). The inefficient
transportation and costly transportation whichhad increased the cost of sugar for growers (Saeed,
2013: 1CMA, 2015). The variable of government policy shows a positive and insignificant
relationship with national competitive advantage. therefore the hypothesis of a significant
relationship between government policy and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The
reason might be unchecked growth by the government. The used of nepotism in sanctioning of
projects. All this has contributed to the problems of newly established units (Wayback Machine,
2015). The other reason might be the stringent policies of the government which has decreased
157
exports of sugar as the state has allowed only paper contract against the letter of credit and also
advance payments, which discouraged the exporters to export more in the global market (Saeed,
2013). Another problem is price fixation delays by the government (ICMAP, 2015).
6.2.6. Regression Analysis- Inorganic Chemical Industry Pakistan
The results showed that the overall model is significant this suggest that national competitive
advantage of Pakistan inorganic chemical industry is determined by the independent variables
identified in the Porter national diamond model. The empirical results suggest a negative and
insignificant relationship between factor conditions and national competitive advantage of
Pakistan. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between factor conditions and the
national competitive advantage is rejected This contradicts the results of Afridi (2016) who
suggested a positive relationship between different factor conditions, including human capital on
the economic growth of Pakistan. The results suggest a positive relationship between a positive
relationship between demand conditions and national competitive advantage, but the results are
insignificant. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between demand conditions
and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The reason might be the low technology
production trap identified by Zia (2013). The results show a positive and significant relationship
between supporting and related industry and national competitive advantage. Therefore, the
hypothesis of a significant relationship between supporting and related industries and the national
competitive advantage is accepted. The result shows the negative and insignificant relationship
between Firm strategy and rivalry with the national competitive advantage of Pakistan. Therefore,
the hypothesis ofa significant relationship between these two variables is rejected. The reason
might increasethe cost of doing business in Pakistan identified by the Department of International
Trade (2015). Mahmood and Ahmed (2017) also identified the increased cost of setting and
running a business in Pakistan, which might be the result of high inflation and poor security
situations. NTC, (2015) also identified the high cost of doing business and the veryunfriendly
socioeconomic environment in Pakistan.
The variable of government policy shows a positive and insignificant relationship with
national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
government policy and the national competitive advantage is rejected. this follows the result of
Hussain &Ahmed (2011) who recommended an urgent requirement of deregulation of subsidies
158
and tax incentives fortrue innovation and entrepreneurship. Amjad.et.al (2012) also recommends
that clear and practical government policy should be devised to solve the problems of export
problems of Pakistan.
6.2.7. Regression Analysis- Textile Industry Pakistan
The results show that the overall model is insignificant in case of Pakistani textile industry.
Therefore, the national comparative advantage of this industry is not determined by the
independent variables identified in the model. The empirical results suggest a negative and
insignificant relationship between factor conditions and national competitive advantage of
Pakistan. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between the two variable is
rejected. This contradicts the results of Afridi (2016) who suggested a positive relationship
between different factor Conditions, including human capital on the economic growth of Pakistan.
The reason might be a lack of skilled labor. As the world is rapidly changing new technologies are
introduced, but this industry is not absorbing and not adopting new methods, procedures due to
which there is high turnover and also lack motivation which had adversely affected the whole
industry. There alsoa lack of technical education related to the industry. The industry also faces
the problem of lack of investment and fluctuation in the raw material prices, lack investment in
R&D (Tahir, 2013). As highlighted by World Bank (2016), unlike its other South Asian neighbors,
lack of female participation in Pakistan’s textile industry is one of the major obstacles which are
keeping its growth below potential. There is a negative and insignificant relationship between
demand conditions and anational competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant
relationship between the two variable is rejected. The reason might be the low technology
production trap identified by Zia (2013). Abass and Waheed(2015) also suggested that the export
competitiveness of raw cotton had increased, whereas, the textile industry faced a competitive
disadvantage. Another challenged recently Emerged which badly damaged the industry by the
imposition of strict environmental standards as part of the worldwide response of businesses and
government for ecological friendly composition and production (Memon, 2015: Shah et.al,2014).
There is a negative and significant relationship between supporting and related industry and
national competitive advantage. therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
supporting and related industry and the national competitive advantage is accepted. This shows
that this variable is negatively impacting the industry. The reasons might be gas and electricity
shortages, closure and shift of Majority of looms to Bangladesh, then the global recession
159
increased the cost of production which badly affected the growth rate of the industry, lack of
research and development, and very limited use of modernized technology (Tahir, 2013). The
variable Firm strategy and rivalry showa negative and insignificant relationship with the national
competitive advantage of Pakistan. Therefore the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
firm strategy and rivalry and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The major reasons
might be energy crises, tax policies and corruption, which is complicating the
businessenvironmentin the country. Other reasons includethe increased cost of doing business in
Pakistan identified by the Department of International Trade (2015). Mahmood and Ahmed (2017)
also identified the increased cost of setting and running a business in Pakistan, which might be the
result of high inflation and poor security situations. NTC, (2015) also identified the high cost of
doing business and the veryunfriendly socioeconomic environment in Pakistan.
The variable of government policy shows a positive and insignificant relationship with
national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
government policy and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The reasons might be the
negative role played by the government, who reduced subsidies, delay in declaration of prices and
unchecked growth (Tahir, 2013). The deregulation and privatization had placed the private sector
in the very dominating position in shaping the market. The government isalso not tackling the
market imperfections. Additionally, subsidy previously provided to the industry has also
eliminated (Wayback Machine, 2015). Also suggested that unfriendly policies, unchecked growth,
political influences, low per hectare yield as compared to global productionstandard and low
crushing capacity have negatively impacted the performance of this industry.
6.2.8. Regression Analysis-Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry India
The results show that the overall model is insignificant,therefore, the national competitive
advantage of edible fruits and nuts industry is not determined by the independent variables
identified in the model. The empirical results suggest a positive and significant relationship
between factor conditions and national competitive advantage of edible fruit and nuts sector of
India. Therefore, the significant hypothesis of the relationship between factor conditions and the
national competitive advantage is accepted. This suggests that factor condition is playing a
significant role in improving the competitive advantage of this industry, despite many problems,
160
including financial difficulties, substandard storage capacity, poor quality packaging and poor
infrastructure identified by Mir and Kottaiveeran (2016).
The empirical results suggest a negative and insignificant relationship between demand
conditions and a national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant
relationship between demand conditions and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The
reason might be insufficient production, poor quality packaging and deficient storage facilities for
these dry fruits, which resulted in the deterioration many dry fruits during transportation (Mir
&Kottaiveeran, 2016).There is a positive and insignificant relationship between supporting and
related industry and national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant
relationship between thetwo variable is rejected. This show that supporting and related industry
variable is not contributing to the national competitive advantage in this industry. The reason might
be the inefficient transportation system.
There is a negative and insignificant relationship between demand conditions and a
national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
demand conditions and the national competitive advantage is rejected. This shows that demand
conditions are not playing a significant role in improving the national competition of this
industry.Firm strategy and rivalry showa positive and insignificant relationship with the national
competitive advantage of Pakistan. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
firm strategy and rivalry and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The variable of
government policy shows a positive and insignificant relationship with national competitive
advantage. Therefore, thenull hypothesis of a significant relationship between government policy
and the national competitive advantage is rejected.
6.2.9.Regression Analysis-Inorganic Chemical Industry India
The results show that the overall model is insignificant, therefore, the national comparative
advantage of the inorganic chemical industry is not determined by the independent variables
identified in the Porter diamond model. The empirical results suggest that there is a positive and
insignificant relationship between factor conditions and national competitive advantage of the
inorganic chemical industry of India. Therefore the hypothesis of a significant relationship
between the two variable is rejected. The reason identified by Lohokare (2011) that despitehaving
161
a great pool of skilled and qualified Indian chemist., the industry is not progressing due to a
continuing trend of increased wage structure in the industry and high financing cost.
There is a negative and insignificant relationship between demand conditions and a national
competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between demand
conditions and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The reason might be increased
economic recession world over which resulted in the decline of demand for its products. The Indian
chemical industries have entered the world market and its presence is also felt in market
penetration terms. The world demand for Indian chemicals is also high, but domestic consumption
is very low (Lohokare, 2011). There is a positive and insignificant relationship between supporting
and related industry and national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant
relationship between the two variable is rejected. The reason might be the inefficient
transportation system. Firm strategy and rivalry showa negative and insignificant relationship with
national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between the
two variable is rejected. The variable of government policy shows a positive and insignificant
relationship with national competitive advantage. Therefore,the hypothesis of a significant
relationship between these two variables is rejected.
6.2.10.Regression Analysis -Textile Industry India
The results show that the overall model is significant, therefore the national comparative
advantage ofthe Indiantextile industry is determined by the independent variables identified in the
national diamond model presented by Porter (1990). The empirical results suggest a negative
relationship between factor conditions and national competitive advantage of the textile industry
of India. Rodriguez and Khan (2015) worked on clothing industries of SAFTA Countries and
suggested that the Indian clothing industry is performing better than all the other SAFTAcountries
in case of factor conditions. India is the largest yarn producer in the world, having large resources
of fibers like silk, polyester, viscose, it accounts for almost 25 % of world cotton yarn.
Additionally, they have skilled human capital, both in technical and management fields. The
design and artistic skills are also in abundance. But the main problem is that its labor cost is
comparatively higher than other competing countries like Pakistan, Bangladesh. This industry also
has disadvantages in labor productivity, technology,and modernization and it is far behind its
competitors, including Taiwan, China,and South Korea (Katharina, 2008). In the case of gents’
162
shirts, its productivity is 9.1 pieces per day per machine which very low as compared to Hong
Kong and China which is 20.9 and 14.respectively. The lower Productivity is because of the use
of obsolete technology (Rangarajan, 2005).
Demand condition shows a negative relationship with national competitive advantage, but the
results were insignificant. The reason might be the low technology production trap identified by
Zia (2013). The buyers prefer to purchase foreign goods. The lack of purchasing power of the
majority population due to high poverty levels. The country is increasing its production at a much
larger pace, but still, the industry is facing larger completion from regional competitors due to the
abolition of restriction by SAFTA agreement (Kathuria, 2008). Therefore the null hypothesis of
an insignificant relationship between demand conditions and the national competitive advantage
is rejected.
The results showa positive relationship between supporting and related industry and national
competitive advantage, but the p-value suggests an insignificant relationship. Therefore the
significant hypothesis between these two variables is rejected. The main problem of this industry
isthatthe best quality of raw material at a reasonable price is not available from the domestic
market, which is largely affected its competitiveness (USITC, 2004). Handlooms and power loom
for fabric manufacturing are also poor in quality with low technology (Kathuria, 2008). Rodrigues
and Khan (2015) also suggested that the industry is facing problems regarding poor quality
containers, and shipping documentation difficulties, steady availability of utilities, paved roads
and highways. Therefore, the null hypothesis of insignificant relationship with supporting
industries with national competitive advantage is accepted. Firm strategy and rivalry showa
negative and insignificant relationship with national competitive advantage. Therefore, the null
hypothesis of the insignificant relationship of firm strategy and rivalry with nation competitive
advantage is accepted. The results show a negative and significant relationship with national
completive advantage showing government positive role in increasing the national competitive
advantage of the country. The reason might be the liberalization policies adopted by the Indian
government.
6.2.11. Regression Analysis - Agriculture Industry India
In the case of the Indian agriculture industry. The results show that the overall model is
insignificant, therefore the national comparative advantage of Indian agriculture industry is not
163
determined by the independent variables identified in the model national diamond model identified
by Porter (1990). This result confirms the results of Parappurathu and Mathur (2008) suggested an
eroding competitive advantage of major agriculture products of India.
In the case of individual variables, the empirical results suggest a negative and significant
relationship betweenfactor conditions and national competitive advantage of India. Therefore, the
hypothesis of a significant relationship of factor condition with national; competitive advantage is
accepted. This supports the results of (Indian food report, 2016), who identified that the Indian
agriculture industry is adding less value to its product despite having a large amount of raw
material and space. Kharuband Sharma, (2017)also identified that main problem of factor
condition in Indiais non Availability of financial service, poor Quality of overall infrastructure,
lack of financial assistance and a large number of Contractual labor.
There is a positive relationship between demand conditions and national competitive
advantage, but the results are significant therefore the hypothesis of a significant relationship
between this two variable is accepted. This confirms the results of Kharub& Sharma (2017), who
identified that the main potential of the Indian economy is its large market size, large and diverse
segments of the buyer.
There is a positive relationship between supporting and related industry and national
competitive advantage but the p-values suggest an insignificant relationship. Therefore the
significant hypothesis of the relationship between this two variable is accepted. This confirms the
results of (Indian food report, 2016), who identified that the main problem in this industry is its
non-deployment of skills and lack of technology to achieve competitive on the global scale
Firm strategy and rivalry show a negative and insignificant relationship with the national
competitive advantage of India. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between
firm strategy and rivalry is rejected. The reason might be limited technology absorption and formal
training programs identified by Kharuband Sharma (2017). The results show variable of
government policy shows a positive and significant relationship with national competitive
advantage showing government positive role in increasing the national competitive advantage of
the country. Therefore the significant hypothesis of the relationship between government policy
and the national competitive advantage is accepted. The reason might be,the liberalization efforts
164
by the government additionally, the Indian government are also trying to help the private sector
with this industry by providing incentives (Indian food report, 2016).
6.2.12.Regression Analysis-Sugar And Sugar Confectionaries Industry India
The results show that the overall model is significant. This shows that the independent
variable identified in national diamond mode by porter (1990) are contributing into determining
national competitive advantage of the Indian sugar industry. The empirical results suggest a
negative and significant relationship between factor conditions and national competitive advantage
of the Indian sugar industry. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significantrelationship between factor
condition and the national competitive advantage is accepted.
The results show a negative and insignificant relationship between demand conditions and
a national competitive advantage. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship of demand
condition and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The variable supporting and related
industries show a positive and insignificant relationship between supporting industries and national
competitive advantage. The reason might be the inefficient transportation system. Therefore, the
significant relationship between these two variables is rejected. Firm strategy and rivalry showa
negative and significant relationship with the national competitive advantage of India. Therefore,
the hypothesis of a significant relationship between these two variables is accepted.
The variable of government policy showed a negative and insignificant relationship with
national competitive advantage. Therefore the hypothesis of a significantrelationship between
these two variables is rejected. The reason might unchecked growth by the government. The used
of nepotism in sanctioning of projects. All this has contributed to the problems of newly established
units (Wayback Machine, 2015).
6.3.Comparison India and Pakistan
6.3.1.Comparison – Pakistan& India
The results of the fixed effect model for Pakistan and India are significant, which suggest
that the porter diamond model is significant in contributing national competitive advantage of both
countries. So, both countries should work on the improvement of these factors for the achievement
of a better position in the global market. As both countries share the same culture, social,
165
geographical conditions and very long common border so they should cooperate and improve ties
with each for attaining the benefits of economic integration. The empirical results suggest
anegative and insignificant relationship between factor conditions and national competitive
advantage for Pakistan, but a positive and insignificant relationship forIndia. This suggested a
very alarming situation for both countries as they are not properly utilizing their factor condition.
Both countries should seriously work on the improvement of their unskilled labor, research and
development, agricultural land, internet facilities and capital resources for the business sector. As
both countries have a low productive human resource, unspecialized factor conditions, lack of
research and development low penetration of internet facilities.
Demand condition shows an insignificant relationship between demand conditions and
national competitive advantage for both countries. Both countries have a very large population,
but the majority of the population is below the poverty line and unable to fulfill their basic needs.
They are not in a position to demand high quality and sophisticated products. This is a very serious
issue, so, both countries should try to improve the poverty condition within the country. Another
issue is very high international standards of product quality. Which requires serious efforts for the
improvement of the quality of goods and services to enhance global demand.
The Supporting and related industries variable shows the insignificant relationship between
supporting and related industry and national competitive advantage for both Pakistan and India.
The major problem in both countries is poor transportation system. The traffic congestion is the
problem in both countries. Railways are in a very bad condition in Pakistan and need serious effort
for its improvement, but in India improvement is made, but it needs much more efforts for its
improvement for its active role in improving the competitiveness of the country. The mobile
subscription in both counties is increasing rapidly, therefore it does not need any serious steps, but
his rapid increase in mobile subscription had created many problems e.g. terrorism etc. therefore,
this aspect needs careful issuance of mobile subscription. Firm strategy and rivalry showa negative
and insignificant relationship with the national competitive advantage of Pakistan. But, in the case
of India, it showed a positive and significant relationship. This shows that as compared to Pakistan,
India is providing a betterenvironmentfor doing business. The intensity of completion and the
favorable environment is attracting foreign investors. Pakistan should seriously Work on this
variable as India is in better a position than Pakistan, as identified by Department of International
166
Trade (2015) and Mahmood and Ahmed (2017), doing business is verycostly in Pakistan. The
variable of government policy shows a positive and significant relationship with national
competitive advantage in Pakistan and India, which suggest that both countries are trying to
increase their exports by introducing trade liberalization policies. India as compared to Pakistan
had followed very protectionist policies till 1990, but after that gradually introduced trade
liberalization policies. Pakistan also had tried to introduce trade openness policies from time to
time. Both countries had entered into many Regional trade agreements and applied measures to
introduce sound business operations at the governmental level.
6.3.2. Comparison-AgricultureIndustry
The results showthat the overall model is significant for agriculture industry of Pakistan and
India. The reason might be that both countries are agriculturally based, supported by favorable
climatic condition, abundant labor force, land resources,and abundant water resources. The
empirical results suggest a negative and significant relationship between factor condition and
national competitive advantage in case of Pakistani agriculture industry in case of India it shows
an insignificant relationship. The results suggest serious problems in both countries. Both countries
have a large pool of labor force, but the majority is unskilled, large agricultural land, but
unspecialized farming methods, lack of research and development, very less value addition, scare
supply of finance and very poor infrastructural resources. The results show an insignificant
relationship between demand condition and national competitive advantage in both countries. This
suggests that despite having a large population, creating a huge market for domestic firms, India
have a huge middle class but, still demand conditions are not playing its role in creating
international and domestic competitive advantage.
The variable of supporting and related industry shows a negative and significant
relationship with national competitive advantage in case of Pakistan, but an insignificant
relationship in case of India. This shows that Pakistan’s supporting and related industries are
contributing negatively in the national competitive advantage of this industry due to
underdeveloped transportation system, as government is not taking keen interest in the
development of these industries, as a result this variable is not contributing into the competitive
advantage of the country, But is damaging its reputation. India is also confronted with the problem
of traffic congestion, making problems for the industry. Firm strategy and rivalry show an
167
insignificant relationship with national competitive advantage for Pakistan and India the reason
might be the uncompetitive environment, energy crises and other difficulties which are creating a
very poor atmosphere for doing business. The variable of government policy shows a positive and
significant relationship with national completive advantage in both countries, showing
government positive role in increasing the national competitive advantage of India and Pakistan
this suggests the government of both countries have realized the importance of this industry and
identified liberalization policies of boostingthe agricultureindustry, India has introduced many
measures for increasing the cooperation between private and public sector by providing many
incentives ( Indian food report, 2016). The Indian government has also introduced certain land
reforms, high-quality seeds, technical capabilities, irrigation facility and the introduction of
procurement prices and subsidy Chand (2016).
6.3.3. Comparison- Edible Fruits and Nuts Industry
The results show that the overall model is insignificant for both Pakistan and India Therefore, the
national competitive advantage of edible fruits and nuts industries of Pakistan and Indiais not
determined by the independent variables identified in the model. The reason may be the poor
transportation facilities, unskilled labor, outdating techniques for production and post-harvesting,
poor financial capacity and ignorance of producers and poor quality certification in Pakistan (Ali,
2012.). In the case of India, the problems are unorganized markets. High freight, income taxes and
storage charges, credit availability constraints, lack of storage facilities and poor quality packaging
(Mir &Kottaiveeran, 2016).The empirical results suggest an insignificant relationship between
factor conditions and national competitive advantage of the edible fruits and nuts industry in
Pakistan. The main reasons are skilled labor using outdating techniques for production and post-
harvesting, poor financial capacity and ignorance of producers, products are not produced
according to market demand and poor-quality certification (Ali, 2012.). there is a need for taking
serious steps for the development of human resourcesin thisPakistani industry. Afraid (2016) also
suggested an increased investment in education and health sector achieve long-term benefits. In
the case of India, factor condition shows a positive and significant relationship with national
competitive advantage. This suggests that despite having too many constraints India has improved
its factor condition. In the case of Pakistan, demand condition shows an insignificant relationship
with national competitive. In the case of India, the empirical results suggest a negative and
insignificant relationship. In case of Pakistan insignificant relationship might be low-quality
168
production (World Bank, 2006), low technology trap (Zia, 2013), Another issue might be less
demand-oriented production accompanied by a poor quality certification (Ali, 2012.) and
itsnoncompliance to the international standards (Ali, 2012). In the case of India, the problems are
insufficient production, poor quality packaging and deficient storage facilities for these dry fruits,
which resulted in the deterioration many dry fruits during transportation (Mir &
Kottaiveeran,2016). There is a positive and insignificant relationship between supporting and
related industry and national competitive advantage for Pakistan and India. In case of Pakistan, the
reason might be poor quality transportation facilities, unstandardized grading, packaging, lack of
addition, policy constraints, shortages of storage facilities, which results in the loss of fruits
production during harvesting (Ali, 2012). India is facing similar problems of traffic congestions
and lack of storage facilities (Mir & Kottaiveeran,2016). There is an insignificant relationship
between demand conditions and national competitive advantage in case of Pakistan but in the case
of India, it showed anegative and insignificant relationship. In the case of Pakistan, the reason is
inefficiencies such as lack of strategy, competitive positioning, lack of shared vision, and low
sector cooperation. But in the case of India, the insignificance relationshipsare the uncompetitive
environment and other issues related to doing business. The variable of government policy shows
a negative and insignificant relationship with national completive advantage in case of both
Pakistan and India. In the case of Pakistan,an insignificant relationship might be inconsistence
policies and lack of execution of plans. The government is following a restrictive policy which is
seriously harming the industry (World Bank, 2006) Delegates attend seminars and exhibitions
abroad but are not contributing to the development of the industry as identified by Aazim (2016).
But in the case of India, the insignificant relationship may be due to low profile government
policies which have made industry unable to cope with the challenges. The imposition of General
Sales Tax (GST) is also playing a negative role in the exports of this industry. India has a high
demand for dry fruits as, these fruits are used in the preparation of many sweet dishes, specially
Cashew which is the major product consumed in India. Many other products like Almonds,
pistachio, walnut raisin, fig, dates,and apricot are frequently consumed domestically (Netscribes,
2013).
4.3.4 Comparison-Sugar Industry And Sugar Confectionaries
The results show that the overall model is insignificant for Pakistan but significant in case of
India. In the case of Pakistan, the insignificant relationship might be due to unchecked growth by
169
the government, political interference (Wayback Machine, 2015), very low yield per hectare as
compared to world averages even below India. There is also a large gap between the yield obtained
from the ordinary farmer and yield from experimental stations. Sugar mills are also producing
below their capacity, due to their ownership by political personalities (Whizz Mag, 2009). Many
other problems include Late planting, early and late harvesting, outdated methods of planting and
agricultural practice, very low soil fertility, poor management, low Variety of outputs,
nonavailability of credit, increased transportation cost (Khushk, Memon and Saeed, 2011). India
is also facing similar challenges which include a lack of alignment between sugarcane prices and
sugarcane production, which leads to arrears in payment to producers. Like Pakistan low yield is
also a problem for India even the large-scale companies are struggling to maintain their
profitability due to fixed mandate prices of sugar cane (Mahajan, 2017). Pandey(2007) identified
that the industry is facing an infrastructural problem, low utilization capacity and shutting down
of many sugar mills due to low profitability. The major problem is the utilization of sugar prices
as a political tool. Despite these problems, India is able to sustain its position in the global market.
The reason might be concrete steps by the government for solving the problems of this industry.
The empirical results suggest a positive and insignificant relationship between factor conditions
and national competitive advantage of Pakistan. But in the case of India, it showed a negative and
significant relationship. In the case of Pakistan an insignificant relationship might be due to below
capacity production, ownership by political personalities (Whizz Mag,2009) late planting, early
and late harvesting, outdated methods of planting and agricultural practice, very low soil fertility,
poor management, low Variety of output, non availability of credit, increased transportation cost
(Khushk.et.al, 2011), delayed payment by the millers to growers, unscientific and obsolete
technology used by farmers and delayed crushing by the farmer due to late recovery. (ICMAP,
2015 ). In the case of India, the reasons for negative relationship includes a lack of alignment
between sugarcane prices and sugarcane production, which leads to arrears in payment to
producers. Like Pakistan low yield is also a problem for India even the large-scale companies are
struggling to maintain their profitability due to fixed mandate prices of sugar cane (Mahajan,
2017). Pandey and Agarwal (2007) identified that the industry is facing an infrastructural problem,
low utilization capacity and shutting down of many sugar mills due to low profitability. There is
an insignificant relationship between demand conditions and national competitive advantage in
Pakistan and India. In the case of Pakistan,the reason might be the low technology production trap
170
identified by Zia (2013). In the case of India, an insignificant relationship is due to the productionof
uncompetitive raw or white sugar (Mahajan, 2017). Thesupporting and related industry variable
was insignificant for both Pakistan and India. In the case of Pakistan, the insignificant relationship
might be increased transportation cost (Khushk et.al, 2011;Saeed, 2013: 1CMA, 2015). The same
reason was identified by Pandey (2007) identified that the industry is facing an infrastructural
problem, low utilization capacity and shutting down of many sugar mills due to low profitability.
The major problem is the utilization of sugar prices as a political tool. Firm strategy and rivalry
showa negative and insignificant relationship with national competitive advantage for both
Pakistan and India. The variable of government policy shows an insignificant relationship with
national completive advantage for Pakistan and India. In case of Pakistan, the insignificant
relationship might be due to stringent policies of the government which have decreased exports of
sugar as the state has allowed only paper contract against the letter of credit and also advance
payments which discouraged the exports to export more in the global market. (Saeed, 2013).
Another problem is price fixation delays by the government (ICMAP, 2015). In the case of India,
the reasons might be unchecked growth bythe government, the use of nepotism in the sanctioning
of projects. All this has contributed to the problems of newly established units (Wayback Machine,
2015).
6.3.5. Comparison- Inorganic Chemical industry
The results show that the overall model is significant for Pakistan andIndia. The empirical
results suggest an insignificant relationship between factor conditions and national competitive
advantage of the Pakistan and IndiaIn case of Pakistan the insignificant relationship might be due
to poor infrastructure, technology, financial resources and insufficient research and development
(Adress, 2015). In the case of India,an insignificant relationship might be due to the trend of
increased wage structure and very high financing cost. Demand condition shows an insignificant
relationship with national competitive advantage for both countries. In the caseof Pakistan,an
insignificant relationship might be a low technology production trap identified by Zia (2013). The
Indian chemical industry is highly impacted by increased economic recession world over which
resulted in the decline of demand for its products; another reason is very low domestic
consumption (Lohokare, 2011). Supporting and related industries show an
insignificantrelationship with national competitive advantage for both India and Pakistan. The
reason might be the inefficient transportation system. Firm strategy and rivalry insignificant
171
relationship with the national competitive advantage of Pakistan and India. The variable of
government policy shows a positive and insignificant relationship with national competitive
advantage for Pakistan and India.
6.3.6. Comparison- The Textile Industry
The overall model is insignificant in case of Pakistani textile industry, but the model is
significant in of case of India. The main reason behind the insignificance might be high inflation,
high cost of financing, high electricity tariffs, increase interest, global recession, tight monetary
policy, removal of subsidy and lack of modernization of equipment in Pakistan(Ahmed &
Tariq,2009), exposition of industry is exposed to international competition due to negligence by
the government, import substitution policies, high tariffs, intellectual property rights and, trade
defense laws and patents, etc.(Paracha, 2012) another reason is the trade policy deficiency by the
government, lack of R&D, energy crises, high prices of raw material, poor law and order situation,
and absolute and low level technology (Shah.et.al., 2012), unfriendly policies, unchecked growth,
political influences, low per hector yield as compared to global production standard and low
crushing capacity (Wayback Machine, 2015). The significance of the model in the case of India
might be due to friendly policies by the government for the improvement of the textile industry in
2000 by passing the National Textile Policy. The ministry of textile is working to improve the
coordination of human-made fiber like cotton, silk, Jude, wool industry, promotion of exports,
decentralization of power loom industry and use of information technology, etc. The empirical
results suggested a negative and insignificant relationship between factor conditions and national
competitive advantage of the textile industry of Pakistan. But in the case of India, it showed a
negative insignificant relationship. The insignificant relationship in case of Pakistan may be
increased cost of financing, high electricity tariffs, increase interest, global recession, tight
monetary policy and lack of modernization of equipment (Ahmed & Tariq,2009), another reason
is the trade policy deficiency by the government, lack of R&D, energy crises, high prices of raw
material, poor law and order situation, and absolute and low level technology (Shah.et.al., 2012),
political influences, low per hectare yield as compared to global production standard and low
crushing capacity (Wayback Machine, 2015). Another reason might be lack of skilled labor, as the
world is rapidly changing, new technologies are introduced, but this industry is not absorbing, and
are not applying new methods and procedures, due to which there are high turnover and lack of
172
motivation in the labor market, which had adversely affected the whole industry. The lack of
technical education related to the industry,lack of investment and fluctuation in the raw material
prices other reason (Tahir, 2013). As highlighted by World Bank (2016), unlike other South Asian
neighbors, lack of female participation in Pakistan’s textile industry is one of the major obstacles
which are keeping its growth below potential. In the case of India, the insignificant relationship
might be due to high labor cost as compared to other competing countries like Pakistan,
Bangladesh. This industry also has disadvantages in labor productivity, technology,and
modernization and it is far behind its competitors, including Taiwan, China,and South Korea
(Katharina, 2008). In the case of gents’ shirts, its productivity is 9.1 pieces per day per machine
which was very low as compared to Hong Kong and China which is 20.9 and 14 respectively. The
lower Productivity was due to the use of obsolete technology (Rangarajan, 2005).
There is an insignificant relationship between demand conditions and national competitive
advantage for Pakistan and India. In the case of Pakistan, the insignificant relationship might due
to low technology production trap identified by Zia (2013). The reasons behind insignificant
relationship in the case of India is that the majority of production is fragmented in small units,
which are only capable of entertaining the local market. There is a negative and significant
relationship between supporting and related industry and national competitive advantage. This
shows that supporting and related industries are playing a negative role in developing a competitive
advantage for the textile industry in Pakistan. In the case of India, it showed an insignificant
relationship. The Pakistani textile industry is confronted with gas and electricity shortages. A
majority of looms are closed and shifted to Bangladesh. The industry is also affected by the global
recession, increased the cost of production, which badly affected the growth rate of the industry
(Tahir, 2013). The Indian textile industry is also facing many problems, including low-quality raw
material, the good quality raw material at a reasonable price is not available from the domestic
market, which is largely affected, its competitiveness (USITC, 2004). Handlooms and power loom
for fabric manufacturing are also poor in quality with low technology (Kathuria, 2008). Rodrigues
and Khan (2015) also suggested that the industry is facing problems regarding poor quality
containers, and shipping documentation difficulties, steady availability of utilities, paved roads
and highways. Firm strategy and rivalry showa negative and insignificant relationship with the
national competitive advantage of Pakistan. The same result was also given by the Indian textile
industry. In the case of India, the insignificant result may be due to intense competition in the
173
regional market due to the abolition of restriction through SAFTA agreement (Kathuria, 2008).
The variable of government policy shows a positive and significant relationship with national
competitive advantage. In the case of India, it showed a positive, but an insignificant relationship.
In the case of India, the insignificant relationship stems from the negative role of government
played by reducing subsidies, delay in declaration of prices and unchecked growth (Tahir, 2013).
CHAPTER # 7
CONCLUSION, RECOMMENDATION, FUTURE DIRECTION &
LIMITATIONS
This chapter will summarize the work done in the study and conclude it by providing answers to
the questions identified in the beginning.
6.1.CONCLUSION
Exports are an important driver of the economy, which helps to boost the level of economic
growth, the balance of payment and employment. Pakistan had faced economic problems since
its independence in 1947. It was an agrarian economy at the time of independence, showing a
positive growth anddeveloped into a semi-industrialized country, but was not able to bridge a gap
between itself and developed countries. As export is one of the components of aggregate demand,
an increase in exports will increase economic growth. The export growth also accelerates service
sector and benefit the local economy. The surplus balance of trade is beneficial for the economy,
but unfortunately, Pakistan has faced the deficit balance of tradeproblem, since very long. A
serious effort is required to overcome this situation. In this regard series of steps were taken by the
government to liberalized trade. This work had tried to analyzethe prospects of trade liberalization
of Pakistan with India by using secondary data from 2005 to 2015. Based upon the number of
trade patterns, data for 5 Pakistani and Indian industries wereselected, includingtextile, Sugar and
Sugar Confectionaries, Inorganic Chemicals, edible fruits and nuts, and Agriculture. The research
was conducted with the intention to find the sources of competitive advantage for Pakistan and
India. The mixed methodology was applied. First, ratio analysis was conducted for the general
174
analysis of trade patterns between Pakistan and India. After ratio analysis, regression analysis was
applied to identify significant independent variables affecting national competitive advantage in
Pakistan and India. As both countries share a common border, culture, climatic condition,
common language, values, rituals and demand patterns, butstill theirtrade patterns are not
significant due to many hurdles in the free trade between both countries. This work had tried to
identify and recommend possible action.
The first objective was to determineand describe the Pak-India bilateral trade regime and
conditions for granting MFN status to India. In order to fulfill this objective a thorough literature
review was conducted which suggested that at the time of independence, India was Pakistan's
major trading partner accounting for 70 % of its total trade. In comparison, India accounted for
less than 5 % of Pakistan's trade. However, thecurrent bilateraltrade is strictly in favor of India.
The main reason might be,the global economic crisis as well as many tariffs and non-tariff barriers
from both sides. At present investment flows from both sides are restricted, despite having a large
potential for cross-border investment. As both sides are charged with elements such as
nationalism, prejudice' bigotry' and religious hostility since independence
In order to resolve this situation efforts had been made from Both sides in the form of bilateral
Composite Dialogue toimprove economic and political relations. For this reason, bothcountries
signedSAFTA (South Asia Free Trade Agreement) in 2006, which was to be fullyoperational
untilthe year 2015 (Baroncelli, 2007). In 2012 both countries decided to cooperate in custom and
recognition of standards, Pakistan also announced to open trade in 6800 fields, previously banned.
Visa policies were also relaxed from both sides the same year. A mutual agreement was also made
business travelers for the improvementof economic partnership (Siddique, 2013). Currently,
Pakistan had ingreater threat of terrorism, which is badly affecting its economy. The conventional
capabilities of Pakistan are not sufficient to address this issue. There is a desperate need for
improving trade relations with our neighboring countries, especially with India; which is a very
fast-growing economy in the region. Pakistan needs hisplatform to boost its economic
growth.Therefore,a visionary approach requiresthe development of an appropriate strategy which
will be based on cost-effective analysis for the nation. So, granting Most Favorite Nation (MFN)
status to India and development of free trade market is very important steps. Mutual confidence
and peaceful dialogues are required to continue trading on an equity basis. This requires an active
175
participation of politicalleaders, a neutral thinking on both sides and realistic goal of economic
stability by ignoring existing stereotypes and prejudices about each other. But it is also important
to identify the benefits to Pakistan of granting MFN status to India. The current trade flows
between Pakistan and India are strictly in favor of India, despite granting MFN status to Pakistan
by India in 1996. If Pakistan grants MFN status to India, it will further boost Indian exports
benefiting only to India. The main reason behind this situation is the imposition of high non-
tariffbarriers byIndia on Pakistani exports, which had hinderedPakistan’s entry to India. The
granting of MFN status is only beneficial to Pakistan if India relaxes its non-tariff barriers and
eliminate strict entry barriers for Pakistani products.
The second objective was to identify the effects of SAFTA on trade liberalization between India
and Pakistan and their applied status with likely pros and cons integrated intothe bilateral trade.In
order to fulfill this objective ratio analysis was conducted, six ratios were applied to trade patterns
of Pakistan and India. The values of intraregional trade ratio suggest a very low value for
intraregional future trade, which suggesting acostlytrade between Pakistan and India, this suggests
that even after so many efforts both countries are unable to benefit of trade liberalization. The
reason might be the negative list and non-tariff barrier between both countries. The second ratio
of intraregional trade intensity suggests that collective trade of Pakistan and India is not very
significant in the world. The ratio of Intraregional trade introversion index gives negative values
for all the years which suggest anextra-regional bias. As both countries are trading more with other
countries rather than with each other. The ratio of revealed comparative advantage suggests that
both countries are unable to achieve a sustainable competitive advantage in the selected industries.
But India in more competitive than Pakistan.The regional orientation of Pakistan and India shows
that Textile industry shows trade creation, whereas inorganic chemical and edible fruit and nuts
show regional biases. The ratio of the trade complementarily index shows very high value except
for textile industry suggesting high future prospects for trade in agriculture, edible fruit and nuts,
sugar and confectionary and inorganic chemical industries with India. This shows that Indian
industries are more competitive and gained more than Pakistan in Post SAFTA environment.
The third objective was to identify factors affecting Pakistan National Competitive Advantage in
trade with India during the period 2005 to 2015. In order to identify significant factor affecting
Pakistan and India trade,Porter National Diamond Model was used and a fixed effect model was
176
applied to both Pakistan and India. The results suggest that in both countries factor conditions,
demand condition, supporting and related industries, firm strategy and rivalry and government
policy play a significant role in determining nation competitive advantage in trade so, both
countries should work on the improvement of these factors for the achievement of a better position
in the global market. But when individually, factor condition was insignificant or negatively
impacting national competitive advantage. Demand conditions, supporting and related industries
and firm strategy and river were also insignificant but in the case of India firm strategy and rivalry
showed a positive impact. Only government policy was significant in most of the industries.
Therefore, both countries can devise their policy for the improvement of all these variables for the
attainment of sustainable national competitive advantage in trade
As both countries share the same culture, social, geographical conditions and very long
common border so they should cooperate and improve ties with each for attaining the benefits of
economic integration. In the case of individual variables in Pakistan,only government policy was
significant and ispositively affecting the national competitive advantage of Pakistan. In the case of
India firm rivalry and strategy and government policy were positively affecting the national
competitive advantage. The porter national diamondmodel was significant for both for Pakistan
and India for the agriculture industry, but in the case of individual variables only government
policy is significantly impacting the national competitive advantage of both countries. In the case
of edible fruits and nuts industry,the overall model is insignificant for both Pakistan and India,the
only factor condition shows a positive and significant relationship with the national competitive
advantage of India. In the sugar industry the model was significant in the case of India, but
insignificant in the case of Pakistan. Factor conditions show a significantnegative significant
relationship with national competitive advantage in India. In Inorganic chemical industry
Regression Analysis.The model is significant in the case of Pakistan but insignificant in the case of
India.The overall model is insignificant in case of Pakistani textile sector, but the model is
significant in the case of India. In Pakistan supporting and related industries are playing a negative
role, but government policy is playing a positive role.The results suggest that both Pakistan and
India are facing almost the same problems. In factor conditions the main problem is unskilled labor
with deficient technical skills, the improper utilization of land, lack of credit availability facilities,
not sufficient research and development, low purchasing power of general population, poor o
infrastructure facilities, government unnecessary intervention and high tariff and non-tariff barriers
177
are hindering the achievement of national competitive advantage. Pakistan is facing more problem
than India, in case of firm strategy and rivalry doing business in India is easier as compared to
Pakistan. The variable, government policy was also significant in the case of both Pakistan and
India.
The last objective was to identify challenges and opportunities for Pakistan in a trade with India
and suggest a response to trade creation.As Pak- India trade is lessthan 1 % of India's international
trade. There are many factors which are hindering trade relation between Pakistan and India
including informal trade, which results in the loss of tax revenues and the high process of products
due tothe increased transportation cost. The Second issue was Non-Tariff Barriers and other
measures, other than tariffs, which restrict trade and protect domestic industry. Pakistan has
allowed almost 1,900 Indian products and is regularly imported, but Pakistan exports are restricted
to very few items due to NTBs imposed by India. The Indian tariff rates also remained high for
Pakistani exports intensive goods, such as leather, mineral onyx,and textile. In 2009 the exports of
Pakistan to India were only 30% of total imports from India, in 2010 it fell to 24 % and to 20% in
2011. Pakistan had sought clarification on non-tariff barriers which its trading groups face in India.
These are related to Visas, requirement sampling or customs inspection, the requirement of
technical or standard certification (e.g.Cement, textiles, leather), labeling and marking rules
(e.g.Processed foods), packaging rules specification, multiple certifications (eg.Surgical
instruments) and investment-related issues. The third problem was land route restrictions, which
is restricting trade of many commodities by land, this problem is now reduced due to bilateral
dialogue. The fourth issue was VISA restrictions, which is rigid on both sides and need to be
liberalized to minimize the unnecessary harassment of genuine and potential trader. The fifth issue
was, restriction on FDI’s, to open new doors for investment, businesses from Pakistan and India,
which were previously fearful and reluctant in these kinds of investments want to invest. But,
there is a risk dueto the Hindu extremist policy adopted by the Indian government. Sixthly,
inefficient telecommunication channels, as currently, Pakistan and Indian do not allow travelers to
use their mobile phones in the other country. The purchase of localSIM is not easy as it required
a lotof documentation; as a result, travelers and businessmen have to use certain informal
mechanisms to attain local SIM cards via relatives and friends. The seventh issue was, thepayment
and dispute resolution system, whichneeds to be improved for better trading relations, it is
important to have forums that bring buyers and sellers together. Guaranteed payments are essential
178
for building new and lasting business partnerships, for which banking channels need to be
improved. An innovative dispute resolution system should also be put in place. The eighth issue
wasan information gap, which exists on both sides. This can be improved with collaborative
efforts from both sides. There are very few items, which have trade potential with Pakistan and
are in the positive list of Pakistan. Additionally, there are many products which India imports from
other parts of the world and not from Pakistan. Lastly, the most important and critical issueis
political tensions which are the major hurdle in trade normalization. The violent partition of British
India in 1947, the Kashmir issue and various military conflicts had been plagued their relationship
by suspicious and hostility.As the amount of ill legal tradeand trade through third countries
suggests a tremendous potential for bilateral trade between Pakistan and India. Restrictions on
official trade between these countries compel traders from sides to import certain products from
far off sources, which are costly and also insecure. As, increased in bilateral trade would ensure
low transportation cost, cheaper raw materials and insurance cost which will enhance the qualityof
goods and their availability at competitive prices for both countries. While consumers would gain
in terms of lower prices, higher purchase power and greater choice of trade goods, manufacturers
will have access to the wider markets in the neighborhood. The Government would have revenue
gains by bringing ill legal tradeinto the formal channel. Ultimately, this would result in a win-win
situation for everyone. Trade in Electricity between both the Countries will also help in reducing
problems associated with electricity load shedding.
6.2.Recommendations
In order to increase national competitive advantage following recommendations are suggested
by the work for both Pakistan and India:
• Trade integration is very critical for the economy as it will help countries to cooperate and
offer more products at reasonable cost and efficiency in the international market. The
government od both Pakistan and India are trying to liberalize their trade policy, but still,
results are not up to the expectation. Therefore, a serious revision of policies and their
implementation is required to achieve the benefits of trade liberalization.
• Both countries had unable to achieve a sustainable competitive advantage in the selected
industries. The reason is that they are unable to provide a competitive environment for the
179
business. This requires serious policy reforms for the development of factor conditions,
demand condition, supporting and related industries and firm strategy and rivalry.
• In order to improve Factor conditions, both countries should improvethe education system
and allocate more budget for education and health,increase number of training institutes
should be established, for the improvement in human resource skills. Health reforms should
be introduced for the improvement of the quality of the labor force. In order to improve per
hectare yield of the crops, the farmers should be given easy credit and facilitated with
superior quality seeds. The communication gap between research and development and the
farmers should be eliminated for better results. Additionally, the feudalism system should
be monitored and regulated and farmers should be given lands. Credit availability should
be eased for entrepreneurs. The major problem of the fruits and nuts industry was the
unavailability of storage facilities, the government should establish and provide proper
storageso that fresh fruits and nuts can be exported for the generation of foreign exchange.
A research and development environment should be maintained, research grants and
support should be given. Increase coordination between different research institutions and
educational institution should be increased.
• For the improvement in demand conditions, population growth should be monitored, the
Strict quality standard should be maintained and regularly monitored. For increasing
international demand for domestic products. Increase employment opportunities should be
created for increasing the purchasing power of the people, Consumer friendly policies
should be introduced. Working of consumer courts should be enhanced, for consumer
protection.
• For the improvement of supporting and related industries, Transportation system should be
upgraded.Technological advancement should be incorporated in every field of life for
better results.
• For the improvement of firm strategy and rivalry More dams should be constructed, solar
power should be used for electricity generation. Other sources of energy like wind, biogas,
coal should be used for generation of power for industries. A business-friendly
environment should be maintained within the country. More industrial zones should be
established, with the facilitation of energy availability and tax benefits. Government
180
procedure should be simplified. The Private sector should be involved and public-private
coordination should beestablished in different industries.
• In order to improve government policy, a rigorous policy should be designed for the
improvement of infrastructure and business environment of the country. The unnecessary
intervention of the government should be restricted. The Prices of sugar or wheat should not
be utilized asa political tool, unnecessary tariffs should be abolished against each other. More
RTAs should be signed for an increase in regional integration, Unnecessary non-tariff barriers
should be abolished, Research grants should be given priorities for increasing the
competitiveness of the country, Measures should be taken to decrease corruption,
accountability and check and balance should be maintained for government officials, efforts
should be made for maintaining normal law and order situation will attract new investment. It
will also decrease the brain drain from the country. Additionally, Healthy competition should
be maintained, in order to attract investment from abroad.
• Corporate sector should feel their corporate social responsibility and work for the development
of their suppliers and employees. And also, for the protection of the environment. Private
institute providing technical facilities should be established. The Private sector should be
involved and public-private coordination should be established in different industries.
6.3. Direction for Future Research
Future research should be conducted by applying other models likea double diamond model
and nine-factor model for better understanding of the factor affecting competitive advantage
in trade for Pakistan. Further research can also be done by adding more items to the
development of variables to Potter National Diamond model. More industries can be included
for a better understanding of the Pakistani economy. The current study has discussed on two
members of SAFTA (i.e. Pakistan and India)., future study can be done by including all the
member countries.
6.4.Limitation of the Study
There are some limitations of this work which cannot be overlooked, the major limitation
is that few industries were selected from both countries, although the sample was
representative, still, the results cannot be generalized to the whole economy,other industries
have their own resource requirements and management practices. The future studies can be
181
directed toward other industries. The second limitation was that the majority of the data was
unorganized and undocumented in both countries, due to which limited items were included in
the development of variables. The third limitation of the study was ill legal tradepatterns
between Pakistan and India and was not included. Lastly, another limitation was political
tensions between both countries, due to which trade was suspended at different time periods
during the study period.
REFERENCES
Aazim,M.(2016).Production and exports of fresh and dry fruits. Dawn Business &
Finance weekly. December 12th, 2016.
Abass.S., Waheed.A. (2015) Pakistan's Potential Export Flow: The Gravity Model
Approach. https://www.researchgate.net/publication/281522999.
Ablett.J.,Baijal.A.,Beinhocker.E.,Bose.A.,Farrell.D.,Gersch. U.,Greenberg.E.,Guptas.,
Gupta.S.(2007) the bird of gold. The rise of India’s consumer market.Mckinsey global
report.
Acharya.L., Marwaha. A.(2012). Status on India Pakistan-Bangladesh economic
relation, FCCI., Bangladesh Bank. The central bank of Bangladesh.
Adil.N.(2016). Analyzing the trade relationship between Pakistan and India. The express
tribune>business. Retrieved from: www.com.pk.
Ahmad, R.E. (2004). Pakistan-India Relations in the 21st Century. International Journal
of Pakistan Vision. 5(2).
Alemu. H. W (2010) Analysis of the Competitiveness of Ethiopian Textile subsector
under the Africa Growth and Opportunity Act (AGOA) using Porter Electronic copy
available athttp://ssrn.com/abstract=183310.
Ali.T.(2012). Untapped potential of dry fruit yield and export. Retrieved
from https://tahirkatlang.wordpress.com/
Adams.G.L., Lamont. B.T(2003). Knowledge management system and developing
182
sustainable competitive advantage. Journal of knowledge management.7(2).142-154.
Adeel-farooq, R. M., Bakar, N. A. A., & Raji, J. O. (2017). Trade openness , financial
liberalization and economic growth The case of Pakistan and India. South Asian Journal of
Business Studies, 6(3), 229–246.
Adrees.M.(2015). Augmenting chemical industry for economic stability.
Economy Watch.
Afridi A. H. (2016). Human Capital and Economic Growth of Pakistan. Business
& Economic Review.8 (1): pp. 77-86.
Afza. T, & Nazir M.S.(2007). Economic Competitiveness and Human Resource
Development: An FDI Perspective. Pakistan Economic and Social Review. 45(2).167-180
Agarwal. A (2013). Changing Profile of Indian Consumers. Project goru.
https://www.projectguru.in.
AghdaieS. F. A, Seidi.M., Riasi A. (2012). Identifying the Barriers to Iran’s Saffron
Export by Using Porter’s Diamond Model. International Journal of Marketing
Studies.4(5). 129-138.
Ahmad, S. (2012). Zardari’s Delhi yatra. The News. Retrieved from
http://www.news.com.pk.
Ahid, W. (17 July 2017). "Pak GDP in terms of purchasing power parity crosses $1
trillion". The New.
Ahuja.S., Allentuck. J., Chung. J., Corrigan .C., Hathaway. I., Martin .C., O’Neil.M.,
Reeves. B., Rojas. C.,Rushing.L., Swift.D.,Yeaw.J.(2006). Economic reforms in India task
force report. The Harrisschool. Retrieved from. www.harris.unhicago.edu.
Ahmed. Y.(2004). A report on Textile Industry OF Pakistan. Horizon private securities
limited.
Akhtar, N., Nadia Z., Ghani, E. (2008), Changing revealedcomparative advantage: A
casestudy of footwear industry of Pakistan, Pakistan Development Review, 47(4),1- 17.
Alam,.A. & Khan. M.. (2010). Pakistan textile industry facing new challenges. Research
Journal of International Studies. 14. 21-29.
Appleyard, Dennis; Field Jr., Alfred, & Cobb, Steven (2006). International Economics
(5th ed.).New York, NY: McGraw-Hill Companies
Anderson (1979) Anderson.J.E. (1979). A Theoretical Foundation for the Gravity
Equation. The American Review, 69(1), 106-116.
183
Arshad.A.(2016). Pakistan down in school infrastructure: District Education Ranking 2016
ByAlifAilaan and SDPI. The Educationist.Retrieved from http://educationist.com.pk.
Armington, P. (1969). A theory of demand for products distinguished by place of
origin, IMF Staff Paper 16, Washington D.C.: International Monetary Fund, 159– 78.
Askari, H. M. (2012, June). New opportunities in Pakistan-India trade?. The Daily Dawn.
Retrieved from http://www.dawn.com.
Astarlioglu, M (2012). Moderating Effect of Porter’s Diamond Framework Between Firm
Strategies and Export Performance: A Conceptual Model EUL. Journal of Social
Sciences. (III: II). 35-63.
Aschauer. D.A. (1989), Is public expenditure productive? Journal of Monetary
Economics 23 (1989) 177-200.
Anderson.J.E. (1979). A Theoretical Foundation for the Gravity Equation.
The American Review, 69(1), 106-116.
Arora, H. (2008). Einstein's theory of relativity: Implications beyond science? Retrieved
From: http://scienceinsociety.northwestern.edu.
Askari, H. M. (2012, June). New opportunities in Pakistan-India trade?. The Daily Dawn.
Retrieved from http://www.dawn.com
Auerbach, C. F., & Silverstein, L. B. (2003). Qualitative data: An introduction to coding
and analysis. NYU press.
Amjad, R. (2010) Key Challenges Facing Pakistan Agriculture: How Best Can Policy
Makers Respond? A Note, [Online], Available: www.pide.org.pk. 8th March 2010.
Balassa, B. (1965), “Trade Liberalization and ‘Revealed’ Comparative Advantage”, The
Manchester School, 33, 99-123.
Baroncelli, E. (2007). The ‘Peace dividend’, SAFTA, and Pakistan-India trade. The
Challenges and Potential of Pakistan-India Trade, 59.
Balcarova. P. (2013). the comparison of nine-factor model and Diamond Model
:application for the Czech Republic, Slovakia and HungryMendel University in Brno,
Faculty of business and Economics, Zemedelská.
Batra and Khan (2005), Revealed comparative advantage: an analysis for India and
China, working paper (168), Indian Council for Research on International Economic
Relations.
Baloch.,Q. B., Pakistan’s Trade Imbalance & Melting Down of Economy. The Dialogue.
3(2): 148-167.
Bakan. I., Dogan İnci Fatma (2012). Competitiveness Of The Industries Based On The
184
Porter's Diamond Model: An Empirical Study. IJRRAS 11 (3).
Bakshi G, Trivedi S (2011). The Indus Equation. Strategic Forsight Group.C-306, .Strategic
Forsight Group.C-306.
Barragan.S. (2005). Assessing the Power of Porter’s Diamond Model in The Automobile
Industry In Mexico After Ten Years of NAFTA.University of Lethbridge,
Lethbridge,Canada
Baroncelli, E. (2007). The ‘Peace dividend’, SAFTA, and Pakistan-India trade. The
Challenges and Potential of Pakistan-India Trade, 59.
Bashiri. M.S, Baziyar M., Balakshahi,andMojib. (2013). Analysis OfVarious Aspects
Of Olive Exports Based On Porter's Diamond Model. Singaporean Journal Of
Business, Economics and Management Studies. 1(6).103-113.
Baldwin, J.R., Dixon, J. (2008), Infrastructure Capital: What is it? Where is it? How
much of it is there? Canadian Productivity Review. No 16.Ottawa: Statistics Canada.
BCG ( 2017).Indian Road Network". National Highways Authority of India. Retrieved 31
March 2009.
Beckwith. C. I (2011). Empires of the Silk Road: A History of Central Eurasia from the
Bronze Age to the Present. Princeton: University Press. ISBN 978-0-691-15034-5
Bergstrand. (1990). The Heckscher-Ohlin-Samuelson Model, The Linder Hypothesis and
the determinants of Bilateral Intra-Industry Trade. The Economic Journal. 100 (403). 1216-
1229.
Bhatti T.H&TagaA.A (2014). South Asian Free Trade Agreement (SAFTA): Its
Prospects and Socio-Cultural Impacts on Pakistan.Academic Research International. 5(2).
Bhutto, Z.A. (1972). Reshaping foreign policy 1948–1966 – a collection of articles,
statements, and speeches. Rawalpindi: Pakistan Publications.
Bhargava.Y (2014). India has the second fastest growing service sector. The Hindu.
retrievedfrom .www.the hindu.com.
Blake.E.,& Knapp .A.B.(2005) The Archaeology Of Mediterranean Prehistory, John
Wiley & Sons.
Bellak.C.J&Weiss A. (1993)., Extensions of the Porter Diamond Framework.A Note on
the Austrian "Diamond"MIR: Management International Review Vol. 33 (1993), pp. 109-
118
Bertman.S.(2005) Handbook to Life In Ancient Mesopotamia. Oxford University
185
Press.
Boltho, A. (1996). The assessment: international competitiveness, Oxford Review of
Economic Policy, 12(3), 1–16.
Bysani.B. (2010). Industry analysis report Inorganic Chemicals Industry. APGCMS,
RAJAMPET.retreivedfrom.www.scribd.com/industry-analysis-report-
InorganicChemicals-Industry.
Burinskiene, M., Rudzkiene, V. (2009), Pltroskrypvertinimoirvaldymo
informaticianmodeliai. Vilnius: Technika.
Business Standards. (2015). India 4TH largest start-up hub in world: Eco survey.
Butt. P. A. (2015). Restructuring of research & development in Pakistan. Retrieved from
www.sciencevision.org.pk.
Cartwright, W. R. (1993). Multiple linked diamonds: New Zealand's experience. Management
International Review, 33 (2): 55-70.
Central Water Commission. (2010). India land and water resources at glance.
Government ofIndia. Rederivedfrom"State-Wise Details of Net Irrigated Area (NIA), Net
Sown Area (NSA) And Percentage of NIA To NSA" (PDF). Ministry of Water Resources,
Government of India. "Fishery - Global Comparison". Retrieved 9 October 2015.
Choudhury, G.W. (1975). Pakistan's Relations with India (1947-1966).London: Pall Mall
Press Ltd.
Chand S. (2016). 8 Important Policy Measures Introduced in the Agricultural Sector
in India. YourArticleLibrary.com.
Cho. D.S., Moon. H.C. (20OO).From Adam Smith to Michael Porter Evolution of
Competitiveness Theory. (7). Asia-Pacific Business Series Extended Edition.
CIA (2017). The World Factbook. retrieved from www.CIA.gov. retrieved on 17 October
2016.
Collon.D.(1990). Near Eastern Seals. University of California Press.
Cohen, Stephen S. (1994) ‘Speaking Freely’, Foreign Affairs, Vol. 73, No. 4 (Jul. - Aug. 1994),
pp. 194-197.
Datt. R.&Sundharam, K.P.M. (2009). Indian Economy. New Delhi.
Davies, H. & Ellis P.(2000).Porter’s competitive advantage of nations: time for the final
judgment? Journal of Management Studies. 37(8),1189–1213.
186
Department of international trade (2015). Reterived from:
www.gov.uk/...pakistan/doing-business-in-pakistan-pakistan-trade-and-export.
Dey. S (2017).A Study on Changing Buying Behaviour of Indian Customers. Global
Journal of Marketing Management and Research. 7(1), PP 2250-3242.
http://www.ripublication.com.
D'Silva, Jeetha (2007). India growth story is attracting talent from govt.
establishments. Retrieved 11 January 2017.
Debrah Y. A. & Ofori. G.(2006) Human resource development of professionals in an
emerging economy: the case of the Tanzanian construction industry.The International
Journal of Human Resource Management.17(3), 440-
463, DOI: 10.1080/09585190500521425
Deardorff, Alan V. (1998): “Determinants of Bilateral Trade: Does Gravity Work in
a Neoclassical World?,” in J.A. Frankel (ed.): The Regionalization of the World
Economy, 7-22, University of Chicago Press, Chicago
Dahal D. R.., Pandey.N. N. (2005). SubediRitu Raj (Ed). New Life Within
SAARC. Institute of Foreign Affairs(IFA) & Friedrich-Ebert-Stiftung (FES).
DikovV.( 2015). Bulgarian Archaeologists To Start Excavations of Ancient Greek
Emporium in Thracians' Odrysian Kingdom. Archaeology in Bulgaria.
Department of International trade (2015) . Doing business in Pakistan: Pakistan trade and
export guide. Guidance.https://www.gov.uk/
Dixit, N.J. (2001, July, 11). No Euphoria Please. The Hindustan Times. Retrieved from
http://thehindustantimes.com.
Darvill.T.(2008). The Concise Oxford Dictionary of Archaeology, Oxford University
Press.
Dunning, J.H. (1992).The Competitive Advantage of Countries and the Activities of
Transnational Corporations.Transnational Corporations.l(1): 135- 168.
Eaton, Jonathan and Kortum, Samuel (2002): “Technology, Geography, and Trade,”
Econometrica, 70(5), 1741-1779.
Ellahi.N., Mehmood.H.Z., Ahmad.M. (2011). Analyzing empirical relationship between
trade openness, industrial value-added and economic growth: A Case Study Of Pakistan.
Interdisciplinary Journal of Contemporary Research In Business.
Etheredge.L.S.(2011). Syria, Lebanon, and Jordan, The Rosen Publishing Group,
ISBN 1615303294, retrieved 2012-06-15.
187
Ezdi, A. (2012, April, 16). Beating the peace drums. The News. Retrieved from
http://www.news.com.pk.
ESOPB.(2015). Reterived from https://web.archive.org/web/20060904133739/
http://www.gsmworld.com/news/press_2006/press06_14.stml.
EY. (2016). Doing business in India. Ernst & Young LLP. India.
Ekelund, R. B., and Robert F. H. (1996). A History of Economic Theory and Method.
New York, NY: McGraw-Hill. ISBN 0070213275.
Engelken.S.(2013). India –Pakistan: Is Trade key to everything? Centre for Strategic&
international studies. 3(1).
FAO. (2015). Food and Agriculture Organization of the United.
Fairclough, N. (1992). Discourse and text: Linguistic and intertextual analysis within
discourse analysis. Discourse & Society, 3(2), 193-217.
Fairclough, N. (1993). Critical discourse analysis and the marketization of public
discourse: The universities. Discourse & Society, 4(2), 133-168.
Fairclough, N. (2003). Analyzing discourse: Textual analysis for social research.
Fairclough, N. (2004). Critical discourse analysis in researching language in the new
` capitalism: Overdetermination, transdisciplinarity,and textual analysis. Systemic
functional linguistics and critical discourse analysis, 103-122.
Frank .R., Bernanke.B.(2004). Principles of economics. The McGraw-hill companies.
Gawad.G.M.M., Alkhteeb.T.T.,Intezar.M.T.(2014) Determinets of competitive
advantages of dates exporting: An applied study on Saudi Arabia. International
Journal of economics and finance.6(4). 79-87.
Goharian, M. E. (1999). Managing non-oil exports (2nd ed.). Tehran: Business study and
research organization.
George.K.V.(2015). India moves up in ‘ease of doing business’ ranking. The Hindu.
Reterived from:https://www.thehindu.com › News › National.
Goharian, M. E. (2000). Modern Exports Management. Tehran: AsrareDanesh.
Ghosh and Yamarik (2004) Ghosh S, Yamarik S. 2004. Are preferential trade agreements
trade creating? An application of extreme.
Grant. R.. (1991). Porter's 'Competitive advantage oF nations': An assessment
188
Strategic Management Journal, 12, 535-548.
Gray, C. S. (1981). National style in strategy: The American example. International
Security. 6(2), 21- 47.
Gopal.A., Srinivasan.R.(2006). The new Indian consumer. Harward business review.
Gul, N. & Yasin,H.( 2011). The Trade Potential of Pakistan: An Application of the
Gravity Model. The Lahore Journal of Economics, 23-62.
Gu, W., & Macdonald, R. (2009), The Impact of Public Infrastructure on Canadian
Multifactor Productivity Estimates. The Canadian Productivity Review. Research Paper
(21).
Gurcharan.D.(2006) The India Model.the foreign affairs. Retrieved from:
https://www.foreignaffairs.com/articles/asia/2006-07-01/india-model.
Hammouda, H. Ben, &Jallab, M. S. (2011). Trade Liberalization and Development: Lessons for
Africa. Journal of World, Investment and Trade.
Haghighat Talab, M. (2007). Marketing techniques. Tehran: AlmaseDanesh.
Helpman, E., and Krugman, P. R. (1985). “Market Structure and Foreign Trade,” MIT
Press, Cambridge, MA.
Hnát, P. (2008). Globalization, multilateralism, regionalism: From dilemma to multi-
dimensionality. Acta OeconomicaPragensia, 2008(2), 6-22.
Henneberry, S. (2000). "An analysis of industrial–agricultural interactions: A case study
In Pakistan. Agricultural Economics. 22: 17–27. doi:10.1016/S0169-
5150(99)00041-9s. Retrieved 27 July 2017.
Head, Keith (2003). Gravity for Beginners, Mimeography, University of British
Columbia.
Heckscher&Eli (1949). The effect of foreign trade on the distribution of income.In
1919. Readings in the Theory of International Trade.Philadelphia, Pa. [u.a.] :Blakiston.
272-300.
Heckscher, Eli F., and Ohlin, B. (1991).Heckscher-Ohlin trade theory, MIT
Press, Cambridge.
Heplman, Elhanan (1987): “Imperfect Competition and International Trade: Evidence
from Fourteen Industrial Countries,” Journal of the Japanese and International
Economies. 1(1), 62-81.
189
Herath H.M.S.P., Liang .C. &Yongbing. C.(2013).Trade Liberalization in Sri Lanka:
Effects on Exports and Imports. Sri Lankan Journal of Banking and Finance (SLJBF).
1(1).37-45.
Howard. S. Ellis & Lloyd A. Metzler, editors, Readings in the theory of international
Trade. Homewood: Irwin.
Hill. Charles.W. L (2005). International business competing in the global marketplace.
McGraw hill Irvin. 5th Ed.
HSBC.(2012).Doing business in India. retrieved from www.pwc.com/india.
Hume, D. (1752). Of the Balance of Trade, Political Discourses, Edinburgh, as
reprinted in Hume (1955)
.
Husain, I.: Pakistan’s export competitiveness in global markets. In: Key Issues in
Pakistani Economy. State Bank of Pakistan, Karachi (2003).
Husain, J. (2012, April, 17). Imperative of peace. The Nation. Retrieved from
http://www.nation.com.pk
Huntington, S. P. (1993). The clash of civilizations? Foreign Affairs, 22-49.
Hussain.S.S., Ahmed. V., (2011). Experiments with industrial policy: The Case Of
Pakistan Working Paper No: 124. The Sustainable Development Policy Institute.
Hussain (2017). Tariff trade and taxation. Dawn. July .2017.
Hyder, O.T. (2013, March, 20). Strategic restraint in South Asia. The Nation. Retrieved
From: http://www.nation.com.pk IT looked good, it sounded good. (2011, July 28). Dawn,
p.5.
Hymer, Stephen H. 1976 (1960). The international operations of national firms: A study
& of direct foreign investment. Cambridge: MIT Press.
ICMAP.(2015).Industry challenges & opportunities Pakistan – an engine of emerging
economyhttps://www.icmap.com.pk/downloads.
IBEF (2008). Inorganic chemicals market & opportunities. Retrieved from
https://www.ibef.org/download/Inorganic_Chemicals_170708.
IBEF.(2017). Research and Development in India. Retrieved From
https://www.ibef.org
Ilyas.M.,Mukhtar.T., Javed.M.T.(2009). Competitiveness among Asian exporters in the
world rice market.48.
190
International Economic Conference of Sibiu (2013). Post Crisis Economy: Challenges
and Opportunities, IECS. Measuring International Competitiveness of Romania by Using
Porter's Diamond and Revealed Comparative Advantage.
Indian food report.(2016). Retrieved from: www.indiaretailing.com › Latest News.
Jabeen.S., Omer. S.,Hanan.M.H. (2014) Indo-Pakistan trade relation: A critical
Discourse..retrievedfrom www.academia.edu/6947131/Indo-Pakistan.
Jammes, O. and Olarreaga, M. (2005), Explaining SMART and GSIM, Washington
D.C. http://wits.worldbank.org/witsweb/download/docs/explaining_smart_and_
gsim.pdf. on 24 November 2015.
JCR-VIS (2013). Sugar Industry Upward pressure ahead with increasing input prices and
weakening local currency... JCR-VIS Sector Update. Retrieved from.
www.jcrvis.com.pk/docs/Sugar201310.pdf.
Jin.B. (2004) Apparel industry in east Asia newly industrialized countries:Competitive
advantage, challenges,and implications. Journal of fashion, marketing and
management: an international journal. 8(2),230-244.
Johnston, A. I. (1995). Thinking about strategic culture. International security, 19(4), 32-
64.
Johnston, A. I. (1998). Cultural Realism: Strategic culture and grand strategy in Chinese
history. Princeton University Press. South Asian Studies 29 (1) 320.
Jochelle. M. (2017). 50%of India’s internet users will be rural & 40% will be women by
2020:BCG.ETRISE. Retrieved from: www.tecom.economicstimes.india times.com.
Kapoor.(2017). GDP growth to slow to 7.1% in FY 17.Livement. Retrievedon 3
February 2017.
Keynes, J.M. (1936) ‘Notes on mercantilism’ in The General Theory of Employment,
Interest and Money. Available here. [Readable introduction to the link between
mercantilism and Keynesianism]
Khan, R.S. (2008). Bilateral pathways to regional integration: The case of Pakistan and
India. In SDC Anthology (Ed.), Peace and sustainable development in South Asia:Issues
and challenges of globalization. Sustainable Development Policy Institute
Islamabad. Pakistan.
Khattak, M. T. (2012, May, 21). Indo-Pak trade in perspective. The News. Retrieved
From http://www.news.com.pk.
Kathuria. L.M.,(2008). An Analysis of Competitiveness of Indian Clothing Export Sector
191
Using Porter’s Model. Journal of International Business, III(4).
Kathuria, L.M. and Singh, R. (2005), “A study of export marketing and other business
practices of selected garment exporters”, Foreign Trade Review, 40 (2), 69-88.
Khalid. S. (2012). Bilateral Trade Between Pakistan and India. Retrieved from
www.rcci.org.pk/wp-content/uploads/2012/12/pibt
Khushk.A.M., Memon.A., Saeed.I. (2011). Analysis of sugar industry competitiveness in
Pakistan. J. Agric. Res., 2011, 49(1),pp 137-151.
Keynes, J.M. (1936) ‘Notes on mercantilism’ in The General Theory of Employment,
Interest and Money. Available here. [Readable introduction to the link between
mercantilism and Keynesianism].
Khan, R. (2008). Bilateral pathways to regional integration: The case of Pakistan and India. SDC
anthology.
Khan, S. H. (2010). Why E-Commerce Remains Unsuccessful in Pakistan ? 1–12.
Khan.M.(2013) India-Pakistan Trade relations:A new beginning. New American
foundation.Retrieved from: indiapakistantrade.org/resources/khan_India-Pakistan.
Kharub, M., & Sharma, R. (2017). Comparative analyses of competitive advantage using
Porter diamond model (the case of MSMEs in Himachal Pradesh). Competitiveness
Review. (27). https://doi.org/10.1108/CR-02-2016-0007.
Kowalski, P., J. Lopez-Gonzalez, A. Ragoussis and C. Ugarte, (2015). Participation of
developing countries in global value chains: Implications for trade and trade-related
Policies, OECD Trade Policy Papers, No. 179, OECD Publishing, Paris.
Kreinin, M.E. 1965. Comparative Labor Effectiveness and the Leontief Scarce-Factor
Paradox. The American Economic Review. 55(1/2):131-140.
Krugman, P.R. (1979). Increasing returns, monopolistic competition and international
trade. Journal of International Economics, 9: 469-479.
Krugman.P (1994). competitiveness a dangerous obsession. Foreign Affairs. 73(2), 28-44.
Kulikov, G. (2000), Japonskijmenedzhmentiteorijamezhdunarodnoj
konkurentosposobnosti. Moscow: Ekonomika.
Lavoy, P. R. (2006). Pakistan’s strategic culture. Comparative strategic cultures
curriculum project, 31
Leontief, W.W. (1951) Input-Output Economics. Scientific American, Reprinted in W.W.
192
Leontief (1966) Input-output economics. New York, OxfordUniversity
López-Rodríguez, Jose & M. García Rodríguez, Rafael. (2005). Technology and export
behaviour: A resource-based view approach. International Business Review, 14(5), 539–
557. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.ibusrev.2005.07.002.
Leontief, Wassily (1953).Domestic Production and Foreign Trade; The American Capital
Position Re-examined. Proceedings of the American Philosophical Society.332- 349.
Laffenmas(1598). Responce à messieurs de Lyon, lesquels veulent empescher, rompre
le cours des marchandises d'Italie, avec le préjudice de leurs foires, et l'abus aux
changes.
Licandro, O. (2010). Trade Liberalization , Competition and Growth, (February).
Lindner, Staffan B. (1961): “An essay on trade and transformation,” John Wiley
and Sons, New York.
Lodhi, M. (2012, May, 22). Free but fair trade. The News. Retrieved from
http://www.news.com.pk
Lowder. G.G. (1970). Studies in volcanic petrology: I. Talasea, New Guinea. II.
The Southwest Utah University of California.
Lyon, P. (2008). The conflict between India and Pakistan.An Encyclopedia. ABC-CLIO.
Lohokare.S.R.,(2011). Presentation on Overview of the chemicals industry in India. Uk
trade &investment and Indian chemical industry. Indian chemical council.
Manan. H.(2013). Budget 2013:Research& development in Pakistan. The express
tribune. Retrieved from http//blogs.tribune.com.pk.
Mahajan., A. (2017). The Indian Sugar Industry - Sector Roadmap. KPMG Advisory
Services Pvt.Ltd.
Mahmood.A., Ahmed.W. (2017). Export Performance of Pakistan: Role of Structural
Factors. SBP Staff Notes.
Magnusson, L. (2002). Mercantilism: the shaping of an economic language. Routledge.
[The introduction is a very good primer for someone new to this subject].
Mahmood. Amir.(2004), Export Competitiveness and Comparative Advantage of
Pakistan’s Non- agricultural Production Sectors: Trends and Analysis, PDR,
43(4) Part II, 541-556.
Mahmood, Z. (1987). Pakistan: Trade relations. CharanWadhvaet. el. Regional Economic
193
Cooperation in Asia: Bangladesh, India, Pakistan and Sri Lanka.
Mansoor. (2011, April, 25). India’s policy of status quo towards Pakistan. The Frontier
Post. Retrieved from http://www.thefrontierpost.com.
Masood.T.(2014). Challenges facing India-Pakistan relation.The express
tribune>opinion. Published in the express tribune, January 29th, 2014.
Massa.S.,Testa.S.(2009)A knowledge management approach to organization competitive
advantage: Evidence from the food sector. European Management Journal. 27(2)129-141.
Mamatzakis E.C. (2008). Economic performance and public infrastructure: An
application to Greek manufacturing.Bulletin of Economic Research. 60(3), 0307-
3378.
Mattoon, R. H. (2004). Infrastructure and State Economic Development: A survey of the
issues (I-G). Economic Conferences
Mboya. J, Kazungu, K.(2015). Determinants of Competitive Advantage in the Textile and
Apparel Industry in Tanzania: The Application of Porter’s Diamond Model. British.
Journal of Economics, Management & Trade 7(2), 128-147.
McGrail, Sean (2001). Boats of the World: From the Stone Age to Medieval Times.
Oxford: Oxford University Press.
McKinsey and Company.(2007 )The Bird of Gold – The Rise of India's Consumer
Market.
Memon N, Rehman. F, & Rabbi. F (2014). Should Pakistan Liberalize Trade With India
Against the Backdrop of the FTA with China? A Comparative Advantage Analysis or the
Manufacturing Sector. The Lahore Journal of Economics 19, 327–348.
Memon. A.Q. (2015). Pakistan gets less duty-free access to US than EU, China. The
Express Tribune. Retrieved From https://tribune.com.pk › Business
Mitra,S., &Pahariya, N.C. (2008). Managing conflict through trade: The case of
Pakistan and India of peace and trade dividends: The case of Pakistan and India. In SDC
(Ed.), Peace and sustainable development in South Asia: Issues and
challenges of Globalization. Sustainable Development Policy Institute Islamabad.
Pakistan.
Ministry Of Water Resources(2016). "State-wise details of net irrigated area (NIA), net
sown area (NSA) and percentage of nia to nsa" .)., Government Of India. Archived
from."Fishery - Global Comparison". Retrieved 9 October 2015.
194
Ministry of road transport&highways. (2016). Basic road statistic and 2014-15 of India
2013-14.
Mir.Z.A., Kottaiveeran.K.(2016). Problems of exports of dry fruits in Jammu and
Kashmir.AsiaPacificJournal of Research.1(XLIV). 62-69.
Moktan, Suresh. (2009). The Impact of Trade Agreements on Exports: Empirical
Evidence from SAARC Countries. Journal of International Economic Studies.23, 23–42.
Mukherjee, A. (2009). A brand-new day or back to the future? The dynamics of India-
Pakistan relations. India Review, 8(4), 404-445.
Mukhtar.M. T &Javed.M.T.(2009). Competitiveness among Asian Exporters in
the World Rice Market. The Pakistan Development Review
48 (4). 783–794
Mun, Thomas. (1664). England’s Treasure by Forraign Trade, or The Ballance of our
Forraign Trade is The Rule of our Treasure.
Nater. N, Cini. V ( 2009 ) Porter’s Diamond Model of Osijek-Baranja County
Industry. InterdisciplinaryManagement Research l(5). 761-769.
National Tariff Commission.92015). reterived from:
www.na.gov.pk/uploads/documents/1439447385_678.pdf.
Nazir, M. (2005). The political and strategic dimensions in Indo-Pak relations (1998-
2004). Pakistan vision.
New farmer, R. and M. Sztajerowska (2012),Trade and employment in a fast-changing
Worldin OECD (2012), Policy Priorities for International Trade and Jobs, OECD
Publishing, Paris.
Netscribes. (2013). Market Research Reports: Dry Fruit Market India 2013.
retrieved from: issuu.com/netscribesinc/docs/dry_fruit_market..
Nicholas.B.(1690). Nicholas Barbon on the mutual benefits of free trade even in luxury
goods (“wants of the mind”). A discourse of trade. Online Library of Liberty.
Noorani, T. (2012, April, 10). Reciprocity: the watchword for trade. Dawn. Retrieved
from http://www.dawn.com.pk
OECD (2017), “Making trade work for all”, OECD Trade Policy Papers, No. 202, OECD
Publishing, Paris. http://dx.doi.org/10.1787/6e27effd-en
OECD (2012), Policy priorities for international trade and jobs, OECD Publishing, Paris.
http://dx.doi.org/10.1787/9789264180178-en.
195
Organization, W. T. (2014). Regional Trade Agreements. www.wto.org.region_e.
Oh.J.,Rhee.S.(2010).Influences of supplier capabilities and collaboration in new car
development ofthe competitive advantage of carmakers. Emerald Insight.
Ohlin.B. (1933) Report Of The United Nations Conference On Trade And
Development.(2004.) Eleventh session São Paulo, 13–18 June 2004 Held in São
Paulo, Brazil, from 13 to 18 June 2004.
Ortmann, G.F. 2001. Industrialisation of agriculture and the role of supply chains in promoting
competitiveness. Agrekon, 40(4):459-489.
Oz, Ozlem (1999).The Competitive Advantage of Nations, the Case of Turkey: Assessing
Porter's Framework for National Advantage, Ashgate Publishing.
Pakistan continues to improve business environment (2016): World Bank report.
The Nation. Retrieved on October 26, 2016.
Pakistan country report (2010). Retrievedfrom: www.bti-project.org/en/reports/country-
reports/detail/itc/pak/
Pakistan Defense Forum. (2015). Top 10 Pakistan Exports and Imports to and from other
countries. Retrieved from https://defence.pk › Pakistan Defense Forum › Pakistan
Affairs › Pakistan Economy.
Pakistan Economic Survey. (2013). Retrieved From: www.finance.gov.pk/survey
Pakistan Economic Survey. (2007). Retrieved From: www.finance.gov.pk/survey
Pakistan statistical bureau (2016). Agriculture Statistics. extracted from:
www.pbs.gov.pk/content/agriculture-statistics.
Parappurathu, S. &. (2008). Comparative Advantage of India in Agricultural.Agriculture
Economic Research Review, 21.
Paracha (2012). Comparative analysis of Pakistan India chemical industries. Retrieved
from Pitad.org.pk/publication/32-pakistan trade.
Pasha H. A. & Saleem. W (2013). The Impact and Cost of Power Load Shedding
to Domestic Consumers. The Pakistan Development Review. 52:4 Part I (Winter), 355–373
Petty.W&Graunt.J (1899). Hull, Charles H., ed. The Economic Writings of Sir William
Petty. Cambridge: University Press. 1.
Poddar. T. (2004). Domestic Competition Spurs Exports: The Indian Example. Working
Paper Middle East and Central Asia Department.
196
Prestowitz C.V, (1994). Playing to Win. Foreign Affairs. RetrievedFrom :
https://www.foreignaffairs.com/articles/1994-07-01
Planning Commission of India (2007). Labour Laws and Other LabourRegulations.
The Government of India.
Phillipson, N. (2010). Adam Smith: An Enlightened Life. Penguin. [Excellent
examination of Smith’s life and times]
Planning Commission Government of India. (2016)."Natural Resources - 3rd Five year
Plan.The Government of India. retrieved 12 September 2016.
Porter. Michael E. (1990) The Competitive Advantage of Nations. New York: Free
Press, Macmillan.
Raja.S.H (2015). Pakistan’s Exports Sector/Challenges and Response.
www.shahidhussainraja.com.
Ranjan, A. (2012, May, 29). Missing things in India and Pakistan dialogue. Daily Times.
Retrieved from http://www.dailytimes.com.pk
Rattanavijit.S.,Somboonwiwat.T.,Khompatraporn.c.(2015). Analysis of casual
competitive factors of Thai iron and steel supply chain by Dematel METHOD.
Industrialengineering, managementscience,and application.541-550.
Ravenstein, E. G. (1889): “The Laws of Migration - Second Paper,” Journal of the Royal
Statistical Society, 52(2), 241–305.
Robertm. M. G. (1991). Porter's 'Competitive advantage of nations': An Assessment.
Strategic Management Journal, 12, 535-548.
Rempel, Gerhard. (1998). Mercantilism. Western New England College.Retrieved
November 6, 2015.
Ricardo, D. (1817), On the Principles of Political Economy and Taxation.
Robb.J.(2007). The Early Mediterranean Village: Agency, Material Culture, and Social
Change in Neolithic Italy.Cambridge University Press.
Rodrigues, G. & Khan, Z. Reza.(2015) Competitiveness of clothingindustry based on
Porter's diamond model: SAFTA countries. Proceedings of Academics World
International Conference. International Institute of Engineers and Researchers,
The United States, 18-23.
Routledge. Frank .R., Bernanke.B.(2004). Principles of economics. The Mcgraw-hill
companies.
197
Rehman,.S.U.(2015). Pakistan Sugar Annual Report 2015. Global Agriculture
Information Network. USDA Foreign Agriculture Service.
Rehmat, A. (2011). Analysis. Dawn. Retrieved from http://www.dawn.com.pk.
Richardson, David. J and Chi Zhang (1999) “Revealing Comparative Advantage: Chaotic
Or Coherent Patterns Across Time and Sector and U.S Trading Partner?” National
Bureau of Economic Research, Working Paper 7212.
Rizivi. S.J.A., (n.d).Sugar industry in Pakistan-problems, potentials. FCMA synopsis.
Retrieved from
https://www.icmap.com.pk/downloads/Past-Publications/sipp_%20potentials.pdf.
Rodrigues.G., Khan.Z.R.,(2015). Competitiveness of the clothing industry based on
Porter's diamond model: SAFTA countries.Proceedings of Academics World
International Conference, International Institute of Engineers and Researchers, United
States, pp.
Rugman, A.M. and A. Verbeke (1990). Global Corporate Strategy and Trade Policy.
London/New York: Croom Helm/ Routledge. Ryan, Richard. 1990. A Grand Disunity.
National Review, July 9,42( 13): 46-47.
Sabandi, M. (2015). The Effects of Trade Liberalization, Financial Development and Economic
Crisis on Economic Growth in Indonesia, 6(24), 120–128.
Saleem.N., Omer. S., Forman. M.A.H. (2014). Indo-Pakistan Trade Relations: A Critical
Discourse Analysis of Daily Dawn. A Research Journal of South Asian Studies. 29 (1),
pp.309-320.
Saleemi.I.(2010).Economy of Pakistan In 2010, Economic Growth, Issues And Solution.
Enfopedia.www.einfopedia.com.
Saeed K.. (2013). Overview of the sugar industry in Pakistan.research and
development department. Lahore chamber of commerce and industry.
Santos-Paulino, A. U. (2005). Trade liberalisation and economic performance: Theory and
evidence for developing countries. World Economy, 28(6), 783–821.
https://doi.org/10.1111/j.1467-9701.2005.00707.x
Schott, Jeffrey J. (1996), ‘Challenges Facing the World Trade Organization’, in Jeffrey J.
Schott (Ed.), The World Trading System: Challenges Ahead, Washington, DC:
Institute for International Economics.
Sean M., (2001). Boats of the World: From the Stone Age to Medieval Times. Oxford:
Oxford University Press.
198
Shabir, S., & Kazmi, R. (2007), Economic Effects of the Recently Signed Pak-China Free
Trade Agreement. Lahore Journal of Economics, 12(Special Edition) 174-202.
Shahzad.,K.(2015). An RCA Analysis of Textiles and Clothing in Pakistan, India, and
Bangladesh.The Lahore Journal of Economics 20 (1)157–168.
Shujaat A, Abdul W. (2015).Trade Competitiveness of Pakistan: The
Revealed Comparative Advantage Approach.Competitiveness Review: An
International Business Journal ,https://doi.org/10.1108/CR-12-2015-0092.
Siddique, H.S. (2013). Trade and payments. Pakistan Economic Survey 2012-13.
Ministry of Finance. The government of Pakistan.
Smith.A. (1776), An Inquiry into the Nature and Causes of the Wealth of Nation.
State Bank of Pakistan. (2016, October 15). Economic Data. Retrieved October 2016, From
State Bank Of Pakistan: www.sbp.org.pk.
Smith.R.L.(2009). Premodern Trade in World History. Taylor & Francis.
Shareof the different sector in the Indian economy. (2005). Natural Resources - 3rd Five
Yearplan". Planning commission government ofIndiaretrieved 12 September 2016.
Smith, A. (1776) ‘Of Restraints upon the Importation from foreign Countries of such
Goods as can be produced at Home’ An Inquiry Into the Nature and Causes of the Wealth
of Nations, [Book IV, part ii, chapter II ].
Spencer Barbara J. , Brander .James A. (1983) .International R&D Rivalry and Industrial
Strategy. Review of Economic Studies.50(163),707-722.
SBP.(2017).Economic Data. RetrievedOctober 2016.from: www.sbp.org.pk.
Stewart. (1770). An Inquiry Into the Principles of Political Economy. Retrieved From
www.efm.bris.ac.uk/het/steuart/prin.
Sun P., Heshmati. (2010). International Trade and its Effects on Economic Growth in
China IZA Discussion Paper No. 5151.
Tabish, M.Iqbal.,& Khan, A.M. (2011). Pakistan economic cooperation harnessing India
Pakistan Trade potential. SAARC Chamber of Commerce and Industry.
Taneja N, Mehra M, Mukherjee P, Bimal Si and Dayal I. (2014). Normalizing India-
Pakistan Trade Summary of Research Studies. Indian Council for Research on
International Economic Relation.
Tahir. A. (2013). Textile Industry of Pakistan. Retrieved from 16 September
2016.
199
Telecom Regulatory Authority of India (2007). A journey towards excellence in
Telecommunications A journey towards excellence in Telecommunication.
Tinbergen, J.(1962): “Shaping the World Economy: Suggestions for an International
Economic Policy,” The Twentieth Century Fund, New York.
The statistical portal. (2017). Median age of the population in selected countries in 2017
(in years). Retrieved from www.statista.com.
Thapar. R. (2011). Ineffective in Promoting Economic Cooperation in South Asia.
Sandford Journal of International Relation.
Thirlwall (2000). Trade liberalization and economic growth: Theory and practice. The
African Development Bank Economic Research Paper no. 63.
Thore.W (1995). Obsidian in the Mediterranean and the Near East: A Provenancing
Success Story. Archaeometry. 37 (2): 217–48.
Thurow, L. C. (1994). Microchips, Not Potato Chips. Foreign Affairs. 189-192.
Trienekens. J.H. (2011). Agricultural Value Chains in Developing Countries A Framework for
Analysis. International Food and Agribusiness Management Review.14 (2), 51-82.
Tuerck, David G., Jonathan Haughton, Frank Conte, and Christopher Doyon. (2007b).
State Competitiveness Report 2007.” Boston: Beacon Hill Institute, December.
Available at: http://www.beaconhill.org/CompetitivenessHomePage.html.
UNCAD. (2015). The role of international trade in the post-2015 development agenda
Trade and Development Board. Trade and Development Commission Sixth session
Geneva, 5–9 May 2014. Item 4 of the provisional agenda.
USITC.(2004). Textiles and Apparel: Assessment of the Competitiveness of Certain
Foreign Suppliers to the U.S. Market. U.S. International Trade
Commission.RetrievedFrom :
https://www.usitc.gov/publications/332/pub3671.pdf.
Utkulu U.&Dilek S. (2004) “Revealed Comparative Advantage and
Competitiveness: Evidence for Turkey vis-à-vis the EU/15”, paper prepared for the
European Trade Group 6th Annual Conference, ETSG 2004, Nottingham.
Vanek, J. 1968. The Factor Proportions Theory: The N-Factor Case. Kyklos 21(4),749-
754.
Vernon, R., & Wells, L. T. (1966). International trade and international investment in the
product lifecycle. Quarterly Journal of Economics, 81(2), 190-207.
200
Viner, J.(1950). The Customs Union Issue. New York: Carnegie Endowment for
International Peace.
Vollrath, T.L. (1991), “A Theoretical Evaluation of Alternative Trade Intensity Measures
of Revealed Comparative Advantage”, WeltwirtschaftlichesArchiv, 130, 265-79.
Vu, H. T., & Pham, L. C. (2016). A dynamic approach to assess international
competitiveness of Vietnam’s garment and textile industry. Springer Plus, 5(203), 1-13.
doi:10.1186/s40064-016-1912-3.
Wang Xu &Badman. P. (2016). A Multifaceted Panel Data Gravity Model Analysis of
Peru’s Foreign Trade.Turkish Economic Review.3(4). .562-577.
Wang. T.Y, Chien.S.C& Yin. S.(2004). National Competitiveness of Myanmar—
A View from Resource-Based Strategies. Asia Pacific Management Review9(2), 263-283
Watson. P. (2005). Ideas: A History of Thought and Invention from Fire to Freud.
New York: HarperCollins Publishers. ISBN 978-0-06-621064-3
Watchravesringkan, K., Karpova, E., Hodges, N.N., Copeland, R. (2010). The
competitive position of Thailand’s apparel industry: Challenges and opportunities for
globalization. Journal of Fashion Marketing and Management, 14(4), 576-597.
Waverman, L.(1995), A critical analysis of Porter's framework on the competitive
advantage of nations, in Alan M. Rugman, Julien Van Den Broec, Alain Verbeke (ed.)
Beyond The Diamond (Research in Global Strategic Management, Emerald Group
Publishing Limited 5., pp.67 – 95.
Wayback Machine.(2015). Textile Industry of Pakistan - An Analysis - Ravi Magazine. e.
2015-04- Factsheet Pakistan (PDF).Retrieved 17 October 2017.
Whitehill.M.(1997). Knowledge-based strategy to deliver sustained competitive
advantage. In long range planning, 30(4).621-627.
Whizz Mag (2009). Pakistan Sugar Industry. retrieved from.
whizzmag.blogspot.com/2009/04/pakistan-sugar-industry.html
Wenden, A. L. (2003). Achieving a comprehensive peace: The linguistic factor. Peace &
Change, 28(2), 169-201.
Wijnands.J.H.M., Berkum. S.V.,Verhoog.A.D.(2015). Competitiveness of CIS and EU
agrifood chains Quantifying Porter’s diamond. AgriCIS.
Wikipedia. (2016). The economy of India. Retrievedfrom:
www.wikipedia.org/wiki/Economy_of_India.
201
Wikipedia. (2017).The economy of Pakistan.Retrievedfrom:
www..wikipedia.org/wiki/Economy_of_Pakistan
World Bank (2016).World Bank Document - Open Knowledge Repository retrieved
From: https://openknowledge.worldbank.org.
World Bank Document. ( 2008). p. 14.Retrieved 10January 2016. 18-23.
World Trade Organization. (2014). Regional Trade Agreements.
Retrieved from:www.wto.org.. region.
Workman.D.(2017).Pakistan Top 10 Exports. retreived from
www.worldstopexports.com
Wright, P. M., McMahan, G. c., & Mcwilliams, A. (1994). Human Resources And Sustained
Competitive Advantage: A Resource-Based Perspective. The International Journal of
Human Resource Management, 5(2), 34. https://doi.org/Article
Yasir, Saleha,andUd-Din, Kashif and Hassan, Yasir, Financial Trends & Analysis of
Sugar Industry in Pakistan over the Decade (2001 to 2010) (November 5, 2012).
Proceedings of the 18th International Business Research Conference, 2012. Available
at: https://ssrn.com/abstract=2171490 or http://dx.doi.org/10.2139/ssrn.2171490.
Yasmin, B., & Altaf, S. (2014). Revealed comparative advantage of carpets and textile floor
covering industry in Pakistan, India,and China. Journal of Economic Cooperation and
Development, 35(4), 113–134.
Yeats, A.J. (1985). On the Appropriate Interpretation of the Revealed Comparative
Advantage Index: Implications of a Methodology Based on Industry sector
Analysis. Review of world economics.121(1),61-73
Yousafzai. (2013, June, 06). For Pakistan, time to try India as a friend. Dawn. Retrieved
from http://www.dawn.com.pk.
Yue, Changjun (2001) “Comparative Advantage, Exchange Rate and Exports in China”,
paper prepared for the international conference on the Chinese economy. CERDI.=France.
Zeenat. R. (2011). Pakistan chemical industry: Challengesand prospects-Analysis.
Retrieved from www.eurasiareview.com/19072011-pakistan chemical
Zia. U. (2006). International Competitiveness International Competitiveness - Where
Pakistan Stands? Where Pakistan Stands?Retrieved from www.pide.org.pk
202
Annexure1
Comparative Table Revealed Comparative Advantage of Pakistan and India In Different
Industries (2005-2015)
Years Textile and
clothing
Inorganic chemicals Agriculture a Sugar and sugar
confectionaries
Edible fruits and nuts
Pakistan India Pakistan India Pakistan India Pakistan India Pakistan India
2005 12.19 3.23 0.01 1.08 0.88 0.74 0.39 0.74 0.21 1.82
2006 1.80 3.16 0.007 1.00 0.10 1.06 0.32 1.06 0.21 1.59
2007 1.53 3.00 0.01 0.72 0.093 1.26 0.191 1.26 0.19 1.35
2008 1.35 2.87 0.01 0.85 0.09 1.20 0.64 1.20 0.18 1.40
2009 0.113 0.25 0.02 0.68 0.12 0.82 0.22 0.82 0.21 1.07
2010 1.16 2.73 0.017 1.37 0.10 1.26 0.13 1.26 0.22 0.98
2011 1.179 2.89 0.016 0.603 0.11 1.08 0.07 1.08 0.21 0.9
2012 1.282 3.24 0.017 0.855 0.14 1.32 0.30 1.32 0.24 0.97
203
2013 0.94 2.77 0.01 0.65 0.09 1.40 0.68 1.40 0.24 0.94
2014 0.97 2.73 0.013 0.701 0.099 1.19 0.55 1.195 0.24 0.92
2015 1.13 3.25 0.013 0.70 0.077 1.167 0.551 1.167 0.248 0.88
Source: Prepared by the Researcher
City University Research Journal Volume 08 Number 02 July 2018 PP 143-154
DETERMINING THE TRADE POTENTIAL OF TRADE BETWEEN PAKISTAN AND SAFTA COUNTRIES USING GRAVITY MODEL
1 2 3
Samra Kiran , Qadar Bakhsh Baloch and Syed Mohsin Ali Shah
ABSTRACT The study tried to identify main determinants of exports between Pakistan and SAFTA countries by applying the
gravity model of trade. Panel data were used from the period 2003 to 2016. The independent variables include
GDP, GDP per capita, distance, border, and inflation to investigate their impact on trade patterns. The Multiple
Regression models were applied. The results suggested the gravity model fits into data reasonably well and
Pakistan's GDP, distance, and border showed a significant negative relationship with trade patterns of SAFTA
countries. Whereas inflation and per capita GDP showed a significant positive relationship with trade patterns
between Pakistan and SAFTA countries. This work has tried to apply theoretical concepts and empirical analysis
to add to the limited literature already available. The results suggest significant potential in SAFTA regions for
Pakistan, which is still untapped. This suggested a development of liberal trade policies, decreasing Non- tariff
barriers to increase trade within the region.
Key Words: Trade, gravity model, SAFTA
INTRODUCTION Globalization had posed many changes at the local and international level, creating windows of opportunities.
Economic integration the outcome of trade liberalization, the main pillar of which is the world trade organization
(WTO) and international monetary fund (IMF). The modeling of trade patterns had received considerable attention
in the research academia. As the emergence of the global market had made it necessary for countries to integrate
into international trade. Various models had been identified to explain bilateral trade flows within the regional
blocs and individual trading partners, but the most popular model used was gravity model of trade based on
Newton's law of gravitation. Tinbergen (1962) used a gravity model to identify the relationship between GDP and
trade flows. Later on, Poyhonen (1963) identified that the amount of trade between countries depends upon their
distance and incomes which was further investigated by Rasoulinezhad (2016).
204
An unevenness of the production patterns of different industries in different countries, unlimited production
tendencies, international production patterns for availing benefits of low wages and cheap raw material from
developing countries is the major reason for the emergence of international trade. Sun and Heshmati (2010)
suggested that international trade had significantly impacted the economic growth of China, resulting in expansion
and higher economic growth. It will also help in achieving development goals through inclusive and sustainable
economic growth, which results in acceleration of job creation, efficient resource utilization, an entrepreneur
incentive achievement which ultimately upgrades living standards (UNCAD, 2015). Wani, Dhania, and Rehman
(2016) suggested that international trade is integral to the economic development of any country. The trade policy of Pakistan showed many ups and downs, in the beginning, it was restricted, but had to liberalize
its policy with the help of the WTO and IMF. This trend was seen in 1980. The open 1
2
3
Ph.D. Scholar, Abdul Wali Khan University, Mardan. Assistant Professor, City University of
Science & I.T. (CUSIT), Peshawar. [email protected] Director, Institute of Business Studies & Leadership, Abdul Wali Khan University, Mardan Assistant
Professor, Institute of Business Studies & Ledarship, Abdul Wali Khan University, Mardan
143 C 2018 CURJ, CUSIT
205
Determining the Trade Potential of Trade Between Pakistan and...
open trade policy gave a boost to exports and imports majorly with China, USA, Germany, UK, France, Italy,
Spain, and Bangladesh, which comprise almost 50% of the total Pakistani exports. The major importing
countries are Germany, India, USA, Kuwait, Malaysia, Japan Saud Arabia, China and Indonesia. Exports can
impact economic development significantly. Pakistan had faced with problem negative balance of payment
consistently the exports are decreasing with its neighboring countries and also with the rest of the world. The
introduction of the Generalized Scheme of Preference (GSP) has offended window of opportunity for
boosting with European countries. Despite many free trade agreements (FTAs) and Preferential Trade
Agreements (PTAs), the regional trade is not increasing. The Second World War ended up with a huge amount of destruction and distress. This marked the start of a new
era in which it was recognized that increase in international trade would greatly contribute in the development of
weak economies of the world, this framework of increased cooperation rapidly increases international trade. This
rapid increase in international trade was the resulting establishment of GATT in 1944. It was actually a multilateral
trade agreement between 23 nations, who were agreed to leave protectionist policies of the past and increase
cooperation among member countries. GATT was in effect till 1995, after which it was replaced by the WTO in
1995. These both political institutions facilitated world trade by providing procedures for increased cooperation
and facilitate trade negotiations. Now many governments are utilizing this multilateral trading system to decrease
trade barriers to increase international trade. These multilateral trade agreements rapidly increased at the end of
the 20th century. There were 34 new RTAs between 1990 to 1994 notified by the WTO. In 1995 to 2001 their
number doubled to 68 and in 2001 to 2005 almost 100 new RTAs were signed. until 2015 406 RTAs are active.
Examples of free trade agreements from North-North establishment the European Community in 1957 among
Belgium, Germany, Italy, Luxembourg, Netherlands, and France under Rome treaty another example is the
establishment of European free trade area among Denmark, Norway, Austria Sweden, Portugal, Switzerland, and
UK at Stockholm convention in 1960. Free Trade Areas found in south –south is CACM (Central American
Common Market), which was established in 1960, members of this agreement were by Honduras, Guatemala,
Costa Rica, El Salvador, and Nicaragua. In 1958 CARICOM (Caribbean Community) among by Suriname,
Barbados, Antigua, and Barbuda, Belize, Bahamas, Dominica, Guyana, Haiti, Jamaica, Granada, St. Kitts and
Nevis, St. Lucia, St. Vincent, Tobago. and Trinidad. The new wave of regionalism started in the 1980s by featuring
developing and developed countries one example is NAFTA (North American Free Trade Area) in this agreement
Canada and America was from developed countries and Mexico as a developing country and the EU (European
Union) established agreements with countries of Eastern and Central Europe and also with some Mediterranean
countries these agreements are EU-Cyprus in 2001, EU-Turkey in 1996 and Euro-Mediterranean Agreements
in1995 an in 1998 EU-Mexico trade agreement. In order to achieve advantages of Regional Trade Agreement
(RTA). South Asian Association for Regional Cooperation (SAARC) was formed among the eight nations of South Asian
1885 these countries- India, Pakistan, Nepal, Sri Lanka, Bangladesh, Maldives, Bhutan, and Afghanistan. Due to
many political reasons, this RTA had not resulted in providing considerable gains to member countries and regional
integration is very much slow. The recognition of this fact in 1993-member countries signed an agreement named
as South Asian Preferential Trading Agreement (SAPTA). This agreement had to be effective in 1995 In this
agreement trade concessions were offered to the member countries in the selected list of items. In order to boost
the process of integration C 2018 CURJ, CUSIT 144
206
Kiran et al. member countries continued their negotiations ad in 2005 SAFTA was replaced by SAFTA. This agreement was
to be operational till 2006 and achieve full integration till 2013. After the signing of these agreements' member
countries are struggling to increase regional cooperation by reducing tariffs and quotas and other non-tariff barriers.
Pakistan is an emerging economy and export revenue will help and support the country for economic development
if they untap their hidden trade potential. The policymakers in Pakistan are trying to adopt trade liberalization
policies. The country under the structural adjustment by the international monetary fund reduced or eliminated
many tariff and non-tariff barriers and also signed many trade agreements with its trading nation. Pakistan has
trapped into a trade deficit problem, which is due to the concentration of international trade in low-value items and
restricted toward few trading partners (Abass and Waheed, 2015). Exports are an important driver of economic
development, it's very important to identify factors which can help in accelerating exports within the country.
Pakistan is facing the problem of deficit balance of trade. Therefore, it's very critical to conduct research on factors
which can accelerate exports from Pakistan. The work will try to explore different factor which is contributing to accelerating trade patterns between
Pakistan and SAFTA countries. The current study had tried to use the gravity model for the overview of the
bilateral trade between Pakistan and SAFTA countries from the period 2003 to 2016. These countries were
selected to have an analysis and checking the outcome the liberalization efforts by South East Asian countries,
for the development of the overall region. As, the benefits emerged include more utilization of abundant
natural resources available and achievement of economies of scale (Helpman and Krugman, 1985) and
specialization, import needed products which cannot be produced domestically, it increases the efficiency of
domestic industries due to the international competitive environment. Earn foreign exchange for the country
(Chenery & Strout, 1966). It is also an important driver of the economy (Frankel &Romer, 1999). The main objective of this work is to quantify Pakistan's trade potential with its other regional pattern and to
analyze the main determinants of trade flows with its neighboring countries. This work will provide important
insight into the direction of trade flows of Pakistan with its SAFTA member countries. This will provide
various policy implications for the increasing trade potential of Pakistan. The gravity model is used in finding
trade potential of Pakistan with its SAFTA member countries for the period 2004 to 2016.
Research Objectives To investigate factors which can accelerate exports of Pakistan with SAFTA Countries by
applying the gravity model.
To investigate factors which can accelerate Pakistani exports to SAFTA countries.
Research Questions What are the factors which can accelerate bilateral trade patterns of Pakistan with
SAFTA countries?
LITERATURE REVIEW The role of trade and development is identified by many theoretical and empirical work, several dimensions of
trade have been discussed so, but the important question is to find the future options and determinants for country's
trade expansion. The gravity model is one of the prominent tools used
145 C 2018 CURJ, CUSIT
207
Determining the Trade Potential of Trade Between Pakistan and...
for measuring the number of trade flows. Ravenctein (1889) used a gravity model to measure migration
patterns in the UK. In 1967, the Newton postulated the “Law of Universal Gravitation” which described the
attraction between the two forces as the result of the product of the e mass the f the two bodies divided by
the squared distance between the two bodies multiplied by a gravitational constant (Head, 2003). Fij = G* Mi α * Mjβ /Dij θ
This model was further used by Tinbergen (1962) in his study trade flows. First, they used variable like the
size of the country and geographical distance. The fitted model was able to measure variation up to 80-90 %.
Tinbergen's Old Gravity Model of 1962 was as follows: The model identified by Tinbergen (1962) was specified as:
In Exports ij = β0 + β1InYi+ β2 In Yj+ β3 DIS ij + εij
the above equation shows that the exports of the country I with country j are dependent on the GNP of the
country I and in the country j the value of DIS is taken as a proxy for the transportation cost. His work
identified that a direct relationship between bilateral trade flows and economic size and indirect, whereas the
indirect relationship with the distance between two trading partners. Linneman (1996) derived gravity model
from partial equilibrium model by incorporating three costs including-, time-related cost, physical cost and
other cost arising from social and cultural differences. Anderson (1979) derived gravity model from the
constant elasticity of substitution (CES). Bergstrand (1985) suggested that gravity model is just a reduced
form of demand and supply general equilibrium. Deardorff (1995) derived gravity model from H-O theory
of factor endowment and specialization. Frankel and Romer (1999) used cross-sectional data from 63
countries gravity model to identify the impact of international trade on the living standards. Their results
suggest a positive relationship between income and trade flows between countries which further increases
with increase in geographical, human and physical capital formation. Heckscher –Ohlin theory suggests that
trade patterns are based on factors endowment. Countries having some factors in abundance use these factors
in their production process. According to Chicago school, this theory has the potential of explaining all the
trade-related factors. But, Ohlin (1913) himself argued that the world is much more dynamic and it cannot solely have explained by
comparative advantage theory. Later on, may empirical work have supported his argument. Leontief (1986) worked
on the US economy and explained that the US is a capital-intensive industry but, still they export many labor-
intensive products. Linder (1961) proposed Linder Hypothesis in which he suggests that when different countries
have similar demand patterns they tend to trade more with one another. This was a demand-based theory which
was opposite to supply based theories of the past. Linder did not give a proper model for his hypothesis, therefore
his findings were tested in different ways by different researchers. Anderson (1979) used a gravity model based on
product differentiation. The Tinbergen's ad hoc formula was progressively micro-founded by Anderson (1979), he
was of the view that gravity model can be explained by expenditure share model by taking certain assumption
which included maximization of the utility of trade goods which are differentiated and have homothetic preferences
(similarity-based preferences). Deardorff (1998) suggested a model in which he considered differences in factor endowment perfect competition,
homogeneous products and-homothetic preferences. Helpman (1999) suggested that C 2018 CURJ, CUSIT 146
208
Kiran et al. gravity models were previously used and have a long history, but these models are different from another
model as it tries to ascertain the volume of trade, but does not explain the composition of trade. The gravity
model uses an equation to predict bilateral trade between two countries. Eaton and Kortum (2002) presented
Ricardian model with the certain assumption in which he took differences in production technology, constant
returns to scale and homothetic preferences. The equation had transformed and various variable were included by different scholars to extend the model,
artificial trade resistance and population size was included by Linnemann (1966).income of the countries
were included by Frankel (1992) foreign direct investment was included by Pfaffermayr(1994) the trade
policy index was introduced by Chen and Wall (1999) in 2010, Nguyen include trade preference and
exchange rate. Based upon the above discussion the gravity equation was identified: Xij = α0 + α1(Yi) + α2(Yj) + α3(Ni) + α4(Nj) + α5(Dij) + α6(Aij) + α7 (Pij)
The role of trade and development is identified by many theoretical and empirical work, several dimensions
of trade had been discussed so, but the important question is to find the future options and determinants for
country's trade expansion. Nicholls (1998) used data from Central American Common Wealth (CACM) and applied Compensating and
equivalent variation Heckhrian measures and suggest that for this area RTAs are strictly trade diverting in
some selected commodities sectors. Thirlwall (2000) contributed that trade is very beneficial for the country
as it contributes in the fuller utilization of resources and this growth is not limited to the home country about
expanded to other parts of the globe. Hassan (2001) used gravity model by using data for SAARC countries and suggest a very low trade that
among SAFTA countries as compared to other RTAs. He identified that there are many areas which are not
been exploited by member countries, as RTAs have a positive impact on the welfare of member countries so,
all member countries should take steps for the increase of regional trade for gaining welfare impact. This
requires proper policies for decreasing political tensions, non-tariff barriers, and other tariffs. Ghosh and
Yamarik (2004) used extreme bound analysis for measuring trade creation and diversion effect of RTAs and
found that very insignificant impact of RTAs on trade creation. The SAARC region is home to an almost
one-fifth population of the world, which are mostly below the poverty level, hindering the achievement of
the goals of the SAARC. The other reasons are political tensions, Lack of trust and ups and downs in relations
between India and its neighboring countries Dahal and Pandey (2005). A gravity model was used by Carrere and Celine (2006) by using data from 130 countries and found that RTAs
can produce a significant impact on trade creation of member countries, but produce a negative impact on non-
member countries. Lee and Shin. (2006) used data from East Asia and suggest that geographical proximity and
having natural trading partners can be more trade creating join a common RTA. He also added that RTAs will
result in welfare for member countries. Hilbun and Dufour (2006) try to find impacts of RTAs in Western
Hemisphere related to the agriculture sector by applying the gravity model for 24 Western Hemisphere Nations.
Many agreements were analyzed, including NAFTA, AC, MERCO, LAIA, and CACM. The results suggested a
positive, but the insignificant effect of trade creation of NAFTA and LAIA. While for AC, MERCO, and CACM
they found the negative and insignificant effect of trade creation. The result found the positive significant
diversionary effect of NAFTA with other agreements all was negative and significant related to
147 C 2018 CURJ, CUSIT
209
Determining the Trade Potential of Trade Between Pakistan and...
diversion GDP had positive and distance has a negative relationship with trade flows. They also found that
RTAs affect more at the inter-industry trade as compared to intra-industry trade. Moktan (2009) also used
data from SAARC member countries by using pooled data from 1980–2005, and applied to augmented
gravity model, suggesting that SAPTA had a positive impact on trade between member countries in the
later period of study. As Indian growth can become an important economic driver for the whole region, but
unfortunately, the whole region is stuck in the economic trap of poverty, poor infrastructure, income
disparity, energy shortages and another environmental issue. Other reasons are internal conflicts between
member countries, ranging from high intensity (India- Pakistan) to low intensity (India-Bangladesh) and
also India Sri Lanka as the presence of Indian army in Sri Lanka. Additionally, these relations were further
worsened by cross-border terrorism, the arms race and hostile propaganda. Rivalry among two nuclear
powers- Pakistan and India continue to treat to the region. These all reason had absolutely make SAARC a
failure (Thapar, 2011). Sridharan (2008) compared the performance of SAARC and ASEAN for their role
in resolving regional conflicts and suggest that ASEAN had contributed a lot in this regard as compared to
SAARC. SAFTA was signed to boost free trade between SAARC member countries therefore, it's
important to analyze the effectiveness of SAFTA after many years of its operation. Karemera et al. (1990)
applied gravity model using pooled data from 1984 to 1993, incorporating GDP, trade flows, inflation,
domestic wholesale prices, import and exports values, distance and other geographical values and found all
variable significant in case of Pacific Rim. Lai and Zhu (2004) used cross-sectional and panel data from 34 countries using labor productivity, total
factor productivity-adjusted wages. distance, average tariffs, time-varying tariffs, labor and productivity-
adjusted wages. the results suggested that that trade liberalization are more beneficial for poor countries as
compared to rich countries. Rahman (2005) used panel data from 1972 to 1999m, to analyze trade
performance of Bangladesh with NAFTA, ASEAN, SAARC, EEC and Middle East countries. the results
follow the theoretical foundation of the gravity model. The results suggest distance, economic size, import
demand, and trade opens to be important determinants of Bangladesh trade flows. Malik and Chaudhry (2012) used gravity model by applying the least square method on panel data from 1996 to
2006. The results suggest an income of trading partners and exchange rate to be important determinants of Pakistan
's import volume. Achakzai (2006) used pooled data from 1337 countries for the year 2005 and applied the standard
gravity model to find the trade potential of Pakistan with ECO countries. The result suggests a significant potential
for Pakistan, which is not properly explored as bordering countries have greater scope for regional integration.
Rahman et al. (2006) used panel data from 51 countries from the period 1991 to 2003, in order to find trade creation
and trade diversion of the effect of SAFTA, by applying gravity model. the results suggest that SAFTA had created
a trade in the region, but it also caused net trade diversion in the region Ruiz and Butt (2008) identified that Pakistan
has a significant trade potential with India, China USA, and Hong Kong by applying Gravity model with the Pseudo
maximum likelihood method for 19 Pakistani sectors examined. Khan et al. (2013) used biennial panel data from
1990 to 2010 of Pakistan with its major trading partner countries. Gravity model was applied with distance, GDP,
and GDP per capita and found that Pakistan has an untapped trade potential with Malaysia, Turkey, Japan, Iran,
and India. Based on the above discussion, the work had identified five independent variables to check their impact
on the trade flows of selected SAFTA countries to test the following hypothesis. C 2018 CURJ, CUSIT 148
210
Kiran et al. Hypothesis: H1: GDP has a significant impact on trade flows between countries H2: Per capita GDP has a significant impact on trade flows between countries H3: border has a significant impact on trade flows between countries H4: RTA has a significant impact on trade flows between countries H5: inflation has a significant impact on trade flows between countries H6: Distance has a significant impact on trade flows between countries
METHODOLOGY The work had tried to investigate main determinants of trade between SAFTA countries. this section will
provide details of main independent and the dependent variable, sample, data sources.
3.1 Data To evaluate hypotheses of the study the work had relied on Panel data. Data from the SAARC countries was
collected, based upon their trade with Pakistan. From all the SAARC countries, India, Bangladesh,
Afghanistan and Sri Lanka were selected. Maldives, Nepal, and Bhutan were excluded as they do not have
any significant trade with Pakistan. All observations were taken on an annual basis. GNP, GDP, GNP per
capita and GDP per capita, inflation, population taxes on international trade, imports, exports, and CPI was
extracted from world bank data portal. The data of trade patterns between Pakistan and SAFTA countries
was extracted from trade map website. Data on the distance between Karachi and other capitals of the
countries included in the sample was obtained from www.indo.com/distance.
3.2 Gravity model Ravenctein (1889) used a gravity model to measure migration patterns in the UK. In 1967, the Newton
postulated the “Law of Universal Gravitation” which described attraction between two forces as the result of
the product of the mass of the two bodies divided by the squared distance between the two bodies multiplied
by a gravitational constant (Head, 2003). Fij = G* Mi α * Mjβ /Dij θ
This model was used by Tinbergen (1962) in his study trade flows. First, they used variable like the size of
the country and geographical distance. The fitted model was able to measure variation up to 80-90 %.
Tinbergen's Old Gravity Model of 1962 was as follows: The model identified by Tinbergen (1962) was specified as:
InExportsij =β0+β1InYi+β2 In Yj+ β3DISij+ εij
the above equation shows that the exports of the country I with country j are dependent on the GNP of the
country I and in the country j the value of DIS is taken as a proxy for the transportation cost. Xij = trade
flows from country I to j Yi = GDP of country i Yj=l GDP of country j Ni = population size of country The nj= population size of country j 149 C 2018 CURJ, CUSIT
211
Determining the Trade Potential of Trade Between Pakistan and...
Aij= any other factor affecting trade between country I and j The Augmented Gravity Model Log (tradei) = α +ß1(log GDPiGDPj) + ß2 log(PCDGPiPCDGPj) ß3 LOG (Distanceij)+ ß4log(Borderij ) +
ß5 (PCDGDPD) B6 LOG (INFLATION) +μ
(PCGDPD) shows the absolute value of per capita income differentials and dummies for a common border
(BORDER) etc., the dummies can take values of units or zeros.
3.3 Variables 3.3.1 Dependent variable
1. Trade would be measured by the total sum of imports and exports between countries
3.3.2 Independent variables 1. GDP
As GDP of the trading nation can be used as a proxy for the economic size of the country, it can be used as
a core variable for gravity model. Ehsan (2017) Found a significant positive relationship between GDP and
trade flows. Apostolov and Josheski, (2018) also found a significant positive relationship between trade flows
and GDP.
2. Capita GDP (PCGDP) Per Capita GDP Differential - Absolute (PCGDPD) It accounts for the effective distance between neighboring
countries that are likely to be engaged in mutual trade more frequently.
3. BORDER
A dummy variable is used for borders, which takes the value 1 if countries have common border and 0 otherwise.
It is commonly believed that countries which share common border usually share common language traditions
culture values customs and similar consumption patterns. So, there is an expectation of positive relationship
between border and trade flows. Ehsan (2017) found a contradictory in case of China trade with OPEC countries.
4. EXCHANGE RATE The exchange rate can be used to find its impact on trade flow. As international trade increase exchange rate
risk so it has an impact on trade flows. The depreciation of the currency encourages exports and discourage
imports. Ehsan (2017) found an insignificant relationship between trade flows and exchange rate.
5. INFLATION This variable measures the price levels of the countries. Most of the previous work had found a negative
relationship between inflation and trade flows. Rahman (2005), Roy and Rayhan (2011). Found positive,
whereas Kaur and Nanda (2010) and Gul and Yasin (2011). Iqbal et al. (2014) and (Apostolov & Josheski,
2018) found a negative relationship between inflation and trade flows.
6. DISTANCE Distance can use as a proxy for transportation and time-related cost. Ehsan (2017) found a significant negative
relationship between distance and trade flows. It shows that increased
C 2018 CURJ, CUSIT 150
212
Kiran et al. distance decreases trade flows between countries as a result of higher transportation cost. The same result
was found by Wang et al (2010) in case of 19 OECD countries, by Apostolov and Josheski (2018) in case f
Asia Pacific Rim and byKhan et al. (2013) in case of Pakistan.
RESULTS In order to test the hypotheses related to the relationship between trade flows and GDP, GDP per capita, inflation,
distance, border, and exchange rate. A regression model was developed and applied. The Table # 1 shows
descriptive statistics of all the independent variables used in the model. The value of kurtosis is less than the
absolute value of 2. This show the normality of the data.
Table 01: Descriptive Statistics
Mean Median Minimum Maximum Standard C.V. Skewness Ex. kurtosis
deviation
Trade 1.01E+06 7.51E+05 1.26E+05 2.85E+06 7.76E+05 0.763 0.64 -0.95
Flows
GDP 4.0E+011 7.38E+010 4.5E+09 2.2E+012 6.6E+011 1.6330 1.63 1.15
GDP per 1224.2 904 198.73 3844.9 988.6 0.80760 1.50 1.34
caita
Inflation 7.4742 7.01 -8.2831 30.5 5.3 0.70872 1.39 2
Distance 1746.4 1735.4 1093.6 2421 655.6 0.37545 0.002 -1.99
Border 0.500 0.50 0 1 0.50 1.0090 0 -2
Exchang 0.93 0.81 0.53 1.82 0.368 0.39609 0.92 -0.28
e Rate Table 02 shows the correlation matrix of all the independent variables. The results suggest that the data is
free from multicollinearity and fit for further analysis.
Table 02: Correlation Matrix
GDP GDP PER CAPITA INFLATION DISTANCE BORDER EXCHANGE
GDP 1 0.0638 0.0067 -0.4934 -0.3469 0.4899
GDP per capita 1 -0.0854 0.4377 0.8358 -0.4217
Inflation 1 0.01585108 0.0444 1.1656
Distance 1 -0.0999 0.529
Border 1 0.7379
Exchange rate 1
Table 03: Regression Results
VARIABLE COEFFICIENT STDERROR T STAT P-VALUE
Const 1078.08 84.9819 12.686 <0.00001 **
GDP -0.492635 0.0513077 -9.602 <0.00001 ***
151 C 2018 CURJ, CUSIT
213
Determining the Trade Potential of Trade Between Pakistan and...
GDP percapit 1.63163 0.136857 11.922 <0.00001 ***
Distance -136.859 10.8898 -12.568 <0.00001 ***
Border -104.279 8.40317 -12.409 <0.00001 ***
Inflation 0.0646092 2.853 2.853 0.00638 *** Unadjusted R-squared = 0.91769 Adjusted R-squared = 0.909116
F-statistic (5, 48) = 107.032 (p-value < 0.00001) The Table # 3 shows results of the regression model the coefficient of the GDP is statistically significant and
show a negative relationship with trade flows of the counties. GDP per capita shows a significant positive
relationship with trade flows. The coefficient of distance shows a negative relationship with trade flows. The
coefficient of the border also shows a significant negative relationship with trade flows. The coefficient of
inflation shows a positive significant relationship with trade flow. All the variables were significant at 1%
significant level. The adjusted R square is 91.7% which suggest that 91.7 % variation in trade bilateral trade
flows of Pakistan is due to the independent variables in the model. The value of f-statistic is 107.032 p-value
0.00001m, which suggests that overall model is significant at 1 % significant level.
DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS The results suggest that the all the variable identified in the model have a significant impact on the trade patterns
n between Pakistan and other SAFTA countries. The GDP was used to measure the size of the economy and shows
a negative and significant relationship with trade patterns which does not follow the results of Wang and Badman
(2016) which shows a positive relationship, between GDP and trade flows. The reason might be political tensions
between member countries, many tariffs and non-tariff barriers, political tensions and extreme poverty levels of
SAARC countries. The negative sign of estimated coefficient shows that Linder hypothesis dominates H-O
hypothesis which means that those countries usually trade less who has a different factor of the endowment. The distance shows a negative relationship with trade flows confirming the proposition of the gravity model,
as increased transaction cost due to the increased distance of the country will decrease trade flows between
countries this follows the results of Wang and Badman (2016)which shows a negative relationship with trade
flows. The coefficient of per capita GDP shows a positive and significant relationship with trade flows
confirming the results of Wang and Badnam (2016). Abass and Waheed (2015) attempt to investigate
Pakistan trade patterns with 40 trading partners from 1991 to 2011, using panel data on augmented gravity
model. The study intends to investigate and identify potential trading partners for Pakistan. The results
suggest that Pakistani exports are determined by Pakistan's supply capacity and import country's demand
potential and additionally by market size, it shows a negative relationship with distance. The relative price
shows significant positive, but less elastic impact. The result of export potential shows that Pakistan has
higher export potential with India. The coefficient of the border also shows a significant negative relationship
with trade flows. Ellahi, Mehmood, and Ahmad (2011) also found a significant impact of trade flows on the
economic development of the country and its import for developing countries to adopt liberal trade policies
of openness for the development of the standard of living of the people. The coefficient of inflation shows a
positive significant relationship with trade flow.
C 2018 CURJ, CUSIT 152
214
Kiran et al.
CONCLUSION The work had tried to find the main determinants of exports in Pakistan with SAFTA countries by applying
gravity model. The panel data was used from 2003 to 2016. The major intention was to identify any untapped
trade potential for Pakistan in SAFTA area. The major independent variable identified and tested were GDP,
GDP per capita, distance, border, inflation, and exchange rate. The workers tried to find the impact of these
independent variables on the trade flows between Pakistan and SAFTA countries. The result follows the
prediction of gravity model in case of distance and per capita GDP. But, in case of the size of the economy
and Border, it does not follow gravity model. The reason might be political tensions between the regional
partners and extreme poverty levels of many countries in the region. Therefore its very import for all the
SAFTA countries to increase trade liberalization and effective implementation of SAFTA policies.
REFERENCES Abbas.S., Waheed.A. (2015) Pakistan's Potential Export Flow: The Gravity Model Approach. https://www.researchgate.net/publication/281522999. Anderson, J. E. (2010). The Gravity Model, 1–3. https://doi.org/10.3386/w16576 Apostolov, M., & Josheski, D. (2018). Macedonia's exports toward Southeast Europe through the gravity
model. Journal of Economic and Administrative Sciences, JEAS-05-2017-0039.
https://doi.org/10.1108/JEAS-05-2017-0039 Carrere, Celine (2006) Revisiting the effects of regional trade agreements on trade flows with proper
specification of the gravity model. European Economic, 50, I( 2), 223–247 Chenery, Hollis B., and Alan M. Strout, 1966, "Foreign Assistance and Economic Development. American Economic Review. 56:149-179. Dahal.D. R., Pandey.N. N. (2005). New life within SAARC. Institute of Foreign Affairs & Friedrich-Ebert-
Stiftung. Reterived from https://books.google.com/books/about/New_Life_Within_SAARC. Deardorff AV. 1998. Determinants of bilateral trade: does gravity work in a classical world. Retrieved from: http://www.nber.org/chapters/c7818 Eaton, Jonathan and Kortum, Samuel (2002): “Technology, Geography, and Trade,” Econometrica, 70(5),
1741-1779. Ehsan R.( 2017). "China's foreign trade policy with OPEC member countries," Journal of Chinese
Economic and Foreign Trade Studies, Emerald Group Publishing, vol. 10(1), 61-81. Ellahi.N., Mehmood.H.Z., Ahmad.M. (2011). Analyzing the empirical relationship between trade openness,
industrial value-added and economic growth: A Case Study Of Pakistan. Interdisciplinary Journal Of Contemporary Research In Business. Frankel Jeffrey A., Romer David H. (1999). Does Trade Cause Growth?. American Economic Review.89(3),
379-399. Ghosh and Yamarik (2004) Ghosh S, Yamarik S. 2004. Are preferential trade agreements trade creating? An
application of extreme Helpman, E., and Krugman, P. R. (1985). “Market Structure and Foreign Trade,” MIT Press, Cambridge,
MA. Leontief, Wassily (1953).Domestic Production and Foreign Trade; The American Capital Position Re-
examined. Proceedings of the American Philosophical Society. 332- 349. 153 C 2018 CURJ, CUSIT
215
Determining the Trade Potential of Trade Between Pakistan and...
Lindner, Staffan B. (1961): “An essay on trade and transformation,” John Wiley and Sons, New York. Moktan, Suresh. (2009). The Impact of Trade Agreements on Exports: Empirical Evidence from SAARC
Countries. Journal of International Economic Studies.23, 23–42. Sun P., Heshmati. (2010). International Trade and its Effects on Economic Growth in China IZA Discussion
Paper No. 5151.
Ravenstein, E.G. ( 1889) The laws of migration, Part 1 and Part 2. Journal of the Royal Statistical Society,
48(2): 167‐235 and 52(2): 241‐305. Thapar. Raghav. (2011). Ineffective in Promoting Economic Cooperation in South Asia. Sandford Journal
of International Relation. Tinbergen, Jan (1962): “Shaping the World Economy: Suggestions for an International Economic Policy,”
The Twentieth Century Fund, New York. Thirlwall (2000). Trade liberalization and economic growth: Theory and practice. The African development
bank economic research paper no. 63. UNCAD. (2015). The role of international trade in the post-2015 development agenda Trade and
Development Board. Trade and Development Commission Sixth session Geneva, 5–9 May 2014. Item 4 of
the provisional agenda. Wang Xu &Badman. P. (2016). A Multifaceted Panel Data Gravity Model Analysis of Peru's Foreign Trade.
Turkish Economic Review.3(4). .562-577.
1
2
An Application of Porter's Diamond Model: A case of Pakistani selected industries
Samra Kiran
PhD Scholar (Abdul Wali Khan University, Mardan)
Prof. Dr. Qadar Bakhsh Baloch
Director (Institute of Business Studies & Leadership)
Abdul Wali Khan University, Mardan
Abstract
The aim the study was to identify factor contributing in Pakistan’s national competitive
advantage in trade. The panel data was applied to five Pakistani industries from 2005-15.
Fixed effect model was applied to the data. The results suggest the overall model is
significant, but only government policy was found significant in individual variable case.
As, International competitiveness is critical for the attraction of investment, tourism and
Other services. The current work will analyze variables through which international
competitiveness can be attained for Pakistani industries. The future studies can be directed
toward other industries, additionally majority of the data was unorganized and
undocumented, due to which limited items were included in the development of variables
future studies can include more items in the development of variables.
Keywords: Competitive Advantage, Trade, Pakistan
Introduction
3
Pakistan came into existence on 14 August 1947. The country has very significant
development potential. It is located at the crossroads of China, Middle East, and South
Asia. It is thus at the fulcrum of a regional market, having large population untapped
potential for trade and diverse resources. At the time of independence, Pakistan was an
agriculturally based country. In the first five decades, its average economic growth was
above the world economy in the same period (Ahid & Wali 2017). Pakistan purchasing
power parity (PPP) in 1980 was $71.81 billion. It grew up to $793.85 billion in 2013.
Pakistan was ranked 42nd in terms of GDP and 24 in terms of PPP. With a population of
over 190 million (the world's 6th-largest) with 6% of the total population is below the
poverty line, its nominal GDP per capita is $1,428 in 2016. Pakistan was ranked 25th in
2017. Growth in GDP was 4.5 % in 2015 and 6.7% in 2016 and 5.2% in 2017 with the
expectation of 5.5% growth in 2018, with the agriculture sector contributing 25%. services
54 %, and industrial sector 20% in the total GDP (Wikipedia, 2017).
The main issue which is threatening its economic stability and growth is decades of
war against terrorism and political instability which had seriously damaged its
infrastructure and other managerial issues. Pakistan economy is semi-industrialized, which
is growing along the Indus River (Henneberry, 2000). A seminar on Pakistan
competitiveness by Zia (2006) suggested a weak Competitive position of Pakistani firms
with stagnant growth. As compared to newly emerging economies. The exports are mainly
composed of low technology products. But, despite weak competitive position the
economy is showing signs of recovery, which might be the result of economic reforms,
concessional financing, debt restructuring, structural reforms, designing of policies with
resulted in increased GDP (Zia, 2006). Currently, the country is in the process of trade
liberalization and privatization of many public organizations for the attraction of FDI and
also for decreasing the problem of the budget deficit (Pakistan Country Report, 2010).
Primary export commodities include chemicals, leather, textiles, sports goods, medical
instruments, and carpets/rugs. (Workman, 2017). Other item exported by Pakistan are
Cotton, Cereals, Ores, slag, ash, Salt, Sulphur, stone, cement, Rawhides excluding fur skin,
Plastics, Food waste, animal fodder, Copper, Fish, Gums, resins, Other textiles, worn
4
clothing, Knit or crochet, Clothing (not knit or crochet), Leather, animal gut articles,
Medical, technical equipment, Textile floor coverings, Furniture, lighting, signs, Plastics,
Fruits, nuts, Footwear, Toys, games, Toys, games, Manmade staple fibers, Salt, Sulphur,
stone, cement, Vegetables, Alcoholic beverages, Sugar, Base metal tools, cutlery, Coffee,
tea and spices, organic and inorganic chemicals and oilseed (Pakistan Defense Forum,
2015).
Research Questions
• What are the factors which contribute to the competitive advantage of Pakistan
international trade.?
Research Objectives
• To identify factors affecting Pakistan National Competitive Advantage in trade
with India during post SAFTA period (2005 to 2015).
Significance Of Research
The study could provide information on Pakistani industries and sources of their
competitive advantage. Countries like companies compete in the international market. At
the firm level, the competitiveness can be attained by the combination of strong political
and legal system, with stable institutions and social frameworks, this work will identify
factors which can play important role in the development of competitive advantage.
Additionally, the macro, as well as micro-conditions of the nation, will help to attain and
sustain competitiveness in the global market. As, International competitiveness is critical
for the attraction of investment, tourism and Other services. The current work will analyze
variables through which international competitiveness can be attained for Pakistani
industries.
Literature Review
5
There are certain countries in which companies are consistently engaged in innovation
and improvement and able to gain and sustain competitive advantage in different industries.
They are also able to overcome barriers to reach different markets. The reason for their
success lies in four important attributes of that country. These attributes individually and
as a constitute diamond of national competitive advantage. This actually a playing field
which is developed by that country for its industries. These attributes are:
Factor Conditions include the condition of a factor of production, including human,
physical, informational, infrastructure and capital necessary for the competition in a
particular industry. Demand Conditions include the composition of home demand and
number and sophisticated customer in the home country. For particular goods and services.
Related and Supporting Industries are the existence or absence of supplier’s industries and
other internationally competitive supporting and relates industries for a particular product
or service. Firm Strategy, Structure, and Rivalry are the business environment of the nation
in which companies develop their strategies and also the nature of domestic rivalry in the
countries. The role of government the policies and procedures perused by the government
to boost the competitiveness of the country.The role of chance is the sudden incidents or
6
events which might have affected the competitiveness of the country.
Figure 1 Porter Diamond Model
Source: Porter (1980)
Factor Conditions
Factor conditions are the backbone of any economy. They play a vital role in the
development and acceleration in the economic development of any country. These factors
are a combination of basic and advanced factors. As Pakistan is a factor driven economy,
Therefore, the factor condition plays a very important role in the development of national
competitive advantage in Trade. The detailed analysis of different factors of Pakistan is as
follows:
7
Human Resource
Human capital and its development play an integral part in the development of
competitive advantage. In this regard, professional experts have strategic importance
(Debrah and Ofori, 2006). For the development of the knowledge-based economy, it’s very
essential to develop human resource of the country which reduces skill mismatch in the
labor market and creates a competitive advantage for the nation by enhancing economic
and social development for the improvement of the wellbeing of its citizens (Khan, 2005).
The Agriculture sector has employed 43% of the total workforce, whereas, wholesale and
retail sector, 9.2 %, manufacturing sector, 13.3 %, and transportation and communication
sector contribute 7.3% of the total workforce (Pakistan economic survey 2013). Afridi
(2016) suggests a positive relationship between human capital and economic growth using
data from 1972 to 2013 from Pakistan they applied ARDL and VECM models. The study
suggested that it’s very important for Pakistan to invest in education and health sector from
its budgets for long-term benefits for the economy.
Pakistan has a population of over 220 million. But it is utilizing almost or less than 20% of
its workforce on the professional, managerial and technical positions, a Major portion of
its workforce is engaged in the industrial and agricultural workforce at the front line (Afza
& Nazir, 2007). Pakistan is situated in South East Asia and the majority of this workforce
is comprised of the labor force, the majority of countries in this region have a labor-
intensive economy. As compared to other economies of South Asia, Pakistan is in a better
position, as it is using its workforce at technical, administrative and professional positions.
However, improvement is still needed in many areas. The current education system has to
be modified and upgraded, the industry and academia should bridge the gap and work
together for the development of the required skills and technical expertise needed. New
institutes for training and development should be established. Pakistan is in the top ten
(9th) labor forces of the countries of the world (Brinkhoff, 2013).
The education sector is dominated by poor infrastructure, ghost teaching staff in many
village schools, poor teaching staff and very inadequate learning outcomes (Arshad, 2016).
8
In the health sector, government spending was 1% of GDP in 2013, which makes it the
lowest spender in the health sector in the world. The outcomes of the health sector have
improved but showed very low improvement in nutritional outcomes. Which is not
improved since two decades, and even worsened. According to the survey on National
Nutrition, the 44% of child stunning rates remained static since 1965, with 15% acute
malnutrition in under 5 years of age. The official statistic suggested reduced poverty rates.
Reductions in poverty have been strong in both urban and rural areas, and the fall in rural
poverty from 40 to 16 percentage points between 2002 and 2011 is particularly striking.
This decline in poverty is confirmed when examining the poverty headcount according to
the international poverty line of $1.25 per capita. According to this metric, poverty in
Pakistan declined from 36 % in 2002 to 11 % in 2011. Pakistan now has the second lowest
headcount poverty rate in the South Asia region, after Sri Lanka (4 %). A large mass of the
population moved from just below to just above the official poverty line, which is why
small improvements in households’ real consumption. Despite increased growth in many
sectors, Pakistan is faced with the problems of very low human development and very low
labor force participation and economic growth. It ranked 146 out of total 187 countries in
2014. Which is lower than most of the South Asian countries. Access to education is very
low with primary completion very low. Government spending on education is 2.1 % of
the total GDP in 2013 (Wikipedia, 2017).
Physical Resources
The major resource of Pakistan’s is its arable land and water. Pakistan has a larger
irrigation system with 25% of arable land under cultivation. It irrigates almost three times
more acres than, Russia with a favorable climate, agriculture contributes 23 % in the GDP
and employs 44% of the total workforce of the country (World Bank, 2008). The country
is endowed with a large number of mineral resources and a very promising area for
exploration of mineral reserves. The country is gifted with almost 6,00,000 km² of the
outcrops area demonstrates a geological potential of different varieties metallic and non-
metallic mineral reserves (Wikipedia, 2017).
9
Knowledge Resources
There is a dire need to increase research and development culture in Pakistan to
increase exports (Manan, 2013). There are a large number of research institutions set up at
federal and provincial level by the government, but the main problem is inconsistent
financial support from the government, lack of linkage between academia and industry and
lack of funding for market-based surveys. The science and technology board of
management has made significant efforts for the development of national science policy
(Butt, 2015).
Capital Resources
The banking sector of Pakistan remained very strong during the financial crises of
2008-9, attracting a huge amount of FDI (Wikipedia,2017). The consumer financing
greatly flourished in the country during the last few years due to the privatization of banks.
There is an inadequate finance to many sectors. The FDI is the major external source of
finance, which can help modernize the industries and it helps to integrate the economy in
world markets. Pakistan had taken reasonable steps to increase the amount of FDI. It is
categorized as one of the top ten destinations of Asia (SBP, 2017).
Infrastructure Resources
The Pakistan telecommunication industry has shown remarkable growth due to
regularization measures. In 2008 mobile subscribers reached 140 million in 2014, which
was the world’s highest mobile tele densities (Wayback machine,2010). There are above 6
million landlines having 100% fiber-optic network. Which provide coverage to the
remotest areas of the country (Wikipedia, 2017). There are almost 3.1 million fixed line
users, additionally 2.4 million wireless users. The liberalization measures had attracted
almost $90 million FDI During 2007-8 (Wikipedia, 2017). This sector attracted $1.62
billion FDI which almost 30% of the FDI received by the country. The Current growth of
state-of-the-art infrastructures in the telecoms sector is due to the efforts of PTA’s vision
and implementation of the updated policy. Internet and mobile phones were adopted with
10
laissez-faire policy. There is a rapid increase in internet users with an increased number of
people speaking in English; the Pakistani society has shown a remarkable revolution in
communication. In terms of growth in broadband internet, Pakistan is ranked 4th in the
world (Wikipedia, 2017). In 2009 the country had 20 million internet users with the
capability of absorbing 50 million in the next 5 years (Wikipedia, 2017). Every government
department has their own website. The used of search engines and messaging devices is
accelerating very rapidly. This sector had provided almost 80000 directly and 500000 jobs
indirectly (Wikipedia, 2017).
Supporting and Related Industries
An efficient and modernized communication and transportation system is a key for the
success of a country. Public and private investment in this sector greatly reduces
transportation cost and also generates employment. Pakistan has reasonably developed its
transportation infrastructure. The country bears a load of almost 239 billion passenger
kilometers domestic transport and 153 billion kilometers per year. The demand for
domestic transportation services, higher than the growth in GDP. The road transport
system plays a vital role in the overall transport system. The network of about 3.65% of
the total road network in the country. It carries loads of about 80% of the total road traffic.
Over the last few decades, the freight and passenger traffic has significantly grown even
more than the national economy. But there is negligence in the other modes of
transportation; the government is now trying to improve them as well. The port traffic is
increasing at the pace of *8% per annum. There are three major ports efficiently working
including Karachi, Port Qasim, and Gwadar port. There are also 14 dry ports working to
cater to foreign trade. Pakistan Railways (PR) provides service for inland transportation,
which cheaper than land routes. It consists of the main North-South corridor, which
connects the Karachi port and the primary production and different population centers
within Pakistan. There are 36 operational airports in the country which handle both
domestic and international cargo (Pakistan Economic Survey, 2007-8).
11
Firm Strategy and Rivalry
According to the world bank, Pakistan had made a significant progress in doing
business index in medium and small size business. It is included in the top ten improvers
of the world. The country has also announced a roadmap for the next three years for further
improvement in the global ranking of doing business. The country has also implemented
reforms in the last three years for registering property, trading across the border and getting
credit (Wikipedia,2017).
The introduction of digitalization process land transferring and other land has improved
and became more reliable. Introduction of cross-border electronic custom platforms both
in Karachi and Lahore had decreased time for fulfilling border regulation. The government
of Pakistan has also improved access to credit information and provided a legal guarantee
to borrower right for the inspection of their data. This has also increased the country
ranking in getting credit. Despite these efforts, the domestic businessmen still face many
problems in different areas including enforcing the contracts and also getting electricity. It
also takes almost 3 years to clear a dispute in Pakistan as compared to world average of
637 days. The companies in Karachi and Lahore faces power outages on a daily basis
(Pasha & Saleem, 2013).
Government Policy
Amjad.et.al (2012) performed a firm-level survey using data from Pakistan and
suggested that the key impediment to Pakistan export competitiveness are, skilled labor
shortages, energy crises, poor infrastructure, and market imperfection. Which needs a clear
and practical government policy to be devised to solve these problems, and help to expand
the export market of the country. The growth strategy of Pakistan followed a pattern of
sector-picking for the sake of import substitution and later for export promotion. This kind
of policy results in negligence of other sectors and distortion of incentives in the public and
12
private sectors. There is an urgent requirement of deregulation of subsidies and tax
incentives for true innovation and entrepreneurship (Hussain &Ahmed, 2011).
Hussain (2017) identified that the decline in the international price of oil and gas were
not passed to exporters of the country, who are not able to take advantage of cost-saving
and innovate new product to be introduced in the market. Exporters are continuously
stressed by the government to increase their exports, but they are continuously faced with
the problem to load-shedding. Additionally, their inconsistency and lack of coordination
between various government policies. Import tariffs are purely driven by or protection of
domestic, import-substituting industries or revenue mobilization. It is not being realized
that a restrictive import regime with the tariff, nontariff and regulatory barriers, and
customs clearance procedures which are very cumbersome and with autocratic powers
enjoyed by low-level customs officials which are amenable to corruption, would restrict
entry of Pakistan into the global market. Large-scale manufacturer enjoys higher tax
incentives which restrict medium-sized firms to attain economies of scale.
13
Conceptual Framework
Based on the above discussion the following conceptual framework was designed
H1
H3
Figure 2 Conceptual Framework
Human resources
Physical resources knowledge resources
Capital resources
infrastructure
Skilled labor
technology
Supporting industries
Related industries
Irrigation system
Home demand
composition
Demand size and
pattern
Internationalization
of domestic demand
Intense competition
Quality and
quantity of
products
Industry status
RTAs
Tariffs
Accountability and transparency
Factor conditions
Government Policy
Demand conditions
Supporting and related
industries
Firm strategy,
structure and rivalry
National
Competitive
Advantage
in Trade
14
Hypotheses
Based upon the discussion above and the conceptual model following hypotheses was
generated
H1= Factor endowment has a significant relationship with National competitive advantage
in trade.
H2= demand conditions have a significant relationship with National competitive
advantage in trade.
H3= Supporting industry has a significant relationship with National competitive advantage
in trade.
H4= Firm strategy, structure, and rivalry has a significant relationship with National
competitive advantage in trade
H5= Government policy has a significant relationship with National competitive advantage
Methodology
Exports are the important driver of the economy, which helps to boost the level of economic
growth, the balance of payment and employment. After independence Pakistan had faced
since its independence in 1947. At that time, the economy was based on agriculture. The
economy had shown a positive growth since independence and developed as a semi-
industrialized country, which was greatly based on agriculture, food products, and textiles.
But it is not able to bridge a gap between itself and developed countries. As export is one
of the components of aggregate demand, an increase in exports will increase economic
growth. The export growth also accelerates service sector and benefit the local economy.
There are many factors which will determine the level of exports conducted by the country
are its - Competitiveness, value addition of exports, exchange rate, sustained productivity
15
and economic growth. The balance of trade compares the value of a country's export of
goods and services against its imports. When the export of the country is greater than its
imports the country tends to have a positive or surplus balance of trade. The surplus
balance of trade is beneficial for the economy, but unfortunately, Pakistan is facing the
deficit balance of trade since very long. A serious effort is required to overcome this
situation. In this regard series of steps has taken by the government to liberalized trade
The study had analyzed different industries of Pakistan and India with an intention to
identify sources of competitive advantage of Pakistan by applying Porter National diamond
model. The ultimate purpose was to ascertain that after so many trade liberalization efforts
and implementation of SAFTA there exist trade creation or trade diversion in Pakistan.
The current study had used secondary data. The panel data was collected for the period
2005 to 2015. 5 Pakistani industries were selectedincluding textile, Sugar and Sugar
Confectionaries, Inorganic Chemicals, edible fruits and nuts, food and agriculture. In
assessing the competitiveness of different industries, Revealed Comparative Advantage
(RCA)was calculated. Which was also used by Mukhtar and Javed (2009) Rattanavijit,
Somboonwiwat and Khompatraporn. (2012).
Table 1 Variable Proxies Data Source and references
Variables Components Proxies Sources References
Factor
conditions
(FC)
Human Resources
(HR)
Labor force
Participation
rate
World bank Wijinads, et.al
(2005)
Tuerck et al.
(2007b, 2008)
16
Education
Index
HDR Report Wang, Chaing,
and Yin (2004)
GDP Per
Capita
World bank Wijinads, et.al
(2005)
Physical Resources
(PH)
Agricultural
land
World bank Wijinads, et.al
(2005)
Gawad, lkhteeb,
Intezar (2014)
Knowledge
Resources (KR)
R&D
expenditure
(% of GDP)
World Bank Wijinads, et.al
(2005
Balcarova (2013)
Capital Resources
(CR)
Getting
credit
World bank Wijinads, et.al
(2005)
FDI Inflows
(billion
USD)
World
Development
Index
Wijinads, et.al
(2005)
Infrastructure (IF) Internet
Users per
1000
individuals
World
Development
Index
Wijinads, et.al
(2005)
17
Demand
conditions
(DC)
Home demand
composition (HD)
Total
population
(million
people)
World bank Wijinads, et.al
(2005)
Vu and Pham
(2016
Demand Size and
Pattern (DSP)
GDP (billion
USD)
Pakistan
Bureau of
statistics
Vu and Pham
(2016)
Internationalization
of Domestic Demand
(IDD)
Total export
value
industry
(billion
USD)
Pakistan
Bureau of
statistics
Vu and Pham
(2016)
Home Demand
Composition (HDC)
GDP per
capita (USD)
World bank Wijinads, et.al
(2005)
Vu and Pham
(2016)
Related and
Supporting
Industries
(RSI)
Domestic Supporting
Industries (DSH)
Mobile
subscription
World bank
Related
industries(RI)
Rail lines
(total route-
km) and
Roads,
World bank Wijinads, et.al
(2005)
Balcarova (2013)
18
Sources of Data
paved (% of
total road
Firm
structure,
rivalry, and
strategy
(FSRS)
Domestic Rivalry
(DR)
The
intensity of
local
competition
Prices of
products
Wijinads, et.al
(2005)
Business Context
(BC)
World bank
DTF points
World bank Vu and Pham
(2016)
International Rivalry
(IR)
Market share
of the
country in
the global
market
World bank Vu and Pham
(2016)
Government
Policy (GP)
Regional Trade
Agreement (RTA)
Dummy
variable
World bank Herath, Liang,
Yongbing (2014)
Tariffs (TF) Average
Tariff Rate
World Bank David (2007).
National
Competitive
Advantage
In Trade
(NCA)
Exports Revealed
comparative
advantage
Pakistan
statistical
bureau
Mukhtar. and
Javed (2009)
Rattanavijit et al
(2012)
19
The work was based on secondary data, various data sources were used in the work.
The list of data sources is given below:
• World Integrated Trade Statistics (WITS)
• UN COMTRADE.
• Bureau of Statistics Pakistan.
• State Bank of Pakistan.
• Pakistan Economic Survey.
• Trade map
Data
The population of this work was industries of Pakistan. The work had tried to find the
source of competitive advantage in different industries of Pakistan, applying national
diamond model presented by Porter (1990). The panel data was used to analyze the export
competitiveness of Pakistan.The sample consists of five industries from Pakistan. The
industries include Agriculture, textile, Sugar and Sugar confectionaries, Edible fruits and
nuts and inorganic chemical industry. The sample consists of five industries from Pakistan
for the period 2005-2015.The sampling techniques used for the analysis were purposive
sampling. In order to analyze industries of Pakistan.
The data were collected from the sources mentioned above. After the collection of the
data, the thorough check was done for identifying error entries, outliers etc. The z- values
were calculated for standardization. After those descriptive statistics were calculated for
checking the normality of the data. The correlation matrix was also calculated between the
independent variables for the detection of the multicollinearity problem. In order to select
between fixed effect or random effect model, the Hausman test was calculated. In order to
check before applying the model data should be tested for Stationary and autocorrelation.
20
For stationary unit root test and for testing of autocorrelation Durban Watson test was used.
Individual variables were tested for stationary.
The Multiple Regression Analysis.
This work had used a fixed effect model panel data, Housman’s test was applied to
select between fixed and random effect model for the analysis and fixed effect model was
preferred. For a fixed effect model, the values of Bayesian criterion (SBC) Akaike
information criterion (AIC), Schwarz and Hannan-Quinn criterion (HQC) were also lower.
By including fixed effect, the average differences across variables were controlled in any
observable or unobservable predictors. The Fixed Effect Model greatly reduced the threat
of omitted variable bias. This work will use the linear regression model, but Following
model will be used:
NCA = α0 + α1 (FC) + α2 (DC) + α3 (FSRS) + α4 (RSI) + α5(GP) + u
Where:
FC = HR + PH +KR + CR + IF
DC = HDC +DSP+ IDD+HDC
RSI= SH+RI
FSRS = DSI +RI +IR +BC
GP =RTA + SD + TC
RESULTS
This section will apply the methodology identified in the previous section. The results
will be analyzed and discussed thoroughly. The regression analysis is a technique used to
identify the variation independent variable caused by individual or more than one
21
independent variables. Before calculating regression, the normality of the data was checked
the descriptive statistics for each model was calculated. For checking the problem of multi-
collinearity Pearson correlation test was applied. ADF test was applied to check stationarity
of each variable.
Table 2 Summary Statistics Pakistan
Variables Mean Median Min Max SD skew Kurt
FC 6.3e019 -0.026 -0.0784 0.193 0.077 0.270 1.022
DC 7.2e-008 0.0378 -0.0378 0.274 0.183 -0.051 -1.361
SRI -9.0e-009 0.0090 -
0.186
0.106 0.081 -0.903 0.202
FSSR 0.0042 -0.002 -0.396 0.263 0.114 -0.901 2.000
GP -0.0002 0.0060 -0.104 0.060 0.048 -0.595 -0.433
Table 5.6 shows the summary statistics of Pakistan. In order to check the normality of the
data the value of kurtosis was analyzed and suggests that all the variable shows less than 2
value. This suggests that the data is normally distributed.
Table 3 Correlation Matrix Pakistan
FC DC SR FSSR GP
FC 1.00 0.65 -0.31 0.14 -0.47
DC 1.00 0.021 0.34 0.19
22
SR 1.00 0.30 0.51
FSSR 1.00 0.22
GP 1.00
Table 5.7 shows the correlation matrix of explanatory variables of the overall Pakistan
model. The result suggests that the problem of multicollinearity is not present in the data.
Table 4 Regression Results
VARIABLE Coefficient Std. Error t-ratio p-value
FC −0.01 0.074 −0.12 0.89
DC 1.14 2.19 0.51 0.60
SR 0.23 0.83 0.28 0.77
FSSR −0.64 1.13 −0.57 0.56
GP 2.44 0.74 3.27 0.002
Adjusted R-squared 0.28
F statistic 5.23
P-value (F) 0.00
Durbin-Watson 1.79
23
Table 5.10 presents regression results Pakistan. The adjusted R square was 28.14 %, which
suggests that almost 28.14 % changes in the selected data were due to above motioned
explanatory variables. The coefficient for factor conditions variable is −0.01 and shows a
negative relationship between factor condition and competitive advantage. The coefficient
of demand conditions is 1.14 which shows that there is a positive relationship between
demand conditions and competitive advantage. The coefficient for supporting and related
industries is 0.23 and shows a positive relationship with the competitive advantage of the
country. The coefficient for firm strategy and rivalry is −0.64 and shows a negative
relationship with the competitive advantage of the country. The coefficient for
government policy variable is 2.44 and shows a positive relationship with the advantage of
the country. The overall model is statistically significant with F value of 5.23 and P-
value 0.00. The T-statistics show that only government policy is statistically significant
at 5% significance level. The DW statistics suggest the data is free from Auto Correlation.
Regression Analysis
The results of the fixed effect model show that overall model is significant, which
suggests that, Pakistan’s national comparative advantage can be explained by the
independent variables tested and identified in the model. This favors the national diamond
model presented by Porter (1990). The regression results for Pakistan suggested a
significant impact of factor conditions, demand condition, supporting and related industries
and government policy on the national competitive advantage. This shows that Pakistani
exports are positively affected by the abundant natural resources available in the country
which supports the results of Zia (2006) who also suggest that Pakistan is factor driven
country and there are signs of growth in the economy. This also supports the results of Raja
(2015) that Pakistan is endowed with fertile soil, climate, hardworking human resource
working in the areas of information technology, finance and engineering, who is providing
a strong base for exports. The variable of factor conditions suggests an insignificant
24
negative relationship with the national competitive advantage of Pakistan. This contradicts
the results of Abbas and Waheed (2015), who suggested a positive relationship between
the irrigated land area and exchange rate against US dollars with the export competitiveness
of Pakistan. It also contradicts the results of Afridi (2016). Who found a positive
relationship between different factor conditions, including human capital on the economic
growth of Pakistan and suggested an investment in education and health sector to achieve
long-term benefits. As the p-value is greater than 0.05 therefore, the hypothesis of a
significant relationship between factor conditions and the national competitive advantage
is rejected. The reason might be unskilled labor situation with an increase in the flight of
both skilled and unskilled human capital to developed countries suggested by (Husain,
2001). As compared to India and China the development of human capital is very weak,
with very low productivity. There is also a very slow growth in private investment with
poor infrastructure which are major impediments to the growth of the economy (Chaudry,
2007). As suggested by Afza and Nazir (2007) that despite having a large population
majority, Pakistan has utilized only 20% of its population on professional, managerial and
technical positions, a Major portion of its workforce is engaged in the industrial and
agricultural workforce at the Frontline. Financial resources for the business sector are also
rudimentary and very restricted as compared to countries following export growth led
policies. FDI can be identified as a potential external source of finance and continuous
inflow of its help in value addition of much industry, transfer of technology and
improvement of labor skills but Pakistan is also lagging behind to attract the potential
amount of FDI. Additionally, Pakistan is not efficiently in research and development as
compared to East Asian countries, for the achievement of sustainable growth (Mahmood
& Ahmed, 2017).
The results of demand conditions suggest positive and insignificant with national
competitive advantage. This suggests that demand conditions are not playing a significant
role in the national competitive advantage of Pakistan. This contradicts the results of
Abbas and Waheed (2015) suggested who suggested a negative relationship between
domestic consumption demand with the export competitiveness. The reason might be the
low technology production trap identified by Zia (2013), the preference of buyers to
25
purchase to export items, lack of purchasing power of the majority population due to high
poverty levels. Therefore the hypothesis of a significant relationship between demand
conditions and the national competitive advantage is rejected
The variable of supporting and related industries suggests a positive but insignificant
relationship with national competitive advantage national competitive advantage. The
reason might be the critical challenges faced by the transport and logistics sector include
non-declaration of transport and logistics as an industry by the government, lack of proper
investment in transport infrastructure by the government, no government licensing
authority for freight cargo transporters, no official law enacted for transport sector in
Pakistan, outdated legal framework for carriage of goods by roads, lack of rail services and
logistics to transport containers from ports, damage of roads and other infrastructure due
to floods, run down roads and transport network, restrictions on provision of bonded
transport, high cost for less than container load, non-operation of Pakistan Railways on
commercial basis, lack of road safety devices, resulting in road accidents (Masood ,2011).
Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship between related and supporting
industries and the national competitive advantage is rejected
Firm strategy and rivalry show a negative and insignificant relationship with the national
competitive advantage of Pakistan. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant relationship
between firm strategy and rivalry and the national competitive advantage is rejected. The
reason might increase the cost of doing business in Pakistan identified by the Department
of International Trade (2015). Mahmood and Ahmed (2017) also identified the increased
cost of setting and running a business in Pakistan, which might be the result of high
inflation and poor security situations. National Tariff Commission (NTC),(2015) also
identified the high cost of doing business and the very unfriendly socioeconomic
environment in Pakistan.
The variable of government policy shows a positive and significant relationship
with national competitive advantage showing government positive role in increasing the
national competitive advantage of the country. The reason might be the liberalization
26
policies introduced in the country. It is also supported by Pakistan country report (2010),
whi9ch suggest that the country is trying to adopt trade liberalization policies, privatization
of many public owned organizations and attracted FDI which might have impacted the
positive impact on the national competitive advantage. According to Mahmood & Ahmed
(2017), increased tariffs had restricted the imports of certain items which boosted some
domestic and increases exports of the country, but in the long run, they will seriously
damage the competitive advantage of the country so applied tariffs should be decreased.
Amjad.et. al (2012) performed a firm-level survey using data from Pakistan and suggested
that the key impediment to Pakistan export competitiveness are, skilled labor shortages,
energy crises, poor infrastructure, and market imperfection. A clear and practical
government policy should be devised to solve these problems which help to expand the
Pakistan export market. Another issue identified by Husain and Ahmed was sector picking
for export promotion which boosts exports of the certain sector but seriously damages
others. Therefore, uniform policies should be devised for the balanced growth of the
economy. The benefits of decreased Soil prices should be passed to manufacturers for cost
saving (Hussain, 2017). Another issue of customs clearance and shipping documentation
should also be revised for better performance. Therefore, the hypothesis of a significant
relationship between government policy and the national competitive advantage is
accepted is rejected.
Conclusion and Recommendation
The main aim of this work was to identify sources of competitive advantage for
Pakistan by applying porter diamond model. Panel data was collected from 5 Pakistani
industries. The independent variable was national competitive advantage in trade which
was calculated by revealed comparative advantage. The independent variable includes
factor conditions, demand conditions, supporting and related industries, firm structure,
strategy and rivalry and government policy. In order to develop variables different proxies
were identified, and composite variable was developed. Fixed effect model was applied
and the results suggests only government policy is playing a significant role in determining
nation competitive advantage in trade. Therefore, Pakistan can devise its policy for the
27
improvement of all the other variables for the attainment of sustainable national
competitive advantage in trade
Recommendations
Trade integration is very critical for the economy as it will help countries to cooperate
and offer more products at reasonable cost and efficiency in the international market. The
government of Pakistan is trying to liberalize their trade policy, but still, results are not up
to the expectation. Therefore, a serious revision of policies and their implementation is
required to achieve the benefits of trade liberalization. In order to improve Factor
conditions, both countries should improve the education system and allocate more budget
for education and health, increase number of training institutes should be established, for
the improvement in human resource skills. Health reforms should be introduced for the
improvement of the quality of the labor force. In order to improve per hectare yield of the
crops, the farmers should be given easy credit and facilitated with superior quality seeds.
The communication gap between research and development and the farmers should be
eliminated for better results. Additionally, the feudalism system should be monitored and
regulated and farmers should be given lands. Credit availability should be eased for
entrepreneurs. For the improvement in demand conditions, population growth should be
monitored, the Strict quality standard should be maintained and regularly monitored. For
increasing international demand for domestic products. Increase employment opportunities
should be created for increasing the purchasing power of the people, Consumer friendly
policies should be introduced. Working of consumer courts should be enhanced, for
consumer protection. Transportation system should be upgraded. Technological
advancement should be incorporated in every field of life for better results. More dams
should be constructed, solar power should be used for electricity generation. Other sources
of energy like wind, biogas, coal should be used for generation of power for industries. A
business-friendly environment should be maintained within the country. More industrial
zones should be established, with the facilitation of energy availability and tax benefits.
Government procedure should be simplified. The Private sector should be involved and
public-private coordination should be established in different industries. In order to
28
improve government policy, a rigorous policy should be designed for the improvement of
infrastructure and business environment of the country. The unnecessary intervention of
the government should be restricted. The Prices of sugar or wheat should not be utilized as
a political tool, unnecessary tariffs should be abolished against each other. More RTAs
should be signed for an increase in regional integration, Unnecessary non-tariff barriers
should be abolished, Research grants should be given priorities for increasing the
competitiveness of the country, Measures should be taken to decrease corruption,
accountability and check and balance should be maintained for government officials,
efforts should be made for maintaining normal law and order situation will attract new
investment. It will also decrease the brain drain from the country.
Direction for Future Research
Future research should be conducted by applying other models like a double
diamond model and nine-factor model for better understanding of the factor affecting
competitive advantage in trade for Pakistan. Further research can also be done by adding
more items to the development of variables to Potter National Diamond model. More
industries can be included for a better understanding of the Pakistani economy.
Limitation of the Study
There are some limitations of this work which cannot be overlooked, the major
limitation is that few industries were selected from both countries, although the sample was
representative, still, the results cannot be generalized to the whole economy, other
industries have their own resource requirements and management practices. The future
studies can be directed toward other industries. The second limitation was that the majority
of the data was unorganized and undocumented in both countries, due to which limited
items were included in the development of variables. The third limitation of the study was
ill legal trade patterns between Pakistan and India and was not included. Lastly, another
limitation was political tensions between both countries, due to which trade was suspended
at different time periods during the study period.
29
References
Afridi Ahad Hassan (2016). Human Capital and Economic Growth of Pakistan. Business
& Economic Review.8 (1): pp. 77-86.
Afza, T. and M.S. Nazir. 2007. Working Capital Management Policies of Firms:
Empirical Evidence from Pakistan. Conference Proceeding of 9th South Asian
Management Forum (SAMF),On February 24-25. Dhaka, Bangladesh: North South
University.
Ahid, Wali (17 July 2017). "Pak GDP in terms of purchasing power parity crosses $1
trillion". The New.
Balcarova.P.(2013).The comparison of nine-factor model and diamond Model:
application for the czech republic, slovakiaand hungary. Mendel University in
Brno, Faculty of Business and Economics, Zemedelská. RETREIVED FROM
krus.slu.cz/su/opf/cz/informace/acta-academica....
Gawad.G.M.M., Alkhteeb.T.T.,Intezar.M.T.(2014) Determinets of competitive
advantages of dates exporting: An applied study on Saudi Arabia. International
journal of economics and finance.6(4). 79-87.
Henneberry, S. (2000). "An analysis of industrial–agricultural interactions: A case study
In Pakistan". Agricultural Economics. 22:17–27. doi:10.1016/S0169-
5150(99)00041-9s. Retrieved 27 July 2017.
Hussain.S.S., Ahmed. V., (2011). Experiments with industrial policy: The Case Of
Pakistan Working Paper No: 124. The Sustainable Development Policy Institute.
Hussain (2017). Tariff trade and taxation. Dawn. July .2017.
Pakistan Defense Forum. (2015). Top 10 Pakistan Exports and Imports to and from other
countries. Retrieved from https://defence.pk › Pakistan Defense Forum › Pakistan
Affairs › Pakistan Economy.
Pakisatn economic survey (2013). Government of Pakistan. Ministry of finance
Reterived from www.finance.gov.pk/survey/.
Paracha (2012). Comparative analysis of Pakistan India chemical industries. Retrieved
from Pitad.org.pk/publication/32-pakistan trade.
Pasha H. A. & Saleem. W (2013). The Impact and Cost of Power Load Shedding
30
to Domestic Consumers. The Pakistan Development Review. 52:4 Part I (Winter),
355–373
Porter. Michael E. (1990) The Competitive Advantage of Nations. New York: Free
Press, Macmillan.
Raja.S.H (2015). Pakistan’s Exports Sector/Challenges and Response.
www.shahidhussainraja.com.
Rattanavijit.S., Somboonwiwat.T., Khompatraporn.c.(2015). Analysis of casual
competitive factors of Thai iron and steel supply chain by Dematel Method.
Industrial engineering, management science, and application.541-550.
State bank of Pakistan(2017). Retrived from www.sbp.org.pk.
World Bank Document. ( 2008). p. 14. Retrieved 2 January 2010. 18-23.
Watchravesringkan, K., Karpova, E., Hodges, N.N., Copeland, R. (2010). The
Wayback Machine. (2015)Textile Industry of Pakistan - An Analysis - Ravi Magazine. e.
2015-04- Factsheet Pakistan" (PDF). Retrieved 17 October 2017.
Wijnands.J.H.M., Berkum. S.V., Verhoog.A.D.(2015). Competitiveness of CIS and EU
agrifood chains Quantifying Porter’s diamond. AgriCIS.
Zia. U. (2006). International Competitiveness International Competitiveness - Where
Pakistan Stands? Where Pakistan Stands? Retrieved from www.pide.org.pk
Top Related